Burstner Viseo 2012 Instruction Manual PDF

1 of 292
1 of 292

Summary of Content for Burstner Viseo 2012 Instruction Manual PDF

Instruction manual

I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

2011 Brstner GmbH Kehl

Instruction manualDear Reader ... We would like to congratulate you on the purchase of your new motorhome. You have selected a top-quality vehicle which will afford you many years of enjoyment. To enable you to always use and operate your motorhome properly and easily, your Brstner dealer will first provide you detailed instructions for all important functions when you take delivery. This manual, the instruction manuals from the base vehicle manufacturer as well as the instruction manuals from the appliance manufacturer will always be at hand to answer any questions you may have regarding your motorhome.

Before your first journey Please familiarise yourself with this manual rather than relying on it strictly for reference. Fill in the warranty cards for the appliances and special equipment in the individual instructions and send these cards to the respective manufacturers. This ensures your warranty claim for each appliance.

I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Instruction manual

3I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Contents

1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 1.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 1.2 Environmental tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10

2 Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 2.1 Fire prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 2.1.1 Avoidance of fire risks . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 2.1.2 Fire-fighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 2.1.3 In case of fire. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 2.2 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 2.3 Road safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 2.4 Towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 2.5 Gas system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 2.5.1 General instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 2.5.2 Gas bottles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 2.6 Electrical system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 2.7 Water system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16

3 Before the journey . . . . . . . . . . . 17 3.1 Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 3.2 Registration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 3.3 Payload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 3.3.1 Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 3.3.2 Calculating the payload. . . . . . . . . . . . 20 3.3.3 Loading the vehicle correctly. . . . . . . . 21 3.3.4 Roof rail and ladder

(special equipment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 3.3.5 Rear garage/rear storage space . . . . . 24 3.3.6 Double floor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 3.3.7 Extendable storage compartment . . . . 25 3.3.8 Bike rack (special equipment) . . . . . . . 25 3.3.9 Removable load rack AL-KO

(special equipment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 3.3.10 Load rack SAWIKO

(special equipment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 3.4 Towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 3.5 Caravan coupling

(special equipment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 3.6 Entrance step

(partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 30 3.7 Television (special equipment) . . . . . . 31 3.8 Sink and drain basin covers . . . . . . . . 31 3.9 Securing add-on parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 3.10 Snow chains (special equipment) . . . . 32 3.11 Road safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33

4 During the journey . . . . . . . . . . . 35 4.1 Driving the motorhome . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 4.2 Parking distance control

Park Boy V (special equipment) . . . . . 36 4.3 Reversing camera

(partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 38 4.4 Driving speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 4.5 Brakes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 4.6 Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 4.6.1 Fastening the seat belt correctly . . . . . 40 4.7 Child restraint systems . . . . . . . . . . . . 40

4.8 Pilot seats for the driver's and front passenger's seats . . . . . . . . . . . . 40

4.8.1 Seats (Aguti) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 4.8.2 Seats (Aguti-Liner) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 4.9 Headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 4.10 Seating arrangement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 4.11 Electrical window winders

(partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 43 4.12 External mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 4.13 Roman shades for windscreen,

driver's window and front passenger's window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44

4.14 Bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 4.15 Washer nozzles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 4.16 Filliing with washer fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 4.17 Filling up with diesel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47

5 Pitching the motorhome . . . . . . 49 5.1 Handbrake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 5.2 Entrance step. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 5.3 Ramps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 5.4 Wheel chocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 5.5 Supports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 5.5.1 General instructions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 5.5.2 Steady legs (SAWIKO)

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 5.5.3 Steady legs (AL-KO)

(partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 51 5.5.4 Electrical steady legs (AL-KO)

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 5.6 230 V connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 5.7 Refrigerator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 5.8 Satellite unit (special equipment) . . . . . 54 5.8.1 Equipment with automatic

antenna alignment (Alden). . . . . . . . . . 54 5.8.2 Equipment with semi-automatic

antenna alignment (Alden). . . . . . . . . . 54 5.8.3 Equipment with automatic antenna

alignment (Oyster) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 5.9 Awning (special equipment). . . . . . . . . 56

6 Living . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 6.1 Conversion door and driver's door. . . . 57 6.1.1 Driver's door, outside

(partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 57 6.1.2 Driver's door, inside

(partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 58 6.1.3 Conversion door, outside

(Hartal M1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 6.1.4 Conversion door, inside

(Hartal M1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 6.1.5 Conversion door, outside

(Hartal Premium) (partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 59

6.1.6 Conversion door, inside (Hartal Premium) (partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 60

Contents

4 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

6.1.7 Window of conversion door (Hartal Premium) (partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 60

6.1.8 Folding insect screen on the conversion door (partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 61

6.2 External flaps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 6.2.1 Flap lock with recessed handle . . . . . . 62 6.2.2 Flap lock, elliptical-shaped. . . . . . . . . . 62 6.2.3 Flap lock with push button . . . . . . . . . . 63 6.2.4 Flap for the 230 V connection,

square . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 6.2.5 Cap for the drinking water

filler neck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 6.3 Furniture flaps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 6.3.1 Furniture flaps with push button. . . . . . 65 6.3.2 Furniture flaps with handle and

push button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 6.3.3 Furniture flaps with release handle . . . 66 6.3.4 Furniture flaps with release handle . . . 66 6.4 Light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 6.4.1 Entrance area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 6.4.2 Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 6.4.3 Wardrobe light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 6.5 Light control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 6.6 Spotlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 6.7 Holder for flat screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 6.7.1 Holder on the column. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 6.7.2 Holder in the TV cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . 72 6.7.3 Holder with jointed arm . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 6.8 Ventilation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 6.9 Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 6.9.1 Hinged window with rotary hinges . . . . 74 6.9.2 Hinged window with automatic

hinges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 6.9.3 Sliding window with lock . . . . . . . . . . . 77 6.9.4 Hinged sunroof with automatic

hinges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 6.9.5 Blind and insect screen . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 6.9.6 Blind and insect screen . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 6.9.7 Roman shade and insect screen . . . . . 80 6.9.8 Roman shade and insect screen

(hinged sunroof). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 6.9.9 Roman shades for windscreen,

driver's window and front passenger's window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81

6.10 Skylights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 6.10.1 Heki skylight (mini and midi) . . . . . . . . 82 6.10.2 Wind-up skylight

(partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . 83 6.11 Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 6.11.1 Suspension table with changeable

table leg . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 6.11.2 Fixed table (table-top for folding,

sliding and rotating) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 6.11.3 Fixed table (extendable table-top) . . . . 86 6.11.4 Fixed table (movable table-top) . . . . . . 87

6.12 Divan adjustment mechanism (partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . .87

6.13 Beds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 6.13.1 Bunk bed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 6.13.2 Pull-down bed, manually operated . . . .88 6.13.3 Pull-down bed, electrically

operated (special equipment) . . . . . . . .90 6.13.4 Fixed bed (manual setup). . . . . . . . . . .92 6.13.5 Fixed bed (gas-pressure springs). . . . .93 6.13.6 Fixed bed (adjustable head section). . .94 6.13.7 Fixed bed, electrically adjustable

(partially special equipment) . . . . . . . . .94 6.13.8 Widening single beds

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96

7 Gas system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 7.1 General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 7.2 Gas bottles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 7.3 Changing gas bottles . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 7.4 Gas isolator taps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 7.5 External gas connection

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 7.6 Crash protection unit switching facility

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101 7.7 DuoControl switching facility

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 7.8 Gas alarm system

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105

8 Electrical system . . . . . . . . . . . .107 8.1 General safety instructions . . . . . . . . .107 8.2 Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 8.3 12 V power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108 8.3.1 Selector switch for radio

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108 8.3.2 Starter battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109 8.3.3 Living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110 8.4 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 99) . . . . . .111 8.4.1 Battery cut-off switch . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 8.4.2 Battery selector switch . . . . . . . . . . . .113 8.4.3 Battery monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 8.4.4 Charging the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 8.5 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 220) . . . . .114 8.5.1 Battery separation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115 8.5.2 Battery selector switch . . . . . . . . . . . .115 8.5.3 Battery monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 8.5.4 Charging the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 8.6 Panel IT 96-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 8.6.1 12 V main switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117 8.6.2 V/tank gauge for battery voltage

and water or waste water levels . . . .117 8.6.3 Switch for water pump . . . . . . . . . . . .119 8.6.4 Battery alarm for the living

area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119 8.6.5 12 V indicator lamp. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119 8.6.6 230 V indicator lamp. . . . . . . . . . . . . .119 8.7 Panel IT 994 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120

5I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Contents

8.7.1 V/tank gauge for battery voltage and water or waste water levels . . . . 120

8.7.2 Battery alarm for the living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122

8.7.3 Digital clock/temperature gauge . . . . 122 8.7.4 Current gauge for charging/

discharging the living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123

8.7.5 12 V main switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 8.7.6 12 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 8.7.7 230 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 8.7.8 Switch for water pump. . . . . . . . . . . . 124 8.8 Panel LT 510. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 8.8.1 230 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 8.8.2 12 V main switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 8.8.3 Batteries gauge. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 8.8.4 Tank gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 8.8.5 Alarms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 8.8.6 Temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 8.8.7 Switch for tank heater . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 8.8.8 Switch for water pump. . . . . . . . . . . . 130 8.9 Fuel cell (EFOY)

(special equipment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 8.10 Solar installation

(special equipment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 8.11 230 V power supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 8.11.1 230 V connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 8.11.2 Connecting 230 V power supply . . . . 134 8.12 Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 8.12.1 12 V fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 8.12.2 230 V fuse. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 8.13 External socket

(special equipment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 8.14 Circuit diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 8.14.1 Circuit diagrams, interior . . . . . . . . . . 142 8.14.2 Circuit diagram, exterior . . . . . . . . . . 148

9 Appliances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 9.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 9.2 Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 9.2.1 Models with waste gas vent on

the right-hand side of the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150

9.2.2 To heat properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 9.2.3 Truma Combi hot-air heater . . . . . . . 151 9.2.4 Alde hot-water heater

(partially special equipment) . . . . . . . 153 9.2.5 Auxiliary heat exchanger

(partially special equipment) . . . . . . . 157 9.2.6 Electrical floor warming unit

(special equipment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 9.2.7 Independent vehicle heater

(special equipment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 9.3 Air conditioning unit

(special equipment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 9.3.1 Dometic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 9.3.2 Telair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161

9.4 Boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 9.4.1 Models with waste gas vent on

the right-hand side of the vehicle. . . . 163 9.4.2 Truma Combi boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 9.4.3 Alde boiler (partially special

equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 9.5 Cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 9.5.1 Gas cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 9.5.2 Gas oven (Dometic)

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 9.5.3 Microwave oven

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 9.5.4 Extractor hood

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 9.6 Refrigerator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 9.6.1 Refrigerator ventilation grill . . . . . . . . 173 9.6.2 Operation (Dometic 7 series

with automatic power selection AES and frame heater) . . . . . . . . . . . 174

9.6.3 Operation (Dometic 8 series with automatic power selection AES) . . . . 176

9.6.4 Refrigerator door locking mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178

10 Sanitary fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 10.1 Water supply, general . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 10.2 Water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 10.2.1 Volumes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 10.2.2 Auxiliary water tank

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 10.2.3 Drinking water filler neck with cap . . . 183 10.2.4 Closing/opening the overflow. . . . . . . 183 10.2.5 Filling with water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 10.2.6 Draining water

(handle with overflow) . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 10.3 Waste water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 10.3.1 Drain cock underneath the vehicle . . 185 10.3.2 Drain cock in the vehicle. . . . . . . . . . 185 10.3.3 Waste water tank heater

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 10.4 Filling the water system . . . . . . . . . . . 187 10.5 Emptying the water system . . . . . . . . 188 10.6 Toilet compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 10.7 Toilet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 10.7.1 Swivel toilet (Thetford C-200) . . . . . . 190 10.7.2 Toilet with fixed seat

(Thetford C-402) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 10.7.3 Toilet (Dometic) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200

11 Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 11.1 External care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 11.1.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 11.1.2 Washing with a high-pressure

cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 11.1.3 Washing the vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 11.1.4 Windows of acrylic glass . . . . . . . . . . 204 11.1.5 Underbody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204

Contents

6 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

11.1.6 Waste water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 11.1.7 Entrance step. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 11.2 Interior care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 11.3 Water system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 11.3.1 Cleaning the water tank . . . . . . . . . . . 206 11.3.2 Cleaning the water pipes . . . . . . . . . . 206 11.3.3 Disinfecting the water system . . . . . . 207 11.4 Extractor hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 11.5 Air conditioning unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 11.5.1 Dometic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 11.5.2 Telair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 11.6 Winter care. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 11.6.1 Preparations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 11.6.2 Winter operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 11.6.3 At the end of the winter season . . . . . 210 11.7 Lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 11.7.1 Temporary lay-up. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 11.7.2 Winter lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 11.7.3 Starting up the vehicle after a

temporary lay-up or after lay-up over winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212

12 Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 12.1 Inspection work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 12.2 Maintenance work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 12.3 Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 12.4 Living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 12.5 Fuel cell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 12.5.1 Replacing the tank cartridge . . . . . . . 216 12.5.2 Refilling service fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 12.6 Alde hot-water heater. . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 12.6.1 Checking the fluid level . . . . . . . . . . . 218 12.6.2 Topping up heating fluid. . . . . . . . . . . 218 12.6.3 Bleeding the heating system . . . . . . . 218 12.6.4 Position of the bleeding valves . . . . . 219 12.7 Independent vehicle heater . . . . . . . . 220 12.8 Replacing bulbs, external. . . . . . . . . . 221 12.8.1 Front lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 12.8.2 Front lights (variant) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 12.8.3 Rear lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 12.8.4 Side lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 12.8.5 Types of bulbs for exterior lighting . . . 227 12.9 Replacing bulbs, internal . . . . . . . . . . 227 12.9.1 Ceiling lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 12.9.2 Recessed halogen light . . . . . . . . . . . 228 12.9.3 Recessed halogen light (flat) . . . . . . . 229 12.9.4 Recessed light with LED . . . . . . . . . . 229 12.9.5 Halogen spotlight (movable) . . . . . . . 230 12.9.6 Wardrobe light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 12.9.7 Garage light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 12.10 Spare parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 12.11 Vehicle identification plate . . . . . . . . . 232 12.12 Warning and information stickers. . . . 232

13 Wheels and tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 13.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 13.2 Tyre selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234

13.3 Tyre specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 13.4 Handling of tyres. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 13.5 Changing wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 13.5.1 General instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 13.5.2 Tightening torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236 13.5.3 Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238 13.6 Spare wheel support

(special equipment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239 13.6.1 Spare wheel support under the

vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239 13.6.2 Spare wheel support under the

vehicle (basket) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239 13.6.3 Spare wheel support in the rear

garage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240 13.7 Tyre pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240

14 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . .243 14.1 Braking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243 14.2 Electrical system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243 14.3 Fuel cell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246 14.4 Gas system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246 14.5 Heater/boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247 14.5.1 Truma heater/boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247 14.5.2 Alde heater/boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248 14.6 Air conditioning unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248 14.6.1 Dometic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248 14.6.2 Telair. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249 14.7 Cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249 14.7.1 Gas cooker/gas oven . . . . . . . . . . . . .249 14.7.2 Microwave oven . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250 14.8 Refrigerator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250 14.8.1 Dometic 7 series with AES . . . . . . . . .250 14.8.2 Dometic 8 series with AES . . . . . . . . .251 14.9 Water supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252 14.10 Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254

15 Special equipment . . . . . . . . . . .255 15.1 Weight details for special

equipment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255

16 Technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259 16.1 View of ground plans . . . . . . . . . . . . .259 16.2 Table of linear measures . . . . . . . . . .264 16.3 Power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265

17 Helpful notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267 17.1 Traffic rules in foreign countries . . . . .267 17.2 Help on Europe's roads . . . . . . . . . . .267 17.3 Speed limits and permissible

dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269 17.4 Driving with low beam in

European countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272 17.5 Sleeping in the vehicle away from

camping areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272 17.6 Gas supply in European countries . . .274 17.7 Toll regulations in

European countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274

7I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Contents

17.8 Tips on staying overnight safely during travel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274

17.9 Tips for winter campers. . . . . . . . . . . 275 17.10 Travel checklists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275

18 Inspection plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279

Contents

8 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

9I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Introduction 1

1IntroductionPlease read this instruction manual completely before using the vehicle for the first time! Always keep this instruction manual in the vehicle. Also inform all other users of the safety regulations.

This instruction manual contains sections which describe model-spe- cific equipment or special equipment. These sections are specially marked. It may be that your vehicle has not been fitted with this special equipment. In some cases, the actual equipment of your vehicle may therefore be different from that shown in some illustrations and descrip- tions. However, your vehicle may be fitted with other special equipment not described in this instruction manual. Special equipment is described when an explanation is required. Adhere to the instruction manuals which are separately enclosed.

Should the vehicle be subjected to damage due to a failure to follow the instructions in this instruction manual, then the guarantee claim is deemed invalid. Our vehicles are subjected to continuous development. Please understand that we reserve the right to alter the form, equipment and technology. There- fore, no claims can be made against the manufacturer as a result of the con- tents of this instruction manual. The equipment which was known and included at the time of going to press is described. The reprinting, translation and copying, including extracts is not permitted without prior written authorisation from the manufacturer.

1.1 General The vehicle is constructed in accordance with the latest technology and the recognised safety regulations. Nevertheless, personal injury may result and the vehicle may be damaged if the safety instructions in this instruction manual are not followed.

The non-observance of this symbol can lead to personal injury.

The non-observance of this symbol can lead to damage being caused to, or inside the vehicle.

This symbol indicates recommendations or special aspects.

This symbol indicates actions which lead to environmental awareness.

The details "right", "left", "front" and "rear" always refer to the vehicle in direction of travel. All dimensions and weight details are "approximate".

10 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Introduction1

Only use the vehicle in a technically impeccable condition. Follow the instruc- tions in the instruction manual. Malfunctions which impair the safety of persons or the vehicle should be immediately remedied by qualified personnel. To avoid further damages, observe the duty to avert, minimize or mitigate loss for the user during faults. Have the vehicle's braking and gas systems inspected and repaired by an authorised specialist workshop only. Alterations to the body are only to be carried out with the authorisation of the manufacturer. The vehicle is designed for the exclusive transport of persons. Luggage and accessories may only be transported up to the maximum permissible gross weight. Observe the test and inspection periods stipulated by the manufacturer.

1.2 Environmental tips Be considerate of the environment. Remember that: All kinds of waste water and household waste are not to be disposed of in drains or in the open countryside. On board, collect waste water only in the waste water tank or if necessary in other containers designed for that purpose. Only empty the waste water tank and toilet cassette or sewage tank at dis- posal stations at the camping or caravan sites, which are especially pro- vided for this purpose. When stopping in towns and communities, observe the instructions at caravan sites or ask where there are disposal stations. Empty waste water tank as often as possible, even when it is not com- pletely full (hygiene). If possible, flush out waste water tank and, if necessary, drainage pipe with fresh water every time it is emptied. Never allow the toilet cassette or sewage tank to become too full. Empty the toilet cassette or sewage tank frequently, at the latest as soon as the level indicator lights up. Separate household waste according to glass, tin cans, plastic and wet waste also when on a journey. Enquire at the town or community authority about disposal points. Household waste is not to be disposed of in waste paper baskets which are situated at car parks. Empty waste bins as often as possible into the containers provided for this purpose. This helps to avoid unpleasant smells and an accumulation of rubbish on board. When parked, do not allow the engine to run more than necessary. When running idle, a cold engine releases more contaminants than usual. The running temperature of the engine is achieved more quickly whilst the vehicle is in motion. Use an environmentally-friendly WC chemical agent for the WC which can also be biologically degraded and only use small doses. When staying in towns and communities for long periods, search for parking areas which are specially reserved for motorhomes. Enquire at the town or community authority about parking spaces. Always leave the parking places in a clean condition.

11I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Safety 2

2SafetyChapter overview This chapter contains important safety instructions. The safety instructions are for the protection of persons and property. The instructions address the following topics:

fire prevention and what to do in case of fire general care of the vehicle road safety of the vehicle towing gas system of the vehicle electrical system of the vehicle water system of the vehicle

2.1 Fire prevention 2.1.1 Avoidance of fire risks

2.1.2 Fire-fighting

2.1.3 In case of fire

Never leave children in the vehicle unattended. Keep flammable materials clear of heating and cooking appliances. Lights can get very hot. When the light is switched on, there must always be a safety distance of 30 cm between light and flammable objects. Fire hazard! Never use portable heating or cooking appliances. Only authorised qualified personnel may make changes to the electrical system, gas system or appliances.

Always carry a dry powder fire extinguisher in the vehicle. The fire extin- guisher must be approved, tested and close at hand. Have the fire extinguisher tested at regular intervals by authorised qual- ified personnel. Observe the date of testing. Depending on the equipment, the fire extinguisher is included in the scope of delivery. Always keep a fire blanket near the cooker.

Evacuate all passengers. Cut off the electrical power supply and disconnect from the mains. Close regulator tap on the gas bottle. Sound the alarm and call the fire brigade. Fight the fire if this is possible without risk.

Acquaint yourself with the position and operation of the emergency exits. Keep escape routes clear. Observe the fire extinguisher instructions for use.

12 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Safety2

All windows and doors which meet the following requirements are considered as emergency exits:

Open to the outside or can be shifted in horizontal direction Opening angle at least 70 Minimum diameter of clearance = 450 mm Maximum distance from the vehicle floor = 950 mm

2.2 General

2.3 Road safety

The oxygen in the vehicle interior is used up by breathing and the use of gas operated appliances. That is why the oxygen needs to be replaced on a constant basis. For this purpose, forced ventilation options (e.g. skylights with forced ventilation, mushroom-shaped vents or floor vents) are fitted to the vehicle. Never cover or block forced ventilations from the inside or outside with objects such as e.g. a winter mat. Keep forced ven- tilations clear of snow and leaves. There is a danger of suffocation due to increased CO2 levels.

Observe the headroom of the doors.

As far as the fitted appliances (heater, cooker, refrigerator, etc.) and the base vehicle (engine, brakes, etc.) are concerned, the instruction manuals are authoritative. It is imperative that they be observed. Fitting accessories or special equipment can alter the dimensions, weight and road behaviour of the vehicle. Some of the parts must be entered in the vehicle papers. Only use wheel rims and tyres which are approved for the vehicle. Informa- tion concerning the size of the approved wheel rims and tyres is included in the vehicle documents or can be obtained from authorised dealers and service centres. Firmly apply the handbrake when parking the vehicle. If the maximum permissible gross weight of the vehicle exceeds 4 tonnes, wheel chocks must be used when parking on gradients. The wheel chocks are provided as standard for vehicles with a maximum permissible gross weight exceeding 4 tonnes.

When leaving the vehicle, it is imperative that all doors, external flaps and windows are closed. Carry a hazard warning triangle and a first-aid kit and/or flashing hazard warning light when this is required by law. The vehicle may only be driven by drivers who hold a driving licence which is valid for the respective vehicle class. When selling the vehicle, hand over all instruction manuals for the vehicle and the fitted appliances.

Before commencing the journey, carry out a functional check of indi- cating and lighting equipment, the steering and the brakes. If the vehicle has been stationary for a long period (approx. 10 months) have the braking and gas systems checked by an authorised specialist workshop.

13I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Safety 2

Before commencing the journey and after short interruptions of the journey, ensure that the entrance step is completely retracted. Before commencing the journey, secure the hinged pull-down bed. Before commencing the journey, open and secure the shades on the windscreen and on the driver's and front passenger's windows. Before commencing the journey, remove the television from the support and store it securely. Before commencing the journey, place and secure the flat screen and screen support in the initial position. If the screen holder is installed in a TV cabinet: Close TV cabinet. Before commencing the journey, take off the loose sink and drain basin covers and store them securely in the kitchen unit or the wardrobe. Before commencing the journey, fix adjustable tables. Before commencing the journey, rotate all swivel seats in the direction of travel and lock in position. During the journey, the swivel seats must remain locked in place in the direction of travel. During the journey, persons are only to sit on the permitted seats (see chapter 4). The authorised number of seats is stipulated in the vehicle documents. Seat belts must be worn by all passengers. Fasten your seat belts before the beginning of the journey and keep them fastened during the journey. Always secure children with the children safety equipment prescribed for the respective height and weight. Factory-set three-point safety belts must be used when attaching child restraint systems. The base vehicle is a commercial vehicle (small truck). Adjust your driving technique accordingly. In case of underpasses, tunnels or similar obstacles, note the total height of the vehicle (including the roof load). In winter, the roof must be free of snow and ice before commencing the journey. Check tyre pressure before a journey or every 2 weeks. Wrong tyre pressure causes excessive wear and can lead to damage or even to tyre burst. You can lose control of the vehicle. Do not operate the heater at petrol stations. Danger of explosion! Do not operate the heater in closed spaces. Danger of suffocation!

Before commencing the journey, distribute the payload evenly within the vehicle (see chapter 3). When loading the vehicle and when taking a rest from driving, in order to load luggage or food, for example, observe the maximum permissible gross weight and axle loads (refer to vehicle documents). Before commencing the journey, ensure that all cupboard doors, the toilet compartment door and all drawers and flaps are secure. Engage the refrig- erator door securing device. Before commencing the journey, close windows and skylights. Before commencing the journey, close all external flaps and lock them.

14 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Safety2

2.4 Towing

2.5 Gas system 2.5.1 General instructions

Before commencing the journey, remove the external supports and retract the corner steadies or steady legs, which are fitted to the vehicle. Before commencing the journey, put the antenna in park position. During the initial journey and each time after changing a wheel, re-tighten the wheel bolts/wheel nuts after 50 km (30 miles). Subsequently inspect them at regular intervals in order to ensure that they are firmly seated. See chapter 13 for tightening torque. Tyres may not be older than 6 years as the material becomes brittle over time (see chapter 13). When using snow chains, the tyres, wheel suspension and steering are subjected to an additional load. When using snow chains, drive slowly (maximum speed 50 km/h) and only on streets which are completely cov- ered with snow. Otherwise the vehicle could be damaged.

Care is to be taken when connecting and detaching a trailer. Risk of acci- dent and injury! No persons are to be between the towing vehicle and the trailer during positioning for connecting and detaching.

Before commencing the journey, when leaving the vehicle or when gas equipment is not in use, close all gas isolator taps and the main isolator tap on the gas bottle. No appliance operated by a naked flame (e.g. heater or refrigerator) may be in operation when filling the tank, on ferries or in the garage. Danger of explosion! Do not use appliances operated with a naked flame in closed spaces (e.g. garages). Danger of poisoning and suffocation! Only have the gas system maintained, repaired or altered by an author- ised specialist workshop. Have the gas system checked by an authorised specialist workshop according to the national regulations before commissioning. This also applies for not registered vehicles. For modifications to the gas system have the gas system immediately checked by an authorised specialist workshop. The gas pressure regulator and exhaust gas pipes must also be inspected. The gas pressure regulator has to be replaced after 10 years at the latest. The vehicle owner is responsible for seeing that this is car- ried out. In case of a defect of the gas system (gas odour, high gas consumption) there is danger of explosion! Close regulator tap on the gas bottle imme- diately. Open doors and windows and ventilate well. If the gas system is defective: Do not smoke; do not ignite any open flames, and do not operate electric switches (light switches etc.). Before using the cooker make sure that there is sufficient ventilation. Open windows or the skylight.

15I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Safety 2

2.5.2 Gas bottles

Do not use the gas cooker or gas oven for heating purposes. If there are several gas devices, each gas device must have its own gas isolator tap. If individual gas devices are not in use, close the respective gas isolator tap. Ignition safety valves must close within 1 minute after the gas flame has extinguished. A clicking sound is audible. Check function from time to time. The built-in gas devices are exclusively meant for use with propane or butane gas or a mixture of both. The gas pressure regulator as well as all built-in gas devices are designed for a gas pressure of 30 mbar. Propane gas is capable of gasification up to -42 C, whereas butane gas gasifies at 0 C. Below these temperatures no gas pressure is available. Butane gas is unsuitable for use in winter. Regularly inspect the gas tube fitted to the gas bottle connection for tightness. The gas tube must not have any tears and must not be porous. Have the gas tube replaced by an authorised specialist work- shop no later than ten years after the manufacturing date. The operator of the gas system must see to it that the parts are replaced. Due to its function and construction, the gas bottle compartment is a space which is open to the exterior. Never cover or block up the standard forced ventilations. Otherwise gas that is emitted can not be diverted to the outside. Do not use the gas bottle compartment as storage space as it is not moisture-proof. Secure the gas bottle compartment against unauthorised access. To do this, lock the compartment. The regulator tap on the gas bottle must be accessible. Only connect gas-operated devices (e.g. gas grill) which have been designed for a gas pressure of 30 mbar. The exhaust gas pipe must be fitted tightly to the heating system and to the vent and must be sealed. The exhaust gas pipe must not show any evidence of damage. Exhaust fumes must be able to escape into the atmosphere unhindered and fresh air must be able to enter unhindered. For this reason, keep the exhaust pipe and intake openings clean and unobstructed (e.g. free from snow and ice). For this reason, no snow walls or aprons may lie against the vehicle.

Gas bottles are only to be transported within the designated gas bottle compartment. Place the gas bottles in vertical position in the gas bottle compartment. Fasten the gas bottles so that they are unable to turn or tilt. If the gas bottles are not connected to the gas tube, always place the protective cap on top. Close the regulator tap on the gas bottle before the gas pressure regu- lator or gas tube are removed from the gas bottle. Use your hands only to connect the gas pressure regulator or the gas tube to the gas bottles. Do not use any tools.

16 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Safety2

2.6 Electrical system

2.7 Water system

Only use special gas pressure regulators with a safety valve designed for vehicle use. Other gas pressure regulators are not permitted and cannot meet the demanding requirements. Use the gas pressure regulator defroster if the temperature falls below 5 C. Use only 11 kg or 5 kg gas bottles. Camping gas bottles with built-in check valve (blue bottle with max. 2.5 or 3 kg content) are can be used in exceptional cases with a safety valve. Use the shortest possible tube lengths (150 cm max.) for external gas bottles. Never block the floor ventilation openings below the gas bottles.

Only allow qualified personnel to work on the electrical system. Prior to carrying out work on the electrical system, switch off all devices and lights, disconnect the battery and disconnect the vehicle from the mains. Only use original fuses with the stipulated values. Only replace defective fuses when the cause of the defect is known and has been remedied. Never bridge or repair fuses.

Water left standing in the water tank or in the water pipes becomes undrinkable after a short period. Therefore, before each use of the vehicle, thoroughly clean the water pipes and the water tank. After each use of the vehicle completely empty the water tank and the water pipes. In the case of lay-ups lasting more than a week disinfect the water system before using the vehicle.

If the vehicle is not used for several days or if it is not heated when there is a risk of frost, empty the entire water system. Make certain that the water pump is switched off on the panel. Otherwise, the water pump will overheat and may get damaged. Leave the water taps on in central position. Leave the safety/drainage valve (if there is one) and all drain cocks open. Frost damage to appliances, frost damage to the vehicle and deposits in water- carrying components can be avoided in this way.

17I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey 3

3Before the journeyChapter overview This chapter contains important information which has to be noted before com- mencing your journey or carrying out any tasks before the journey. The instructions address the following topics:

keys registration calculating the payload correct loading of the vehicle and bike rack load rack towing retracting and extending the entrance step storing the television storing the sink cover securing add-on parts using snow chains

At the end of the chapter there is a checklist which once again summarises the most important points.

3.1 Keys The following keys are included with your vehicle: Two keys for

ignition lock fuel tank

Two keys for

driver's door conversion door of the body drinking water filler neck external flaps

Always deposit a replacement key outside the vehicle. Make a note of the key number. Our authorised dealers and workshops can offer assistance in case of loss.

3.2 Registration Your motorhome is a vehicle which must be registered. Observe national reg- ulations on registration. Please remember that certain countries require a separate national code sticker in addition to the EU plate.

18 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey3

3.3 Payload

On loading, make sure that the payload's centre of gravity is as low as possible (directly above the floor of the vehicle). Otherwise this may affect the driving characteristics of the vehicle.

3.3.1 Terms

Maximum permissible gross weight in a laden

condition

The maximum permissible gross weight in a laden condition is the weight that a vehicle may never exceed. The maximum permissible overall weight in laden condition consists of the mass in ready-to-drive condition and of the payload. In the vehicle documents, the manufacturer has specified the maximum per- missible gross weight in a laden condition.

Permitted mass The permitted mass is the weight specified by the manufacturer for issuing the type approval. The permitted mass must never exceed the maximum permis- sible gross weight of the loaded vehicle.

Overloading the vehicle and wrong tyre pressure can cause tyres to burst. You can lose control of the vehicle. Only the maximum permissible gross weight and the mass in a ready-to- drive condition, not the actual weight of the vehicle, is stated in the vehicle documents. For your own safety, we recommend that you have your loaded vehicle (with all passengers, luggage and personal objects) weighed on a public weighbridge before you set out on your journey. Adapt the speed to the payload. The stopping distance is increased if the payload is high.

Do not exceed the maximum permissible gross weight stated in the vehicle documents by the payload. Built-in accessories and special equipment reduce the payload. Adhere to the axle load stated in the vehicle documents.

Description Load (kg)

Maximum permitted payloads

Pull-down bed 200

Bunk bed 100

Roof load 200

Rear garage and rear storage space 200

Storage compartment, extendable 40

Bike rack Double 60

Triple 60

Load rack (AL-KO) 150

Load rack (SAWIKO) 130

Technically speaking, the term "mass" has now replaced the term "weight". However, "weight" is still the term more frequent in common use. For better understanding, "mass" is therefore only used in the following sections for fixed formulations. All specifications according to EU norm DIN EN 1646-2.

19I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey 3

Mass in ready-to-drive condition

The mass in ready-to-drive condition is the weight of the ready-to-drive standard vehicle. The mass in ready-to-drive condition is made up as follows:

Unladen weight (mass of the empty vehicle) with factory-installed standard equipment Driver's weight Basic equipment weight

Unladen weight includes lubricants such as oils and coolants which have been filled, the on-board tool set, the spare wheel and a fuel tank which has been filled up to 90 %. 75 kg are calculated for the weight of the driver, regardless of how much the driver really weighs. Basic equipment includes all equipment and fluids required for safe and proper vehicle use. The weight of the basic equipment includes:

Water system filled up to 90 % (water tank and pipes) Gas bottles filled up to 90 % A full heating system The power cables for the 230 V power supply A full toilet flushing system The installation kit for an auxiliary battery if an auxiliary battery can be used

The waste water and sewage tanks are empty.

In the vehicle documents, the manufacturer specifies the mass in ready-to- drive conditions.

Payload The payload is made up as follows:

Conventional load Additional equipment Personal equipment

You will find explanations on the individual components of the payload in the following text.

Conventional load The conventional load is the weight specified by the manufacturer for the pas- sengers. Conventional load means: 75 kg are calculated for every seat specified by the manufacturer, regardless of how much the passengers actually weigh. The driver's seat is already included as part of the mass in ready-to-drive condition and must not be calculated as part of the conventional load. In the vehicle documents, the manufacturer specifies the number of seats.

Example for calculating the basic equipment

Water tank with 120 l 120 kg

Gas bottles (2 x 11 kg gas + 2 x 14 kg bottle) + 50 kg

Boiler with 12 l + 12 kg

230 V power cable + 4 kg

Installation kit for auxiliary battery + 20 kg

Total = 206 kg

The vehicle's payload can be increased by reducing the weight in a ready- to-drive condition. To do this, it is allowed for example to empty the fluid containers or to remove the gas bottles.

20 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey3

Additional equipment Additional equipment includes accessories and special equipment. Examples of additional equipment include:

Caravan coupling Roof rail Awning Bike or motorcycle rack Satellite unit Microwave oven

Chapter 15 lists the weights of the various items of special equipment; they may also be obtained from the manufacturer.

Personal equipment Personal equipment includes all items in the vehicle that are not included in the conventional load or in the additional equipment. For example, personal equipment can include the following:

Foodstuffs Crockery Television Radio Clothes Bedding Toys Books Toiletries

No matter where kept, personal equipment also includes:

Animals Bikes Boats Surfboards Sports equipment

For the personal equipment, according to the applicable regulations, the man- ufacturer must use a minimum weight that is determined according to the fol- lowing formula:

Formula Minimum weight M (kg) = 10 x N + 10 x L

Explanation N = maximum number of people including the driver, as stated by the manu- facturer L = total length of the vehicle in metres

3.3.2 Calculating the payload

The payload calculation at the factory is partly based on all-inclusive weights. For safety reasons, the maximum permissible gross weight in a laden condition must not be exceeded. Only the maximum permissible gross weight and the mass in a ready-to- drive condition, not the actual weight of the vehicle, is stated in the vehicle documents. For your own safety, we recommend that you have your loaded vehicle (with all passengers, luggage and personal objects) weighed on a public weighbridge before you set out on your journey.

21I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey 3

The payload (see section 3.3.1) is the difference in weight between

Maximum permissible gross weight in a laden condition and Vehicle mass complete in a ready-to-drive condition.

The calculation of the payload from the difference between the maximum per- missible gross weight in laden condition and the mass specified by the manu- facturer in ready-to-drive condition is however only a theoretical value. Only if the vehicle is weighed with full tanks (fuel and water), full gas bottles and complete additional equipment on a public weighbridge, can the actual payload be determined. To do this, proceed as follows:

First only drive the vehicle on to the weighbridge with the front wheels and have it weighed. Then drive the vehicle on to the weighbridge with the back wheels and have it weighed.

The individual values give the current axle loads. These are important for the correct loading of the vehicle (see section 3.3.3). The sum of these values is the current weight of the vehicle. The actual payload is the difference between the maximum permissible gross weight in laden condition and the weighed vehicle weight. This can be used to determine the weight that remains for the personal equip- ment:

Determine the weight of the passengers and subtract it from the value for the actual payload.

The result is the weight that is permitted for the actual load of the personal equipment.

3.3.3 Loading the vehicle correctly

Mass in kg to be calculated

Calculation

Example for calculating the payload

Maximum permissible gross weight ac- cording to vehicle documents

3500

Vehicle mass in a ready-to-drive condi- tion, including basic equipment according to vehicle documents

- 3070

This results in a permissible payload of

430

Conventional load e.g.: 3 persons each weighing 75 kg

- 225

Additional equipment - 40

For the personal equipment this re- sults in

= 165

For safety reasons, never exceed the maximum permissible gross weight in a laden condition. Distribute the load evenly on the left and right sides of the vehicle.

22 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey3

Large storage spaces, such as the rear garage, also have room for heavy objects (e.g. motorcycle). This might mean that the axle load on the rear axle is exceeded. However, the individual axles may not be overloaded under any circum- stances. That is why it is important, at which distance to the axles the load is stored. To distribute the load correctly, you will need a scale, a tape measure, a cal- culator and some time. Two simple formulas are needed to calculate the effect of the weight of the load on the axles:

Formulas A x G : R = weight on the rear axle Weight on the rear axle G = weight on the front axle

Explanation A = distance between storage compartment and front axle in cm G = weight of the load in the storage compartment in kg R = wheelbase of the vehicle (distance between axles) in cm

Calculating axle loads: Multiply the distance between storage compartment and front axle (A) with the weight of the load in the storage compartment (G) and divide the result by the wheelbase (R). The result is the weight of the load in the storage compartment on the rear axle. Make a note of this weight and of the storage compartment. In a second step, subtract the weight in the storage compartment (G) from the weight calculated beforehand. If the result is a positive value (example 1), this means that the load on the front axle is reduced by this value. If the result is a negative value (example 2), this means that the load on the front axle is increased. Make a note of this value, too. Calculate all storage compartments of the vehicle in the same way. In a last step, add all weights calculated for the rear axle to the rear axle load and add (or subtract) all weights calculated for the front axle to (from) the front axle load. How to determine rear axle load and front axle load is described in section 3.3.2.

Distribute the load evenly on both axles. In doing so, observe the axle loads specified in the vehicle documents. Observe the permissible load- carrying capacity of the tyres (see chapter 13). Heavy loads behind the rear axle can reduce the load on the front axle due to the leverage effect ( ). This applies especially to long rear extensions, if a motorbike is transported on the rear carrier or if there is a heavy load in the rear storage space. The release of the front axle neg- atively affects the driving quality, especially for front-driven vehicles. Store all objects in such a way that they cannot slip. Store heavy objects (awning, tin cans, etc.) close to the axles. Low-lying storage compartments whose doors do not open in the direction of travel are particularly suited for storing heavy objects. Stack light objects (laundry) in the roof storage cabinets. Load the bike rack with bicycles only (max. three units).

Measure the external distances horizontally from the centre of the front wheel to the centre of the storage compartment or to the centre of the back wheel.

23I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey 3

If the calculated value exceeds the permissible axle load, the load must be dis- tributed in a different way. If the load on the front axle is too low, the grip of the tyres on the road is reduced (traction). This applies in particular to vehicles with front wheel drive. In this case, the load must be redistributed, too.

3.3.4 Roof rail and ladder (special equipment)

Example 1 Example 2

Example calculation Distance to the front axle A (A1) 450 (cm) (A2) 250 (cm)

Weight in the storage compartment G x 100 (kg) x 50 (kg)

Wheelbase of the vehicle R 325 (cm) 325 (cm)

Load on the rear axle (add to the axle load)

138.5 (kg) 38.5 (kg)

Weight in the storage compartment - 100 (kg) - 50 (kg)

Load relief to the front axle (subtract from the axle load)

38.5 (kg)

Load on the front axle (add to the axle load)

-11.5 (kg)

Access the roof only when a roof rail has been fitted. Take care when stepping onto the ladder. There is danger of slipping when the ladder is moist or icy. Take care when stepping onto the roof. There is danger of slipping when the roof is moist or icy. Do not overload the roof. Road behaviour and brake reaction deteriorate as the roof load increases.

If the vehicle is equipped with a roof rail, load racks can be mounted on the roof rail for roof loads (e.g. for surfboards, rubber boats or light canoes). Special girder systems are available as accessory. The authorised dealer or service centre will be happy to advise you. The maximum permissible roof load is 200 kg.

The maximum localised load is 90 kg/100 cm2. Before stepping on to the roof, extensively cover the area you will be treading on. Materials with a smooth or soft surface are suitable, for example, a thick polystyrene panel. Secure roof loads with tension belts. Do not use rubber expanders. Observe the overall height of the vehicle when the roof rack is loaded.

The driver's cabin should have a clearly visible notice stating the overall height. This eliminates the need for calculations at bridges and thorough- fares.

24 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey3

Climbing on to the roof (rear ladder):

Hook the lower part of the ladder (Fig. 1,1) in the part of the ladder (Fig. 1,2) which is fastened to the rear, and place it on the ground. Carefully climb the ladder.

Climbing on to the roof (telescopic ladder):

Carefully place the telescopic ladder (special equipment) against the side of the vehicle. Carefully climb the ladder.

3.3.5 Rear garage/rear storage space

Fig. 1 Rear ladder

Observe the permissible axle loads and maximum permissible gross weight when loading the rear garage/the rear storage space. The maximum permitted load of the rear garage/the rear storage space is 200 kg. Do not exceed the permissible rear axle load. Observe: If the rear garage or (depending on the model) the rear storage space is loaded to its maximum capacity, this will reduce the load on the front axle due to the levering action. The driving quality is impaired.

Depending on the vehicle equipment, clamping rails with clamping eyelets are mounted in the rear garage or in the rear storage space. Always secure loads onto the clamping eyelets. Always use tightening straps or lashing nets for securing the load, never rubber expanders. When clamping loads, always check that the clamping eyelets are placed tightly in the clamping rails. If the clamping eyelet is not anchored tightly in the clamping rail, the load may slide or loosen during forcible movements of the steering wheel or when braking. Distribute the load evenly. Excessive spot loads can lead to damages of the floor covering. Use the supporting system offered by your dealer if two-wheelers are trans- ported in the rear garage.

25I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey 3

3.3.6 Double floor

3.3.7 Extendable storage compartment

3.3.8 Bike rack (special equipment)

Observe the permissible axle loads and maximum permissible gross weight when loading the double floor.

Distribute the load evenly. Excessive spot loads can lead to damages of the floor covering.

The maximum permitted extendable storage compartment load is 40 kg.

Observe the permissible axle loads and maximum permissible gross weight when loading the bike rack. Bicycles may protrude at the side by a maximum of 40 cm, measured from the outer edge of the tail lights. However, a total width of 2.5 m must not be exceeded. Adjust the attachments for the bikes accordingly. The lateral overhang must be marked with a red flag. Load the bike rack with bicycles only (max. three units). Fasten bicycles using the straps provided and check to see that they are secure after you have driven a few kilometres. Check the secure attachment of the bicycles on the bike rack after the first 10 km and then at each break in the journey. Do not use the bike rack as luggage rack or ladder.

The bike rack is only to be used for transporting bicycles. The gross weight specified by the manufacturer must not be exceeded. The identification plate and rear lights must not be covered. The maximum permissible payload of the bike rack is 60 kg. When loading the bike rack, observe the centre of gravity. If the bike rack is only loaded with one bicycle, position the bicycle as closely as possible to the vehicle wall. Driving with a folded out bike rack without bicycles is not permitted. Before every journey, check: Is the bike rack without bicycles folded in correctly? Are the bicycles securely fastened to the bike rack using the bike rack belts?

26 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey3

Loading the bike rack with bicycles

When loading the bike rack, observe the centre of gravity. The centre of gravity of the bicycles must be as close as possible to the rear wall of the vehicle. The bike rack should always be loaded from the inside to the outside. Loading the bike rack correctly:

Depending on the model, fold the bike rack down or pull it out. Place the heaviest bicycle directly against the rear wall. Place the lightest bicycles in the centre or on the outside of the bike rack. Secure the front and rear wheels of each bicycle with the retaining straps on the bike rack. In addition, fasten the outermost bicycle depending on the model of the bike rack on the retaining clip or the retaining bracket and to the spacer respectively.

If the bike rack is only loaded with one bicycle, position the bicycle as closely as possible to the rear wall.

Bike rack, not lowerable

The bike rack (Fig. 2) can be used to transport a maximum of 3 bicycles com- fortably. The bike rack (Fig. 3) can be used to transport a maximum of 2 bicycles com- fortably.

Loading the bicycles: Fold the swivel clip down. Place the bicycles on top and secure them with quick straps. Fasten the spacer to the frame of the outermost bicycle.

3.3.9 Removable load rack AL-KO (special equipment)

Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 2 Bike rack, max. 3 bicycles Fig. 3 Bike rack, max. 2 bicycles

Do not exceed the rear axle load. Heavy loads behind the rear axle can reduce the load on the front axle due to the leverage effect ( ). This applies especially to long rear extensions, if a motorbike is transported on the rear carrier or if there is a heavy load in the rear storage space. The release of the front axle neg- atively affects the driving quality, especially for front-driven vehicles.

27I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey 3

The load rack permits transport of a load (e.g. a motorcycle or a motor scooter) weighing up to 150 kg. Always remove the load rack after use.

Installation: Apply the handbrake. Insert the supports on the left and on the right into the holders on the frame and secure them with a quick closure (Fig. 4,1). Connect the electrics between the load rack and the vehicle.

Removal: Apply the handbrake. Disconnect the electrics between the load rack and the vehicle. Open the quick closure (Fig. 4,1) and pull the support from the holders on the frame.

3.3.10 Load rack SAWIKO (special equipment)

Always make sure to store the load roadworthy and secure it against falling. The load may not jut out beyond the maximum width of the vehicle. The lighting and the official licence plate on the load rack may not be covered by the load.

The load rack and caravan coupling may not be used simultaneously.

The load rack has a EG type approval number. Have your dealer or service centre install the load rack. Observe the country-specific regulations. Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 4 Quick closure

Do not exceed the rear axle load. Heavy loads behind the rear axle can reduce the load on the front axle due to the leverage effect ( ). This applies especially to long rear extensions, if a motorbike is transported on the rear carrier or if there is a heavy load in the rear storage space. The release of the front axle neg- atively affects the driving quality, especially for front-driven vehicles.

28 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey3

The load rack permits transport of a load weighing up to 130 kg. For the trans- port of the load different attachments are available. They are e.g. bike rack or a transport box. Our authorised dealers and service centres will be happy to advise you.

The load rack (Fig. 5) permits transport of a motorcycle or a motor scooter weighing up to 130 kg.

Scope of delivery The following parts belong to the scope of delivery:

Rack trough (Fig. 5,3) and retaining clip (Fig. 5,1) with attachment to vehicle (Fig. 6) Rear lights (Fig. 5,4) Vehicle licence plate light (Fig. 5,5) 13-pole Jger System plug Ramp (Fig. 5,2)

Attachment to vehicle The two side members (Fig. 6,1) of the load rack are fixed to the floor of the vehicle by means of tommy screws (Fig. 6,2) on the square drives (Fig. 6,4). The load rack is secured by a bolt (Fig. 6,3) with locking ring.

Entry in the vehicle documents

Have your dealer or service centre install the add-on parts. They will also take care of all the formalities for you.

Always make sure to store the load roadworthy and secure it against falling. The load may not jut out beyond the maximum width of the vehicle. The lighting and the official licence plate on the load rack may not be covered by the load.

The load rack and caravan coupling may not be used simultaneously.

An entry must be made in the vehicle documents in order to attach a load rack. The required documents are enclosed with the load rack. Have your dealer or service centre install the load rack. Observe the country-specific regulations. Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 5 Load rack Fig. 6 Attachment to vehicle

29I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey 3

3.4 Towing

3.5 Caravan coupling (special equipment)

Entry in the vehicle documents

Have your dealer or service centre install the add-on parts. They will also take care of all the formalities for you.

Care is to be taken when connecting and detaching a trailer. Risk of acci- dent and injury! No persons are to be between the towing vehicle and the trailer during positioning for connecting and detaching. Observe the permissible nose weight and rear axle load of the towing vehicle. Nose weight and rear axle load must not be exceeded. The values of the nose weight and rear axle load are included in the docu- ments of the vehicle and the caravan coupling.

Trailer with an overrun brake: Do not connect or detach trailer with the overrun brake on. Caravan coupling with detachable ball neck: If the ball neck is mounted incorrectly, there is the danger of the trailer breaking away. Observe the instruction manual for the caravan coupling.

When mounting a caravan coupling, see the vehicle documents for infor- mation on maximum nose weight and caravan load. Retighten the caravan coupling fixing screws after 1000 operating hours.

The load rack and caravan coupling may not be used simultaneously.

An entry must be made in the vehicle documents in order to attach a car- avan coupling. The required documents are enclosed with the caravan coupling. Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 7 Caravan coupling

30 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey3

3.6 Entrance step (partially special equipment)

The vehicles have an electrically extendable entrance step.

Before stepping on the entrance step, fully extend it (Fig. 8).

Extending: Press the rocker button (Fig. 9,1) down and hold it pressed (at least 3 seconds) until the entrance step has extended completely.

Retracting: Press the rocker button (Fig. 9,1) up until the entrance step has retracted completely.

Before commencing the journey and after short interruptions of the journey, ensure that the entrance step is completely retracted. Do not stand in the direct range of the entrance step while it is being retracted or extended. Do not step on the entrance step until it has extended completely. There is a risk of injury. Do not under any circumstances raise or lower persons or loads with the entrance step.

Take note of the different step heights and make certain that the ground is firm and even when exiting. Do not grease or lubricate the pivot bearing and joints of the entrance step (see chapter 11).

The button to operate the entrance step is located on the inside of the vehicle in the area of the conversion door. If the entrance step is not retracted and locked in place correctly, a red indi- cator lamp lights up on the dashboard when the ignition is switched on. Follow the warning notice on the entrance step.

Fig. 8 Warning notice for entrance step

Fig. 9 Operating button for entrance step

31I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey 3

When the ignition is switched on and the entrance step is extended, an indi- cator lamp (Fig. 10,1) is illuminated on the dashboard.

3.7 Television (special equipment)

3.8 Sink and drain basin covers

Fig. 10 Indicator lamp

Before commencing the journey, remove the television from the support and store it securely. Before commencing the journey, place and secure the flat screen and screen support in the initial position. If the screen holder is installed in a TV cabinet: Close TV cabinet. Before commencing the journey, ensure that the antenna is in park posi- tion. Danger of accidents! Park position means: The antenna points towards the back, is fully lowered and is locked in this position.

If there is a risk of frost, do not leave the flat screen television in the vehicle.

Further information on positioning the flat screen can be obtained from chapter 6.

In the event of an accident or emergency braking, the loose sink (Fig. 11,1) and drain basin covers could injure the occupants of the vehicle. Before commencing the journey, take the loose covers off and store them securely in the kitchen unit or wardrobe.

Fig. 11 Sink cover

32 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey3

3.9 Securing add-on parts

Add-on parts are, for example, inner doors or partition walls. See section 6.3 for furniture flaps.

Securing add-on parts: Secure doors or partition walls (Fig. 12,1) with the locks or means of securing provided.

3.10 Snow chains (special equipment)

The use of snow chains is subject to the legal regulations of the individual countries.

Always mount snow chains to the drive wheels. After a few metres, check the tension of the snow chains.

In the event of an accident or emergency braking, loose add-on parts could injure the occupants of the vehicle. Before setting off, secure loose add-on parts in the holders provided or stow them in a secure place inside the vehicle.

Unsecured flaps and doors can spring open during the journey and damage parts of the interior. Secure all flaps and doors before setting off.

Fig. 12 Shower partition

Only mount snow chains if there is a clearance of at least 50 mm between the tyres and the vehicle body. When using snow chains, the tyres, wheel suspension and steering are subjected to an additional load. When using snow chains, drive slowly (maximum speed 50 km/h) and only on streets which are completely cov- ered with snow. Otherwise the vehicle could be damaged. Observe the fitting instructions issued by the manufacturer of the snow chains. Do not fit snow chains on alloy wheel rims.

If the drive axle of the vehicle has twin tyres (2 tyres next to each other), mount the the snow chains to the outer tyres.

33I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey 3

3.11 Road safety

Before commencing the journey, work through the checklist:

Check tyre pressure before a journey or every 2 weeks. Wrong tyre pressure causes excessive wear and can lead to damage or even to tyre burst. You can lose control of the vehicle.

No. Checks Checked

Base vehicle 1 All vehicle documents are on board

2 Tyres in proper condition

3 Vehicle lighting, brake lights and reversing lights function

4 Oil levels for engine, gearbox and power steering controlled

5 Coolant and fluid for windscreen washers filled up

6 Brakes function

7 Brakes react evenly

8 When braking, the vehicle remains in the lane

Housing body, outside 9 Awning completely retracted

10 Roof free of snow and ice (in winter)

11 External connections and lines disconnected and stored away

12 External supports removed

13 Fitted supports retracted and fixed in place

14 Wheel chocks removed and stored away

15 Entrance step retracted (observe indicator lamp)

16 External flaps closed and locked

17 Rear conversion door closed

18 Overall height of the vehicle including roof rack when loaded measured and noted. Keep the height information close at hand in the driver's cabin

Housing body, inside 19 Windows and skylights closed and locked

20 Television securely stored

21 Flat screen secured

22 Television antenna retracted (if one is built in)

23 Loose parts and add-on parts stored away or fixed in position

24 Open storage spaces empty

25 No gas cartridges or other easily flammable materials stored in the roof cupboard of the awning light

26 Store sink and drain basin covers securely

27 Refrigerator door secured

28 Refrigerator set to 12 V operation

29 All drawers and flaps closed

30 All doors secured

34 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Before the journey3

31 Pull-down bed secured

32 Children's seats mounted to seats with three-point safety belts

33 Swivel seat locking device for driver's seat and front passen- ger's seat locked

34 Shades in the driver's cabin opened and secured

Gas system 35 Gas bottles firmly fixed in the gas bottle compartment so that they are unable to turn

36 If the gas bottles are not connected to the gas tube, always place the protective cap on top

37 Regulator tap on the gas bottle and gas isolator taps are closed

Electrical system 38 Check the battery voltage of the starter and living area battery (see chapter 8). If the panel indicates that the battery voltage is too low, the respective battery will need to be recharged. Observe the notes and instructions in chapter 8

Commence journey with fully charged starter and living area batteries.

No. Checks Checked

35I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey 4

4During the journeyChapter overview This chapter contains instructions on how to drive the motorhome. The instructions address the following topics:

the parking distance control reversing camera with LCD monitor driving speed brakes seat belts child restraint system seats and headrests seating arrangement electrical window winders electrically adjustable and heatable external mirrors Roman shades in the driver's cabin bonnet washer nozzles windscreen washer fluid container filling the tank

4.1 Driving the motorhome

The base vehicle is a commercial vehicle (small truck). Adjust your driving technique accordingly. Before commencing the journey and after short interruptions of the journey, ensure that the entrance step is completely retracted. During the journey, seat belts should always be worn at the seats that have seat belts mounted. Never open your seat belts when travelling. Passengers must remain in the seats provided. The doors must remain locked. Avoid braking with a jerk. If a navigation system is used, only change the destination when the vehicle is stationary. Drive to a car park or stop in a safe area when changing the destination. Do not play DVDs using the monitor of the navigation system during the journey.

Drive slowly on poor roads. Take extreme care when driving onto ferries, crossing uneven roads and driving in reverse. Because of the relatively large overhang, larger vehicles might swing out and "touch ground" in unfavourable conditions. This can cause damage to the underbody or to parts fitted there.

If an accident occurs as a result of these instructions not being observed, the manufacturer will not be responsible for damages caused. The safety measures stipulated in chapter 2 have to be observed.

36 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey4

4.2 Parking distance control Park Boy V (special equipment)

Short description The parking distance control serves as an aid for parking. The distance to pos- sible obstacles is measured using the ultrasound echo sounder method. Four sensors at the rear of vehicle send ultrasound signals and the distance to the obstacle is measured according to the time taken by the reflected ultrasound signals. In the passenger compartment, a display unit (Fig. 13) shows the distance to the obstacle. At the same time, an acute signal sounds as a warning. The sensors and display unit are linked by radio.

If a reversing camera is installed in the vehicle, the camera is automatically switched on when driving in reverse gear. If the vehicle is equipped with the automatic transmission Comfort-Matic from Fiat, please note the following: The acoustic signal described in the instruction manual for Comfort-Matic is not active in our vehicles. No warning tone will sound.

Be particularly careful when driving backwards. Risk of accident and injury. The parking distance control is only an auxiliary appliance and may not necessarily recognise all obstacles. The driver of the vehicle is respon- sible for safety. If the device fails or there is a malfunction and damage occurs, then claims cannot be asserted against the vehicle manufac- turer. Soil deposits, ice, snow and exhaust fumes can prevent the parking dis- tance control from working properly. Only if you drive slowly (at inching speed) will a warning be emitted in time. Obstacles above or below the sensor measurement area will be ignored (e.g. projecting load ramps). Precipitous embankments or road edges (e.g. quay walls) are ignored.

Reflections from the road (a change of surface, irregularities) can some- times trigger false alarms. This is not due to an error in the parking distance control.

Fig. 13 Park Boy V display unit

1 STOP symbol 2 Distance display in cm (in 5 cm inter-

vals) 3 Distance to the obstacle (graphical

display) 4 On/Off button for the sensors at the

rear of the vehicle 5 Without function

37I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey 4

Activation by engaging reverse:

Switch on the ignition and start the motor. Engage reverse. The display illuminates and the vehicle symbol appears in the display. The parking distance control is ready to measure.

Activation by pressing the On/Off button on the display

unit:

Press the On/Off button (Fig. 13,4). The display illuminates and the vehicle symbol appears in the display. The parking distance control is ready to measure.

Switching off: Press the On/Off button (Fig. 13,4). The parking distance control can be switched off at all times independent of the selected switch-on method using the On/Off key.

Distance display The distance between the vehicle and the obstacle is issued in three ways: The display (Fig. 13) shows the distance in steps of 5 cm. The shortest dis- tance measured by a sensor is shown. Black measurement field blocks in the graphical distance display show an obstacle approaching. In addition to the visual displays, an acoustic signal (melody) is emitted that changes according to the distance. As the distance between the vehicle and the obstacle grows shorter, so the length of time between the signals shortens until it becomes one continuous sound.

When you switch on the ignition, the parking distance control runs a self- test. If a sensor is defective, this is indicated on the display by rapid flashing of the sensor position. The parking distance control continues to function, with the exception of the defective sensor. If the radio connection is faulty, this will be indicated on the display by means of a transmission mast symbol. Distance measurement is then not possible. When reverse gear is disengaged, the transmission mast symbol is also briefly displayed.

Further information can be obtained in the device manufacturer's instruc- tion manual.

38 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey4

4.3 Reversing camera (partially special equipment)

Depending on the equipment, a reversing camera (Fig. 14,1 or Fig. 15,1) with LCD monitor (Fig. 16,1) is installed in the vehicle.

When it is dark, the infrared LEDs of the reversing camera (Fig. 15,1) illumi- nate the field of view. If the engine is running or the ignition is switched on, the reversing camera and LCD monitor switch themselves on automatically when you engage reverse. If the engine is running or the ignition is switched on, the reversing camera and LCD monitor can also be switched on manually via a pushbutton or a switch on the display. The system can also be switched off via a pushbutton or the "OFF" button on the display.

Depending on the model, different monitor systems can be installed in the vehicle. The function of the reversing camera is the same way for all sys- tems.

Fig. 14 Reversing camera (example) Fig. 15 Reversing camera with infrared illumination

Fig. 16 LCD monitor for reversing camera (example)

Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.

39I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey 4

4.4 Driving speed

4.5 Brakes

Before each journey Before each journey, check by means of a braking test:

Do the brakes function? Do the brakes react evenly? Does the vehicle remain in the lane when braking?

4.6 Seat belts The vehicle is equipped with seat belts in the living area on the seats for which seat belts are compulsory by law. National regulations apply seat-belt fas- tening.

The vehicle is equipped with a powerful engine. This means there are sufficient reserves in difficult traffic situations. This high power enables a high maximum speed and requires above-average driving ability. The vehicle provides a large contact surface for wind. A sudden cross- wind can be especially dangerous. Uneven or one-sided loading affects road performance. Driving on unknown streets, you may encounter hazardous road condi- tions and unexpected driving situations. Therefore, in the interest of safety, make sure your driving speed is appropriate to any given driving situation and environment. Adhere to the national legal speed limits.

Have defects on the braking system immediately remedied by an author- ised specialist workshop.

Avoid block brakings. Block braking gives the tyres "brake plates" of var- ying strength. This reduces driving comfort. It might even make the tyres unserviceable.

Fasten your seat belts before the beginning of the journey and keep them fastened during the journey. Do not damage or trap belts. Have damaged seat belts changed by an authorised specialist workshop. Do not alter the belt fixing devices, automatic seat belt winders and the belt clips. Inspect the screwed connections of the seat belts from time to time in order to ensure that they are correctly seated. Only use one seat belt for one adult person. Do not belt in objects together with persons. Seat belts are not sufficient for persons who are less than 150 cm tall. In these cases use additional restraining devices. Observe test certificate. Factory-set three-point safety belts must be used when attaching child restraint systems.

40 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey4

4.6.1 Fastening the seat belt correctly

The seat belt is fastened correctly when a fist can be passed between the body and the seat belt.

4.7 Child restraint systems

Child restraint systems are divided into five classes:

4.8 Pilot seats for the driver's and front passenger's seats

After an accident, replace the seat belts. During the journey, do not tilt the backrest too far backwards. Otherwise the functionality of the seat belt is no longer guaranteed.

Do not twist the belt. The belt must be positioned smoothly against the body. When fastening the seat belt, adopt the correct sitting position.

When travelling, secure children under 13 years of age that are smaller than 150 cm, with a suitable and officially approved child restraint system. Factory-set three-point safety belts must be used when attaching child restraint systems. Fasten the childrens' seat belts before commencing the journey and make sure that their seat belts are kept fastened during the journey. If a front passenger airbag is fitted in the vehicle, do not use a child restraint system (Reboard systems) that faces the back of the front pas- senger's seat. Follow warning notices in the vehicle.

Class Body weight Approximate age

0 Up to 10 kg Up to 9 months

0+ Up to 13 kg Up to 18 months

I 9 kg to 18 kg 9 months to 4 years

II 15 kg to 25 kg 3 years to 7 years

III 22 kg to 36 kg 6 years to 12 years

Before commencing the journey, rotate all swivel seats in the direction of travel and lock in position. The seats must remain fixed in position during the journey and are not to be rotated.

Before rotating the seats in the pitched vehicle, always apply the hand- brake.

41I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey 4

4.8.1 Seats (Aguti)

Rotating seats The seats can be rotated in any direction. The seats can only be locked in posi- tion in the direction of travel.

Push both armrests upward. Push the driver's seat/front passenger's seat backwards or into the central position. Operate the release lever (Fig. 17,3). The latch is released. Rotate the seat.

Adjusting the armrest The height of the armrests is infinitely adjustable.

Turn the knurled wheel (Fig. 17,2) upwards or downwards.

Adjusting an appropriate seating position

The position of the driver's and front passenger's seats can be adjusted. The handles which are required for this purpose are positioned to the front, right or left of the seat.

Pull the handle (Fig. 17,1). The seat can be moved forward or backward. Release handle. The seat runner automatically locks into the desired posi- tion. Turn the knurled knob (Fig. 17,4). The angle of the backrest can be adjusted.

4.8.2 Seats (Aguti-Liner)

Rotating the seat The seats can be rotated in any direction. The seats can only be locked in posi- tion in the direction of travel.

Fig. 17 Driver's seat and front pas- senger's seat

1 Lengthways adjustment 2 Armrest adjustment 3 Rotating 4 Backrest adjustment

Fig. 18 Seat adjustment Fig. 19 Armrest adjustment

42 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey4

Push both armrests upward. Slide seat forward. Operate the release lever (Fig. 18,3). The latch is released. Rotate the seat.

Moving seat in lengthways direction

Adjust the driver's seat so that the driver can depress the pedals comfortably.

Pull the bar (Fig. 18,1) upwards. Push the seat forwards or backwards. Release the bar. The seat must audibly lock into place.

Setting the seat inclination

Adjust the seat inclination so that the thighs rest on the seat surface without any pressure.

Pull the lever (Fig. 18,2) upwards. Bring the seat into the desired inclination position by applying or relieving pressure. Release the lever. The seat must audibly lock into place.

Adjusting the backrest Adjust the angle of the backrest so that the steering wheel can be held with the arms slightly bent.

Turn the knurled knob (Fig. 18,4). The backrest inclines forwards or back- wards, depending on the rotation direction.

Adjusting the armrest The height of the armrests can be steplessly adjusted.

Turn the knurled wheel (Fig. 19,1). The armrest inclines upwards or down- wards, depending on the rotation direction.

4.9 Headrests

Before commencing the journey, adjust the headrests (Fig. 20,1) or the head- rest (Fig. 21,1) so that the back of the head is supported at approximately ear height. Push the headrests upwards or downwards by hand.

The headrests are not adjustable for all models.

Fig. 20 Bench headrest Fig. 21 Bench headrest (alternative)

43I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey 4

4.10 Seating arrangement

Seats which may be used during travel are equipped with a sticker (Fig. 22).

4.11 Electrical window winders (partially special equipment)

There is an electrical window winder on the driver's side of the vehicle.

Opening: Press lower part of the switch (Fig. 23,2).

Closing: Press upper part of the switch (Fig. 23,1).

During the journey, persons are only to sit on the permitted seats. The authorised number of seats is stipulated in the vehicle documents. During the journey sitting on the divans is not permitted. Seat belts must be worn by all passengers.

Fig. 22 "Seat" symbol

Remove hands and other objects from the window before closing. Even if you leave your vehicle just briefly, remove the ignition key from the steering lock. Otherwise children may be able to operate the window winder and injure themselves.

Fig. 23 Switch for electrical window winders

44 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey4

4.12 External mirrors

Depending on the model or equipment, the vehicle is equipped with two elec- trically adjustable and heated external mirrors (Fig. 24,1). The switch used to adjust the external mirrors is located on the driver's door or on the left of the dashboard.

Adjusting the external mirrors:

Select the external mirror to be adjusted. To do so, turn the rotary switch (Fig. 25,2 or Fig. 26,1) to the left or right. Press the switch (Fig. 25,2 or Fig. 26,1) in the appropriate direction.

Switching on the external mirror heater:

Press the switch (Fig. 25,1) on the dashboard. The switch indicator lamp shows it is in operation.

4.13 Roman shades for windscreen, driver's window and front passenger's window

Fig. 24 External mirrors

Fig. 25 External mirror adjustment and heater switch

Fig. 26 External mirror adjustment switch

While travelling, the Roman shades for the windscreen, driver's window and front passenger's window must be open, in a fixed position and secured.

45I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey 4

Opening and closing: Grasp the handle (Fig. 27,1) of the Roman shade and slide to the left or the right.

Securing: Push the handle (Fig. 28,1) onto the cap. The Roman shade is secured.

4.14 Bonnet

Opening: Pull the lever (Fig. 29,1) on the left under the dashboard. Move the bonnet in an arch forwards and upwards.

Closing: Move the bonnet in an arch downwards and backwards until the latch locks audibly in place. Check whether the bonnet is locked correctly. In order to carry this out, pull on the bonnet.

Fig. 27 Roman shade Fig. 28 Lock for Roman shade

When the bonnet is open, there is a risk of injury in the engine compart- ment. Even if the engine was switched off some time ago, it might still be hot. Danger of burns! Do not work in the engine compartment while the engine is running. The bonnet must be kept firmly closed and locked during the journey. After closing, check whether the lock has engaged. In order to carry this out, pull on the bonnet.

Fig. 29 Release lever for the bonnet (inside the vehicle)

46 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey4

4.15 Washer nozzles

The vehicle has washer nozzles with an adjustable angle of spray.

Adjusting: Use a suitable screwdriver to turn the adjusting screw (Fig. 30,1) until you reach the desired position.

4.16 Filliing with washer fluid

Unlock and open the bonnet. Push the handle (Fig. 31,2) down and keep it pressed. Pull the flexible hose (Fig. 31,4) to the front and out of the holder (Fig. 31,3). Remove the lid (Fig. 31,1) from the filler neck of the washer fluid container. Twist the flexible hose in a way so that the filling hole points upwards (Fig. 32). Slowly fill in washer fluid. Push the lid onto the filler neck of the washer fluid container. Push the flexible hose back into the holder and lock it into place.

Fig. 30 Washer nozzle

Fig. 31 Washer fluid container filler neck

Fig. 32 Filler neck in filling position

47I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey 4

4.17 Filling up with diesel

The fuel filler neck is situated on the exterior of the vehicle, at the front left.

Opening: Insert the key in the locking cylinder (Fig. 33,1) and turn it in an anticlock- wise direction. Remove cap.

Closing: Place the cap on the fuel filler neck. Turn key in a clockwise direction. Remove the key. Check that the cap is fastened securely on the fuel filler neck.

No appliance operated by a naked flame (e.g. heater or refrigerator) may be in operation when filling the tank, on ferries or in the garage. Danger of explosion! The cap for the fuel filler neck and for the drinking water filler neck are very similar. Before filling the tank, always check the label.

The fuel filler neck is labelled with the word "Diesel".

Fig. 33 Cap for the fuel filler neck

48 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

During the journey4

49I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Pitching the motorhome 5

5Pitching the motorhomeChapter overview This chapter contains instructions on how to pitch the vehicle. The instructions address the following topics:

handbrake entrance step ramps wheel chocks operation of the supports 230 V connection refrigerator aligning the antenna retracting and extending the awning

5.1 Handbrake Firmly apply the handbrake when parking the vehicle.

5.2 Entrance step In order to exit the vehicle, first fully extend the entrance step. Observe the indicator lamp on the dashboard. For operating the entrance step, see section 3.6.

5.3 Ramps

To enable the vehicle to be parked on the level, ramps can be used for height compensation when the vehicle is parked on a hill or on uneven ground.

5.4 Wheel chocks When parking the vehicle on slopes or inclines use the wheel chocks. If the maximum permissible gross weight of the vehicle exceeds 4 tonnes, wheel chocks must be used when parking on gradients. The wheel chocks are provided as standard for vehicles with a maximum permissible gross weight exceeding 4 tonnes.

Pitch the vehicle so that it is as horizontal as possible. Use ramps where necessary. Otherwise, the water from the shower tray will not be able to drain properly. Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling. Animals (especially mice) can cause great damage to the interior of the vehicle. To prevent this from happening, regularly check the vehicle for damages or animal traces after pitching.

Ramps are not included in the scope of delivery. Different models are avail- able from accessory shops.

50 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Pitching the motorhome5

5.5 Supports 5.5.1 General instructions

5.5.2 Steady legs (SAWIKO) (special equipment)

In order to ensure their correct function, clean and grease the interior tubes of the steady legs regularly. The length of the steady legs can be adjusted according to the model.

Extending: Place the socket spanner on the hexagon nut (Fig. 34,1) and rotate until the steady leg is in a perpendicular downward position. If the length of the steady leg can be adjusted, remove the splint (Fig. 34,4) out of the support foot extension (Fig. 34,5). Pull out the support foot extension until it has reached the required length. Insert the splint in the support foot extension. Rotate the hexagonal nut until the steady leg rests completely on the ground and the vehicle is in a horizontal position.

Retracting: Place the socket spanner on the hexagon nut (Fig. 34,1) and rotate until the steady leg is clear of the ground. If the length of the steady leg can be adjusted, remove the splint (Fig. 34,4) out of the support foot extension (Fig. 34,5).

Do not use the fitted supports as a vehicle jack. They supports are only for stabilising the parked vehicle to prevent the rear axle from bottoming out. When pitching the vehicle, ensure that the supports are evenly loaded. Before driving away, wind up the supports as far as they can go, fully retract and secure them.

When the ground is soft, place a pad or block under the supports in order to prevent the vehicle from sinking into the ground. Pitch the vehicle so that it is as horizontal as possible. Otherwise, the water from the shower tray will not be able to drain properly.

Depending on the model, the hexagonal nut has a joint, which can be used to bring the attached socket spanner into a more convenient position for turning.

Fig. 34 Steady leg

51I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Pitching the motorhome 5

Push in the support foot extension (Fig. 34,5) and insert the splint (Fig. 34,4) in the drilled hole in the support foot extension. Rotate the hexagonal nut (Fig. 34,1) until the steady leg has swung upwards and the guide (Fig. 34,2) has reached the very end of the slot (Fig. 34,3).

5.5.3 Steady legs (AL-KO) (partially special equipment)

In order to ensure their correct function, clean and grease the interior tubes of the steady legs regularly. The length of the steady legs can be adjusted according to the model.

Extending: Place the socket spanner on the hexagon nut (Fig. 35,1) and rotate until the steady leg is in a perpendicular downward position. Remove the splint (Fig. 35,4) out of the support foot extension (Fig. 35,5). Extend the support foot extension until it has reached the required length. Insert the splint in the support foot extension. Rotate the hexagonal nut until the steady leg rests completely on the ground and the vehicle is in a horizontal position.

Retracting: Place the socket spanner on the hexagon nut (Fig. 35,1) and rotate until the steady leg is clear of the ground. Remove the splint (Fig. 35,4) out of the support foot extension (Fig. 35,5). Push in the support foot extension (Fig. 35,5) and insert the splint (Fig. 35,4) in the drilled hole in the support foot extension. Rotate the hexagonal nut (Fig. 35,1) with the socket spanner until the steady leg has swung upwards and the guide disc (Fig. 35,3) has com- pletely retracted into the notch (Fig. 35,2).

Before commencing the journey, observe the following: Are all steady legs and support foot extensions retracted completely and secured with the splint?

Depending on the model, the hexagonal nut has a joint, which can be used to bring the attached socket spanner into a more convenient position for turning.

Fig. 35 Steady leg

Before commencing the journey, observe the following: Are all steady legs and support foot extensions retracted completely and secured with the splint?

52 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Pitching the motorhome5

5.5.4 Electrical steady legs (AL-KO) (special equipment)

Button functions Preselection: steady leg left (Fig. 36,4) Preselection: steady leg right (Fig. 36,2) Retract steady leg (Fig. 36,1) Extend steady leg (Fig. 36,3) Control LED (Fig. 36,5)

Each time a button is pressed, the control LED (Fig. 36,5) flashes.

Always observe the electrical steady legs when extending or retracting them. When extending or retracting the steady legs, ensure that no one is in the vehicle. Risk of injury due to unexpected rolling motion.

Never extend the steady legs so far that the tyres of the vehicle are not in contact with the ground. This could damage the body and chassis and the brakes will not work. The steady legs are designed only to support the vehicle, not to level it. Steady legs need sufficient ground clearance to be able to fold out verti- cally.

The electrical steady legs can only be operated with the ignition switched off. If the remote control is not operated for two minutes after the controller has been activated, the controller automatically switches off. When a key on the remote control is pressed, the indicator lamp flashes. If the steady legs are extended and the ignition is switched on, a pulsating warning tone is heard. The warning tone stops after the ignition has been switched off.

Fig. 36 Remote control for electrical steady legs

Fig. 37 Electrical steady leg on vehicle

53I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Pitching the motorhome 5

Extending: Press the push button for approx. 2 seconds until a brief sound is emitted. The steady legs control is now activated. Press and hold the preselection button for the steady leg side (Fig. 36,2 or 4) for approx. 1 second. Within 2 seconds, press the "Extend steady leg" button (Fig. 36,3) and hold it until the support leg (Fig. 37,4) is touching the ground. Press the preselection button for the other steady leg side and repeat the procedure.

Retracting: Press the push button for approx. 2 seconds until a brief sound is emitted. The steady legs control is now activated. Press and hold the preselection button for the steady leg side (Fig. 36,2 or 4) for approx. 1 second. Within 2 seconds, press the "Retract steady leg" button (Fig. 36,1) and hold it until the support leg (Fig. 37,4) is fully retracted. Once the support leg is fully retracted, a control signal sounds. Press the preselection button for the other steady leg side and repeat the procedure.

Changing the remote control battery:

Remove the rear casing. Change the battery (CR2032). Observe the correct polarity ("+" to the out- side).

Emergency operation If the electric drive breaks down, the steady legs can be moved with the hand crank.

Extending/retracting: Press the securing bracket (Fig. 37,2) inwards. Push the motor (Fig. 37,3) in the direction indicated as far as it will go. Extend or retract the steady leg like a mechanical steady leg via the hex- agonal nut (Fig. 37,1).

When the fault has been rectified: Push the motor in the opposite direction of the arrow to its initial position. Pull out the securing bracket (Fig. 37,2) until it engages.

5.6 230 V connection The vehicle can be connected to a 230 V power supply (see chapter 8).

Do not extend the steady leg to the end position without it being in contact with the ground.

The battery must be changed if the control LED flashes more slowly or if it goes out.

Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.

54 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Pitching the motorhome5

5.7 Refrigerator

For units with an automatic power selection, the 12 V operation of the refriger- ator only functions in the automatic mode when the vehicle engine is running. When the vehicle engine is switched off, switch the refrigerator to 230 V oper- ation or gas operation.

5.8 Satellite unit (special equipment)

5.8.1 Equipment with automatic antenna alignment (Alden) The satellite unit is equipped with an automatic positioning unit. This automatic positioning unit ensures that the antennas are aligned accurately. The flat screen incorporates a digital receiver. The satellite unit is operated via remote control.

Setting up the unit: Switch on the television.

Press the key " " (Fig. 38,2) on the remote control. The satellite antenna repositions itself out of the park position and into search mode. When the unit finds the satellite, you will hear a signal tone. Use the memory buttons (Fig. 38,3) or the function buttons (Fig. 38,4) to set the required transmitter.

5.8.2 Equipment with semi-automatic antenna alignment (Alden) The satellite unit is equipped with a semi-automatic positioning unit.

If the refrigerator is set to 12 V operation, it will constantly consume cur- rent. Therefore, switch over to gas operation when the vehicle engine is not running, and the vehicle is not connected to the 230 V power supply.

Before commencing the journey, ensure that the antenna is in park posi- tion. Danger of accidents!

The vehicle must be still during the satellite search. Do not walk through the vehicle. Satellite reception is only possible, when the antenna is positioned in direct line of sight of the chosen satellite and the view is not blocked in any way. Further information can be obtained in the device manufacturer's instruc- tion manual.

Fig. 38 Remote control

55I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Pitching the motorhome 5

The flat screen incorporates a digital receiver. The satellite unit is operated via remote control.

Switching on the satellite unit:

Switch on the television.

Press the key " " (Fig. 39,2) on the remote control for the television. The unit switches to search mode. You will hear a continuous tone.

Press the key " " on the remote control for the antenna. The satellite antenna lifts out of the park position and moves to the last position entered. To switch to television reception on the TV remote control, press the TV button (Fig. 39,1). The signal tone will stop. An image will appear on the screen.

Setting up the antenna: Use the memory buttons (Fig. 39,3) on the TV remote control or the func- tion buttons (Fig. 39,4) to select the desired station.

On the remote control for the antenna, use the keys " " or " " to correct the angle of the antenna in accordance with the enclosed cards. Loosen antenna mast clamp. Turn antenna slowly. When the antenna finds the satellite, you will hear a signal tone. Optimise the reception by turning and tilting the antenna. Slightly retighten the antenna mast clamp.

Lowering the antenna for driving:

Loosen antenna mast clamp. Turn the antenna until the slot in the clamp and the slot in the antenna mast are congruent with each other.

Press the key " " on the remote control for the antenna. The satellite antenna moves into park position. Check whether the antenna is fully lowered and points to the rear of the vehicle. Slightly retighten the antenna mast clamp. Switch off the television.

5.8.3 Equipment with automatic antenna alignment (Oyster)

Fig. 39 Remote control for television

Before commencing the journey, ensure that the antenna is in park posi- tion. Danger of accidents!

56 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Pitching the motorhome5

The satellite unit is equipped with an automatic positioning unit. This automatic positioning unit ensures that the antennas are precisely aligned to the desired satellites. Operation is menu-controlled (TV screen) using the remote control.

Setting up the unit: Switch on the television. Use the mains switch to switch on the receiver. When the green LED on the receiver's infra-red receptor lights up, the receiver is ready to operate. Switch on the receiver with the remote control. The satellite antenna repo- sitions itself out of the park position and into search mode.

When the system finds the satellite, the selected TV programme appears auto- matically.

5.9 Awning (special equipment)

Advantages of the awning The advantages of an awning are:

The awning provides shade. The awning creates a covered vestibule and thus expands the space. The vehicle thus becomes more homelike.

Putting up the awning: Use the manual crank to open up the awning (Fig. 40,1). Set up the brackets (Fig. 40,2) when the awning is open.

The vehicle must be still during the satellite search. Do not walk through the vehicle. Satellite reception is only possible, when the antenna is positioned in direct line of sight of the chosen satellite and the view is not blocked in any way. Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Retract the awning in strong wind, rain or snow. In the case of light rain, shorten one of the support legs so that water can run off. Only retract the awning when the fabric is dry. When the awning must be retracted while the fabric is still wet: Extend the awning as soon as pos- sible, in order to dry out the fabric. Before retracting, remove leaves and coarse dirt from the awning.

Only use the awning for protection against the sun. Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 40 Awning

57I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

6LivingChapter overview This chapter contains instructions about living in the vehicle. The instructions address the following topics:

opening and closing the doors and flaps light switches light control adjusting the halogen spotlights positioning the television ventilation of the vehicle opening and closing the windows and blinds opening and closing the Roman shades in the driver's cabin opening and closing the skylights modifying the table surfaces converting tables the adjustment mechanism of the divan use of the beds

6.1 Conversion door and driver's door

6.1.1 Driver's door, outside (partially special equipment)

Opening: Insert the key into the locking cylinder (Fig. 41,1) and turn towards "Open" (Fig. 41,4) until the door is unlocked. Return the key to the central position and remove it. Pull on the handle (Fig. 41,3). The door is open.

Only drive with locked doors.

Locking the doors can prevent them from opening of their own accord, e.g. during an accident. Locked doors also prevent forced entry, e.g. when waiting at traffic lights. However, in an emergency, locked doors make it more difficult for helpers to enter the vehicle. When leaving the vehicle, always lock the doors.

Fig. 41 Door lock of driver's door, out- side

58 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

Locking: Insert the key into the locking cylinder (Fig. 41,1) and turn towards "Lock" (Fig. 41,2) until the door is locked. Return the key to the central position and remove it.

6.1.2 Driver's door, inside (partially special equipment)

Opening: Pull the door opening lever (Fig. 42,1). When this is done, the safety knob (Fig. 42,2) is automatically pressed upwards and the door lock is unlatched.

Locking: Close the door. Push the safety knob down (Fig. 42,2).

6.1.3 Conversion door, outside (Hartal M1)

Opening: Insert the key into locking cylinder (Fig. 43,1) and turn until the door lock is unlatched. Return the key to the central position and remove it. Pull on the handle (Fig. 43,2). The door is open.

Locking: Insert the key into locking cylinder (Fig. 43,1) and turn until the door lock is engaged. Return the key to the central position and remove it.

Fig. 42 Door lock of driver's door, inside

Fig. 43 Door lock of conversion door, outside

59I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

6.1.4 Conversion door, inside (Hartal M1)

Opening: Press lever (Fig. 44,2).

Locking: Push the sliding trap (Fig. 44,1) down.

6.1.5 Conversion door, outside (Hartal Premium) (partially special equipment)

Opening: Insert the key into locking cylinder (Fig. 45,1) and turn until the door lock is unlatched. Return the key to the central position and remove it. Pull on the handle (Fig. 45,2). The door is open.

Locking: Insert the key into locking cylinder (Fig. 45,1) and turn until the door lock is engaged. Return the key to the central position and remove it.

Fig. 44 Door lock of conversion door, inside, locked

Fig. 45 Door lock of conversion door, outside

60 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.1.6 Conversion door, inside (Hartal Premium) (partially special equipment)

Opening: Pull on the handle (Fig. 46,2). The door lock is unlatched.

Locking: Press the upper part of the handle (Fig. 46,2) in the direction of the recessed handle (Fig. 46,1).

6.1.7 Window of conversion door (Hartal Premium) (partially special equipment) The conversion door window is fitted with a Roman shade.

Closing: Grip the Roman shade (Fig. 47,2) in the middle of the holding bar (Fig. 47,1), pull it upwards and then release it at the desired height. The Roman shade will stay at this height.

Opening: Grip the Roman shade in the middle of the holding bar and push it down.

Fig. 46 Door lock of conversion door, inside

Fig. 47 Roman shade

61I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

6.1.8 Folding insect screen on the conversion door (partially special equipment)

Closing: Pull out the insect screen completely by the bar (Fig. 48,1).

Opening: Push the insect screen into its initial position by the bar (Fig. 48,1).

6.2 External flaps

The external flaps fitted to the vehicle are all fitted with identical locking cylin- ders. Therefore, all locks can be opened with a single key.

Open the insect screen completely before closing the conversion door.

Fig. 48 Insect screen

Before commencing the journey, close all external flaps and lock them. To open and close the external flap, open or close all locks that are fitted to the external flap.

When leaving the vehicle, close all external flaps.

62 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.2.1 Flap lock with recessed handle

Opening: Insert key into locking cylinder (Fig. 49,1) and turn a quarter turn. The flap lock is unlatched. Remove the key. Pull on the lock handle (Fig. 49,2). The external flap is open.

Closing: Firmly close the external flap. Insert key into locking cylinder and turn a quarter turn. The flap lock is locked. Remove the key.

6.2.2 Flap lock, elliptical-shaped

Opening: Insert key into locking cylinder (Fig. 50,1) and turn a quarter turn in an anti- clockwise direction. The lock handle (Fig. 50,2) snaps out. Remove the key. Turn lock handle one quarter turn in an anticlockwise direction. The flap lock is open.

To open the external flap, pull all the lock handles fitted to that particular external flap at the same time.

Fig. 49 Flap lock with recessed handle

During rain, water can penetrate the opened flap lock. Therefore close the lock handle.

Fig. 50 Flap lock, elliptical-shaped, closed

63I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

Closing: Firmly close the external flap. Turn lock handle in a clockwise direction until it is horizontal. The flap lock is now engaged but not locked. Insert key into locking cylinder. Press down lock handle with key inserted and turn key a quarter turn in a clockwise direction. The lock handle will stay bolted. Remove the key.

6.2.3 Flap lock with push button Depending on the flap size the service flap is equipped with one or two lock- able push-button locks.

Opening: Insert the key into locking cylinder of the lockable push-button lock (Fig. 51,1) and turn a quarter turn. The push-button lock is unlatched. Remove the key. If equipped, unlock the second lockable push-button lock as well. Press the two push buttons of the push-button locks simultaneously with the thumb and open the service flap.

Closing: Close the service flap and press it shut. The push-button locks are now engaged but not locked. Insert the key into locking cylinder of the lockable push-button lock (Fig. 51,1) and turn a quarter turn. The push-button lock is locked. Remove the key. If equipped, lock the second lockable push-button lock as well.

Fig. 51 Push-button lock service flap

64 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.2.4 Flap for the 230 V connection, square

Opening: Reach into the recessed grip (Fig. 52,1) on the external flap (Fig. 52,2) and swing the external flap upward.

Closing: Swivel the external flap downwards and press it shut.

6.2.5 Cap for the drinking water filler neck

Opening: Insert the key in the locking cylinder (Fig. 53,2 or Fig. 54,2) and turn it in an anticlockwise direction. Remove cap.

Closing: Insert the cap in the drinking water filler neck. Turn key in a clockwise direction. Remove the key.

Fig. 52 Flap for the 230 V connection

1 Recessed grip 2 External flap

Fig. 53 Cap for the drinking water filler neck

Fig. 54 Cap for the drinking water filler neck (alternative)

The cap for the drinking water filler neck and for the fuel filler neck are very similar. Before filling the tank, always check the label.

The drinking water filler neck is labelled by the word "WASSER" (water) (Fig. 53,1) or marked by the symbol " " (Fig. 54,1).

65I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

6.3 Furniture flaps

6.3.1 Furniture flaps with push button

Opening: Press inner part of the lock. The push button jumps out (Fig. 55). Hold push button and open furniture flap.

Closing: Press furniture flap shut. Press push button in until it locks. The furniture flap is closed correctly when the fastener locks into place.

6.3.2 Furniture flaps with handle and push button

Opening: Press the release knob (Fig. 56,1 or Fig. 57,1) on the handle (Fig. 56,2 or Fig. 57,2) and hold it down. Pull handle until furniture flap is open.

Closing: Press the furniture flap down until you can feel the flap hinge close and hear the lock snap into place.

Before commencing the journey, close all furniture flaps and inner doors and lock them. The furniture flaps shown in this section are examples. Depending on the model, the locks and handles on the furniture flaps may differ to those dis- played here.

Fig. 55 Furniture flap with push button

Fig. 56 Furniture flap with handle (example)

Fig. 57 Furniture flap with handle (example)

66 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.3.3 Furniture flaps with release handle

Opening: Press the release handle (Fig. 58,2) and hold it down. Pull the release handle (Fig. 58,1) until the furniture flap is open.

Closing: Press the furniture flap down until you can feel the flap hinge close and hear the lock snap into place.

6.3.4 Furniture flaps with release handle

Opening: Press the release handle (Fig. 59,1) down and keep it pressed. Pull the release handle until the furniture flap is open.

Closing: Press the furniture flap down until you can feel the flap hinge close and hear the lock snap into place.

Fig. 58 Furniture flap with release handle

Fig. 59 Furniture flap with release handle

67I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

6.4 Light switch 6.4.1 Entrance area

The entrance area has light switches for the following lamps:

Seating group lights (Fig. 60,1) Entrance lights (Fig. 60,2) Awning lights (Fig. 60,3) Living area lights (Fig. 60,4)

6.4.2 Interior

Depending on the model, the light switches are fitted at various points: directly on the lamp itself (Fig. 62,1) or away from the lamp at easily accessible loca- tions (Fig. 63,1).

The light switches shown in this section are examples. Depending on the model, the type and allocation of the light switches may differ to those dis- played here.

Fig. 60 Light switch Fig. 61 Awning light

The lamps shown in this section are examples. Not all lamps used in the vehicle are shown. The examples are intended to clarify the possible posi- tions for the light switches. The type and appearance of the light switches can deviate from those shown here.

Fig. 62 Lamp (example), switch mounted directly on the lamp

Fig. 63 Separate light switch

68 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

Further light switches in the living area are located directly on the corre- sponding lamp (Fig. 64,1) or next to the lamp (Fig. 65,1).

In the case of kitchen lights, the light switch (Fig. 66,1) is generally located on the light itself.

6.4.3 Wardrobe light

The On/Off switch (Fig. 67,2) is located directly on the wardrobe light (Fig. 67,3).

Fig. 64 Halogen lamp (example) Fig. 65 Recessed halogen light

Fig. 66 Kitchen light

The wardrobe light can be removed from its holder (Fig. 67,1) and used as a torch. When the wardrobe door is closed, the wardrobe light switches off auto- matically. A brightness sensor ensures that the wardrobe light comes on only when it is dark. This prevents the wardrobe light from being accidentally switched on during daylight hours, which would waste the batteries.

Fig. 67 Wardrobe light

69I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

6.5 Light control

Functions Depending on the model, the vehicle is fitted with a central lighting system. This lighting system operates and dims single lamps or lamp groups that form part of the lighting system. Furthermore, scene functions are integrated into the lighting system. These scene functions enable the user to save and automatically recall the desired brightness of all lamp groups.

Light switch The lights that are integrated into the lighting system are controlled via buttons on the panel (Fig. 68) or via buttons on two switches (Fig. 69 and Fig. 70). The switches are installed at various points in the vehicle.

Buttons on the panel All light control functions are available on the panel.

Buttons on the switch Not all light control functions are available on the two switches.

The lights that are not integrated into the lighting system (e.g. kitchen light, bathroom light or reading spotlights) are switched on and off via separate light switches.

Fig. 68 Panel

Fig. 69 Buttons in the living area Fig. 70 Buttons in the sleeping area

70 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

Symbols The symbols listed in the following table always have the same meaning.

Operation Each button has different functions:

Symbol Signification

Light scene

Main light, living area

Indirect lighting, living area

Main light, sleeping area

Indirect lighting, sleeping area

Night light

All lamps "OFF"

Button Press shortly Keep pressed

Scene Switch the preset scene on/ off

Save the current scene set- ting (> 3 seconds)

Light Switch the appropriate lamp on/off

Dim the appropriate lamp (> 1 second)

71I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

6.6 Spotlight

The spotlight can be rotated, moved or detached.

Turning: Grasp the housing (Fig. 71,2) and turn it.

The housing can be turned in different directions:

To the left and to the right Up and down

Shifting: Grip holder (Fig. 71,1) and turn by approx. 45. Push spotlight along the rail system to desired position.

Removal: Grip holder (Fig. 71,1) and turn by approx. 90. Remove spotlight from rail.

The spotlight can be installed in any position into the rails.

6.7 Holder for flat screen

Bulbs and light fittings can be extremely hot. Allow the light bulbs and lamp holders to cool down before touching them. If the light is switched on or still hot, there must always be a safety dis- tance of at least 30 cm between stores or curtains and flammable objects. Fire hazard!

Fig. 71 Spotlight

Before commencing the journey, place and secure the flat screen and screen support in the initial position. If the screen holder is installed in a TV cabinet: Close TV cabinet.

If there is a risk of frost, do not leave the flat screen television in the vehicle.

72 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.7.1 Holder on the column The holder for the flat screen is attached to a column.

Positioning: Push the release lever (Fig. 72,2) to the side and turn the holder (Fig. 72,3) with the flat screen to the desired position. Press flat screen slightly upward and swivel it to the desired position. Three different inclination angles may be used.

Storing away: Turn flat screen back until the holder (Fig. 72,3) engages in the lock (Fig. 72,1).

6.7.2 Holder in the TV cabinet The flat screen is attached to a console in the TV cabinet.

Positioning: Push the unlocking bar (Fig. 73,1) in. Pull out the extension (Fig. 73,2) as far as possible. Swivel flat screen into the desired position.

Storing away: Swing back flat screen into its original position. Push in the extension (Fig. 73,2) until the unlocking bar (Fig. 73,1) engages.

Fig. 72 Holder on the column

Fig. 73 Holder in the TV cabinet

73I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

6.7.3 Holder with jointed arm The flat screen is fastened to a jointed arm.

Positioning: Pull the release knob (Fig. 74,3). The jointed arm (Fig. 74,4) is unlocked. Swivel flat screen into the desired position. Take hold of the flat screen at the top and bottom edge with both hands and set the desired angle of inclination.

Storing away: Turn the flat screen back into the original position until the holder (Fig. 74,1) engages in the lock (Fig. 74,2).

6.8 Ventilation

Condensation Ensure that there is a continuous exchange of air by providing frequent and efficient ventilation. This is the only method for ensuring that condensation and resulting mould is not formed during cool weather. During the colder season, a pleasant living climate is created if heating output, air distribution and venti- lation are synchronised. To avoid draft close the air outlet nozzles on the dash- board and set the air distribution of the base vehicle to air circulation. If the vehicle is laid up for a longer period, occasionally ventilate it well, espe- cially in summer as heat accumulation can occur. Do not only air the interior, but also the storage compartments which are accessible from the outside. Air the parking place as well if the vehicle is parked in a closed space (e.g. garage). The occurrence of condensation could lead to the formation of mould.

Fig. 74 Holder with jointed arm

The oxygen in the vehicle interior is used up by breathing and the use of gas operated appliances. That is why the oxygen needs to be replaced on a constant basis. For this purpose, forced ventilation options (e.g. skylights with forced ventilation, mushroom-shaped vents or floor vents) are fitted to the vehicle. Never cover or block forced ventilations from the inside or outside with objects such as e.g. a winter mat. Keep forced ven- tilations clear of snow and leaves. There is a danger of suffocation due to increased CO2 levels.

Although sufficient ventilation is provided, in certain weather conditions, condensation can form on metal objects (e.g. screwed connections in the floor). Additional cold spots can occur at thermal "bridges" (e.g. mushroom- shaped vents, skylight edges, sockets, filler necks, flaps, etc.).

74 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.9 Windows

6.9.1 Hinged window with rotary hinges

The windows are fitted with a blind or Roman shade and with an insect screen or folding insect screen. After the latch has been released, the blind and insect screen automatically spring back to the initial position by tensile force. In order not to damage the tension mechanics, hold onto the blind or insect screen and allow it to slowly return to the initial position. The Roman shade and folding insect screen are made of thin woven fabric. In order not to damage the Roman shade or the insect screen, grasp the respective handle and carefully return it to the initial position. Do not keep blinds closed over a longer period of time as that can cause increased material wear. If the blind or the Roman shade is completely closed, exposure to direct sunlight can cause heat to accumulate between the blind/the Roman shade and the window. The window could be damaged. Therefore, if the shade is installed in the bottom blind box, close the shade only 2/3 when sunlight is intense. This allows the heat to escape between the window and the shade. If the shade is installed in the top blind box, close the shade fully and open it regularly. Also move the window into the "continuous ventilation" position. Before commencing the journey, close the windows. Depending on the weather, close the windows far enough to prevent mois- ture from entering. To open and close the window, open or close all catch levers which are fitted to the window.

When leaving the vehicle, always close the windows. In extreme weather conditions or if the temperature fluctuates strongly, a light condensation film can form on the double-glazed acrylic glass. The glass is designed in such a way that condensation can evaporate when the external temperature increases. There is no danger of the double-glazed acrylic glass being damaged by condensation.

When opening the hinged windows, ensure that there are no torsional forces. Open and close the hinged windows evenly.

75I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

Opening: Turn the catch lever (Fig. 75,3) a quarter turn towards the centre of the window. Open the hinged window until the required position has been reached and use knurled knob (Fig. 76,1) to secure in position.

The hinged window remains locked in the required position.

Closing: Turn knurled knob (Fig. 76,1) until the latch is released. Close the hinged window. Turn the catch lever (Fig. 75,3) a quarter turn towards the window frame. The locking catch (Fig. 75,2) is located on the inside of the window catch (Fig. 75,1).

Continuous ventilation With the catch lever, the hinged window can be placed in 2 positions:

"Continuous ventilation" (Fig. 77) Firmly closed (Fig. 75)

To place the hinged window into the "continuous ventilation" position:

Turn the catch lever (Fig. 77,3) a quarter turn towards the centre of the window. Lightly open the hinged window outwards. Return the catch lever to its initial position. The locking catch (Fig. 77,2) has to be moved into the recess of window catch (Fig. 77,1).

During the journey, the hinged window may not be in "continuous ventilation" position. If it rains, the "continuous ventilation" hinged window position could lead to splashing water penetrating the living area. Therefore, close the hinged win- dows completely.

Fig. 75 Catch lever in "closed" position Fig. 76 Hinged window with rotary hinges, open

Fig. 77 Catch lever in the "continuous ventilation" position

76 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.9.2 Hinged window with automatic hinges

Opening: Turn the catch lever (Fig. 78,3) a quarter turn towards the centre of the window. Open the hinged window to the desired latched position. The automatic hinge (Fig. 79,1) locks in place automatically.

The hinged window remains locked in the required position.

Closing: Open the hinged window as wide as necessary until the latch releases. Close the hinged window. Turn the catch lever (Fig. 78,3) a quarter turn towards the window frame. The locking catch (Fig. 78,2) is located on the inside of the window catch (Fig. 78,1).

Continuous ventilation With the catch lever, the hinged window can be placed in two positions:

"Continuous ventilation" (Fig. 80) "Firmly closed" (Fig. 78).

To place the hinged window into the "continuous ventilation" position:

Open the window completely, to release the lock. If the locking device is not released and the window is closed nevertheless, there is the danger of the window breaking due to the massive counter-pressure. When opening the hinged windows, ensure that there are no torsional forces. Open and close the hinged windows evenly.

Fig. 78 Catch lever in "closed" position Fig. 79 Hinged window with automatic hinges, open

Fig. 80 Catch lever in the "continuous ventilation" position

77I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

Turn the catch lever (Fig. 80,3) a quarter turn towards the centre of the window. Slightly open the hinged window outwards. Turn the catch lever a quarter turn towards the window frame. The locking catch (Fig. 80,2) has to be moved into the recess of window catch (Fig. 80,1).

During the journey, the hinged window may not be in "continuous ventilation" position. If it rains, the "continuous ventilation" hinged window position could lead to splashing water penetrating the living area. Therefore, close the hinged win- dows completely.

6.9.3 Sliding window with lock

Opening: Press the lock (Fig. 81,2) upwards. Press handle (Fig. 81,1) and push it forward or backward at the same time. Open window half up to the required position.

Closing: Close the window as far as it can go. Push the lock downwards.

6.9.4 Hinged sunroof with automatic hinges

Fig. 81 Sliding window with pressure lock

Open the window completely, to release the lock. If the locking device is not released and the window is closed nevertheless, there is the danger of the window breaking due to the massive counter-pressure. When opening the hinged windows, ensure that there are no torsional forces. Open and close the hinged windows evenly. Do not open the hinged window if there is a risk of frost. The hinge rail could be damaged.

78 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

Opening: Turn the catch lever (Fig. 82,1) a quarter turn towards the centre of the window. Open the hinged window to the desired latched position. The automatic hinge automatically locks in place.

The hinged window remains locked in the required position.

Closing: Open the hinged window as wide as is necessary to release the lock. Close the hinged window. Turn the catch lever (Fig. 82,1) a quarter turn towards the window frame. The locking catch (Fig. 82,2) is located on the inside of the window catch (Fig. 82,3).

6.9.5 Blind and insect screen

The windows are fitted with a blind and an insect screen. The blind and insect screen are adjusted separately.

Blind The blind is located in the upper blind box.

Closing: Pull blind at the handle (Fig. 83,2) downwards. If the blind is to be com- pletely closed, it is suspended into the locking devices (Fig. 83,3) situated on both sides of the window frame.

Fig. 82 Catch lever in "closed" position

Open blinds before commencing the journey. When the blinds are closed, vibrations can damage the spring shaft.

Fig. 83 Hinged window

79I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

Opening: If the blind is completely closed: Press handle (Fig. 83,2) downwards and, at the same time, tilt it slightly inward. The blind can be taken out of the locking devices situated on both sides of the window frame. If the blind is in an intermediate position: Pull the handle (Fig. 83,2) slightly downwards until the locking device releases. Use handle to return blind slowly to its initial position.

Insect screen The insect screen is located in the upper blind box.

Closing: Pull insect screen at the handle (Fig. 83,1) down and hang it into the locking devices (Fig. 83,3) situated on both sides of the window frame.

Opening: Press handle (Fig. 83,1) downwards and, at the same time, tilt it slightly inward. The insect screen can be taken out of the locking devices situated on both sides of the window frame. Use handle to return the insect screen slowly to its initial position.

6.9.6 Blind and insect screen The windows are fitted with a blind and an insect screen. The blind can be used separately.

Blind The blind is located in the bottom blind box.

Closing: Press handle (Fig. 84,4) and draw blind (Fig. 84,3) from the bottom to the top up to the desired height. Release handle. The blind locks into the nearest locking position.

Opening: Clench handle (Fig. 84,4). The latch is released. Slowly return the blind (Fig. 84,3) to its initial position.

Insect screen The insect screen is located in the upper blind box.

Closing: Pull insect screen (Fig. 84,2) down until it touches the blind (Fig. 84,3), and engage the closure latch (Fig. 84,1) in the locking device (Fig. 84,5).

Opening: Release the closure latch (Fig. 84,1). Slowly return insect screen into its initial position.

Fig. 84 Hinged window

80 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.9.7 Roman shade and insect screen The windows are fitted with a Roman shade and an insect screen. The insect screen can only be moved together with the Roman shade.

Roman shade The Roman shade is located in the bottom blind box.

Closing: Grip the Roman shade using the holding bar (Fig. 85,3), pull it from the bottom to the top and then release it at the desired height. The Roman shade will stay at this height.

Opening: Grip the Roman shade in the middle of the bar and push it down.

Insect screen The insect screen is located in the upper blind box.

Closing: Pull the insect screen down using the holding bar (Fig. 85,2), until it touches the holding bar of the Roman shade (Fig. 85,3). Clip the catch (Fig. 85,1) on the insect screen into the handle of the Roman shade.

Opening: Push the catch (Fig. 85,1) on the insect screen inwards. Move the insect screen back slowly on the holding bar (Fig. 85,2).

6.9.8 Roman shade and insect screen (hinged sunroof) The hinged sunroof is fitted with a Roman shade and insect screen.

Roman shade The Roman shade can be operated separately from the insect screen.

Closing: Grip the Roman shade (Fig. 86,2) in the centre of the holding bar, pull it out and release it at the required position. The Roman shade will stay in that position.

Fig. 85 Hinged window

Fig. 86 Hinged sunroof

81I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

Opening: Grip the Roman shade (Fig. 86,2) in the centre of the holding bar and slowly push it to its initial position.

Insect screen The insect screen can be used separately from the Roman shade and can also stay fully closed if required.

Closing: Grip the insect screen in the centre of the holding bar (Fig. 86,1), pull it out and release it at the required position. The insect screen will stay in that position.

Opening: Grip the insect screen in the centre of the holding bar and slowly push it to its initial position.

6.9.9 Roman shades for windscreen, driver's window and front passenger's window

Closing: Grasp the handle (Fig. 87,2) of the Roman shades and draw carefully until the magnetic catch keeps the Roman shades closed.

Opening: Using the handle, carefully push back the Roman shades. Push the handle (Fig. 87,2) onto the cap (Fig. 87,1). The Roman shade is secured.

6.10 Skylights Depending on the model, skylights with or without forced ventilation are fitted to the vehicle. If a skylight is fitted without forced ventilation, the forced venti- lation is performed using mushroom-shaped vents.

Fig. 87 Roman shade, driver's cabin window

The apertures for forced ventilation must always be kept open. Never cover or block forced ventilations with objects such as e.g. a winter mat. Keep forced ventilations clear of snow and leaves.

82 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.10.1 Heki skylight (mini and midi)

The Heki skylight is opened on one side only.

Opening: Press the safety knob (Fig. 88,2) and pull the bar (Fig. 88,1) down with both hands. Pull the bar (Fig. 89,1) in the guides (Fig. 89,2) to the rearmost position (Fig. 89,3).

Closing: Use both hands to push the bar (Fig. 89,1) slightly upwards. Push the bar back in the guides. Push the bar upwards with both hands until it is above the safety knob (Fig. 88,2).

The skylights are fitted with a blind or Roman shade and with an insect screen or folding insect screen. After the latch has been released, the blind and insect screen automatically spring back to the initial position by tensile force. In order not to damage the tension mechanics, hold onto the blind or insect screen and allow it to slowly return to the initial position. The Roman shade and folding insect screen are made of thin woven fabric. In order not to damage the Roman shade or the insect screen, grasp the respective handle and carefully return it to the initial position. Do not keep blinds closed over a longer period of time as that can cause increased material wear. If the blind or the Roman shade is completely closed, exposure to direct sunlight can cause heat to accumulate between the blind/the Roman shade and the skylight. The skylight could be damaged. For that reason, close the blind/Roman shade only 2/3 of the way in direct sunlight. Open the skylight slightly or move it to ventilation position. Depending on the weather, close the skylights far enough to prevent mois- ture from entering. Do not climb on the skylights. Before commencing the journey, close the skylights. Before commencing the journey, check that the skylights are closed and locked.

When leaving the vehicle, always close the skylights.

Fig. 88 Safety knob on the Heki sky- light

Fig. 89 Heki skylight, guide

83I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

Ventilation position The Heki skylight can be put in two ventilation positions: Bad weather position (Fig. 90,1) and central position (Fig. 90,2). Depending on the model, the sky- light can be locked in the central position with the latch (Fig. 91,1).

Press the safety knob (Fig. 88,2) and pull the bar (Fig. 88,1) down with both hands. Pull the bar in the guides (Fig. 89,2) to the desired position. Push the bar slightly upwards and into the selected guide (Fig. 90,1 or 2) and lock if necessary.

Roman shade To close and open the Roman shade:

Closing: Pull out Roman shade at the handle and release in the required position. The Roman shade will stay in that position.

Opening: Slowly push the Roman shade at the handle to its initial position.

Insect screen To close and open the insect screen:

Closing: Pull the insect screen by the handle to the opposite handle of the Roman shade.

Opening: Press the rear part of the handle of the insect screen. The latch is released. Use handle to return the insect screen slowly to its initial position.

6.10.2 Wind-up skylight (partially special equipment)

The wind-up skylight can be opened using the manual crank.

Opening: Rotate the hand crank (Fig. 92,2) until a resistance can be felt.

Fig. 90 Heki skylight in ventilation position

Fig. 91 Ventilation position locking mechanism

Fig. 92 Wind-up skylight

84 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

Closing: Rotate the hand crank until the wind-up skylight is closed. The wind-up sky- light can be locked after rotating two or three more times. Check the locking mechanism. To do so, press your hand against the acrylic glass.

Roman shade The Roman shade can be closed in any position, as desired. If the Roman shade is locked with the insect screen, the insect screen is also moved along on closing the Roman shade.

Closing: Pull the handle of the Roman shade (Fig. 92,3) and release in the desired position. The Roman shade will stay in that position.

Opening: Slowly push the Roman shade at the handle to its initial position.

Insect screen If the insect screen is locked with the Roman shade, the Roman shade is also moved along on closing the insect screen.

Closing: Pull insect screen at the handle (Fig. 92,1) to the opposite handle of the Roman shade (Fig. 92,3) and allow to engage.

Opening: Press the handle of the insect screen (Fig. 92,1) at the back upwards and detach the insect screen from the Roman shade (Fig. 92,3). Slowly push insect screen at the handle to its initial position.

6.11 Tables

6.11.1 Suspension table with changeable table leg

The suspension table size can be enlarged by inserting a table-top extension.

Extending: Open catches (Fig. 94,1). Raise the table-top (Fig. 93,2) slightly and pull it out as far as possible. Set down the table. Insert the table-top extension (Fig. 93,1) and secure it with the catch (Fig. 94,1). Lift the table-top slightly and push back as far as possible. Secure the table-top with the catches.

The tables shown in this section are examples. Depending on the model, the tables may differ from the the type displayed here.

Fig. 93 Suspension table Fig. 94 Catch

85I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

Reducing size: Open catches (Fig. 94,1). Slightly lift the front of the table-top and pull out. Remove table-top extension (Fig. 93,1) and lay it aside. Lift the table-top slightly and push back as far as possible. Set down the table. Secure the table-top with the catches.

Depending on the model, the suspension table may also be used as a bed foundation.

Conversion to bed foundation:

Slightly raise the front of the table-top (Fig. 95,2). Remove table leg (Fig. 95,3) and lay it aside. Press the release knob (Fig. 96,1) on the lock (Fig. 95,1). Push the table-top approx. 45 upward and remove it. Bolt on the short table leg. Place the table-top in the holders (Fig. 95,4) on the bench seats.

6.11.2 Fixed table (table-top for folding, sliding and rotating)

The foldable table-top can be rotated and moved crossways.

The extension frame beneath the table-top is locked into the mounting rail. Release the lock before lifting the table-top.

Fig. 95 Conversion to bed Fig. 96 Lock

Pull out the support frame before folding down the table-top. The hinges could otherwise be damaged.

86 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

Folding out the table-top: Pull out the support frame (Fig. 97,2) below the table-top (Fig. 97,1) to the end position. Fold out the table-top and carefully rest it on the support frame.

Folding away the table-top: Lift up the part of the table-top that is folded out and place it carefully on the fixed part of the table-top. Push in the support frame to the end position underneath the table-top.

Moving the table-top: Loosen knurled screw (Fig. 98,1). Move table-top to the desired position. Retighten the knurled screw.

Rotating the table-top: Raise the adjustment knob (Fig. 98,2). Rotate the table-top into the desired position (in 90 stages). Allow the adjustment knob to click back into position.

6.11.3 Fixed table (extendable table-top)

Extending: Pull the knob (Fig. 99,3) of the lock down and swing out the table-top exten- sion (Fig. 99,2).

Reducing size: Swing the table-top extension (Fig. 99,2) under the table-top (Fig. 99,1) until the lock latches in place audibly.

The fixed table cannot be used as a bed foundation.

Fig. 97 Support frame Fig. 98 Fixed table (from below)

Fig. 99 Fixed table

87I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

6.11.4 Fixed table (movable table-top) The top of the fixed table can be moved both lengthways and crossways.

Moving in a lengthways direction:

Loosen knurled screw (Fig. 100,1). Move table-top (Fig. 100,2) to the desired position. Retighten the knurled screw.

Moving in a crossways direction:

Loosen knurled screw (Fig. 100,3). Move table-top (Fig. 100,2) to the desired position. Retighten the knurled screw.

The fixed table cannot be used as a bed foundation.

6.12 Divan adjustment mechanism (partially special equipment) The "Reliner" mechanism allows you to adjust the seat, the neck cushion and the armrest of the divan.

Adjusting the seat: Pull up the loop (Fig. 101,2) and carefully pull the seat (Fig. 101,3) along the rails as far as it will go towards the middle. Let go of the loop and move the seat back and forth slightly until you hear it lock into place.

Adjusting the neck cushion: Hold the neck cushion (Fig. 101,4) in both hands and carefully move it up or down to the right position.

Adjusting the armrest: Hold the armrest (Fig. 101,1) in both hands and carefully move it up or down to the right position.

Fig. 100 Fixed table

Fig. 101 Adjusting the divan

88 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.13 Beds

6.13.1 Bunk bed

Depending on the model, the vehicle is fitted with a bunk bed. The bunk bed can be used immediately, without additional conversion. Always use the access ladder provided to climb up to the top bed.

6.13.2 Pull-down bed, manually operated

Always use the safety guards supplied. Never remove or dismantle the safety guards supplied.

Only use the upper bunk bed if the safety guard is fitted. The maximum permitted bunk bed load is 100 kg. The upper bunk bed must not be used by children under 6 years of age. Never allow small children to remain in the bunk bed without supervision. But in particular with regard to small children less than 6 years of age, users should ensure that they cannot fall out of the bunk bed. Use separate children's beds or travel cots suitable for children.

Switch off the reading lamps in the pull-down bed before the bed is pushed up. Fire hazard! Switch off the reading lamps on the underside of the pull-down bed when the bed is lowered. Fire hazard! The maximum permitted pull-down bed load is 200 kg. Before commencing the journey, secure the pull-down bed. To do this, lock the pull-down bed. Before use, pull the pull-down bed into the lower end position. Ensure that the pull-down bed is not resting on obstacles such as headrests, cushions or similar. If there is a safety net: Only use the pull-down bed, if the safety net is set up. Never allow small children to remain in the pull-down bed without super- vision. But in particular with regard to small children less than 6 years of age, users should ensure that they cannot fall out of the pull-down bed. Use separate children's beds or travel cots suitable for children.

You must be able to close the pull-down bed without any great effort, so that there is no tension in the locking position. Objects on the pull-down bed can distort the lifting mechanism on one side, resulting in damage.

89I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

The pull-down bed is located in the driver's cabin above the seats.

Opening the pull-down bed: Switch off the lamps underneath the pull-down bed. Rotate the driver's and front passenger's seats in the direction of travel, lock in position, push completely forwards and turn the backrest as far back as possible. Close the shade in the driver's cabin. Push the release knob (Fig. 102,1). The lock is released. With both hands, pull the pull-down bed down as far as it will go. Make sure that the pull-down bed is in the lower end position and is not resting on obstacles such as headrests, cushions or similar.

Closing the pull-down bed: Switch off the lamps in the pull-down bed. Use both hands to push pull-down bed upwards as far as it will go. When doing this, ensure that the snap latch engages audibly in the locking bracket. Check that the pull-down bed is locked correctly. To do this, pull down the pull-down bed firmly.

Safety net If fitted, the safety net (Fig. 103,2) and the retaining belts are located beneath the mattress of the pull-down bed. Only use the safety net if persons are already in the pull-down bed.

Setting up: Attach retaining belts (Fig. 103,1) to the hooks on the ceiling.

Access ladder Always use the provided access ladder to climb up to the pull-down bed.

Attaching the foldable step ladder:

Hook step ladder (Fig. 103,5) to the pull-down bed by attaching the two hooks (Fig. 103,4) in the holding bar (Fig. 103,3). Grasp the upper edge of the folded-up part of the step ladder and unfold it so that all four feet are securely on the ground.

Fig. 102 Lock Fig. 103 Pull-down bed complete with applied safety net

When closing the pull-down bed, pull the side fabric panels inwards. This prevents the fabric from getting trapped in the lock of the pull-down bed.

The access ladder will differ according to the model.

90 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

Roman shade The Roman shade is fastened to the ceiling. Only let the Roman shade down if persons are already in the pull-down bed.

Closing: Unwind cord (Fig. 104,2) from of the button (Fig. 104,3). Carefully let down the Roman shade (Fig. 104,1) using the cord.

Opening: Using the cord (Fig. 104,2), carefully pull up the Roman shade (Fig. 104,1). Wind cord several times around the button (Fig. 104,3).

6.13.3 Pull-down bed, electrically operated (special equipment)

Fold up the steps before removing the step ladder.

Fig. 104 Roman shade for pull-down bed

Switch off the reading lamps in the pull-down bed before the bed is pushed up. Fire hazard! Switch off the reading lamps on the underside of the pull-down bed when the bed is lowered. Fire hazard! The maximum permitted pull-down bed load is 200 kg. Do not allow children to play with the pull-down bed. Store the remote control in a safe place inaccessible to children. Never allow small children to remain in the pull-down bed without super- vision. But in particular with regard to small children less than 6 years of age, users should ensure that they cannot fall out of the pull-down bed. Use separate children's beds or travel cots suitable for children. If there is a safety net: Only use the pull-down bed, if the safety net is set up. Do not reach into the area between the bed and the side wall when low- ering or raising. Danger of bruises! Do not lower or lift the bed when there are people using the pull-down bed. Only lower the bed if the lowering area is clear. Bring the pull-down bed into the lower end position before use. Ensure that the pull-down bed is not resting on obstacles such as headrests, cushions or similar.

91I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

Making ready for operation

After every power interruption (e.g. lay-up over winter), the electrical drive must be made ready for operation again. To do so carry out a reference run.

Carrying out a reference run:

Using the arrow key (Fig. 105,3) on the manual control unit, bring the pull- down bed down as far as it will go or into any intermediate position. Press the "R" key (Fig. 105,2) three times in a row. Within 10 seconds, bring the pull-down bed upwards using the arrow key (Fig. 105,4). When the end position is reached, a beeping noise is emitted. Release the arrow key.

Opening the pull-down bed: Switch off the lamps underneath the pull-down bed. On the manual control unit (Fig. 105,1), press the arrow key (Fig. 105,3) and keep it pressed until the pull-down bed has moved downwards to its end position. Make sure that the pull-down bed is in the lower end position and is not resting on obstacles such as headrests, cushions or similar.

Closing the pull-down bed: Switch off the reading lamps on the ceiling. On the manual control unit (Fig. 105,1), press the arrow key (Fig. 105,4) and keep it pressed until the pull-down bed has moved up into its end posi- tion. Ensure that there are no objects stuck between the roof and the pull-down bed.

Only raise or lower the pull-down bed if it is loaded with a maximum of 15 kg. This maximum load includes the contents of the wall-mounted cup- board at the base of the pull-down bed. If the pull-down bed is overloaded, the overload protection switches off the lifting motor. However, the lifting mechanism can still be damaged. Before starting a journey, the pull-down bed must be brought into the uppermost end position. No objects must be stuck between the roof and the pull-down bed.

Fig. 105 Manual control unit Fig. 106 Pull-down bed complete with applied safety net

When making ready for operation, overload protection is not in use.

When closing the pull-down bed, pull the side fabric panels inwards. This prevents the fabric from getting trapped in the lock of the pull-down bed.

92 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

Overload protection If the pull-down bed meets an obstacle during opening or closing (e.g. a person or a headrest), the overload protection stops the movement. For release, move the pull-down bed with the arrow key in the opposite direction.

Safety net If fitted, the safety net (Fig. 106,2) and the retaining belts are located beneath the mattress of the pull-down bed. Only use the safety net if persons are already in the pull-down bed.

Setting up: Attach the retaining belts (Fig. 106,1) to the hooks on the ceiling.

Access ladder Always use the provided access ladder to climb up to the pull-down bed.

Attaching: Hook access ladder (Fig. 106,5) to the pull-down bed by attaching the two hooks (Fig. 106,4) in the holding bar (Fig. 106,3). Grasp the upper edge of the folded-up part of the access ladder and unfold it so that all four feet are securely on the ground.

Storing away: Fold in steps. Hang the access ladder from the holding bar on the pull-down bed. Store the access ladder securely.

Emergency operation If the pull-down bed can no longer be moved via the manual control unit (e.g. due to loss of the vehicle's power supply), it can also be operated manually. To do this, proceed as follows:

Remove the connection (e.g. splint and pin) (Fig. 107,2) between the push rod (Fig. 107,1) and lever (Fig. 107,3). Open or close the pull-down bed manually. Contact customer service.

6.13.4 Fixed bed (manual setup)

Fig. 107 Drive

Do not let the slatted frame fall down when closing the bed!

93I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

The bedding box is located underneath the bed. The bedding box may be used to store bedding. Fold up the slatted frame to place items in the bedding box or to empty it. Depending on the model, the slatted frame may be equipped with a sliding bar.

Opening: Lift up the slatted frame (Fig. 108,5) and push it upwards until the bar (Fig. 108,4) in the guide rail (Fig. 108,1) has reached the end position (Fig. 108).

Closing: Lift up the slatted frame (Fig. 108,5) and push back the bar (Fig. 108,4) at the lower end. Ensure that the roller (Fig. 108,3) at the end of the bar near the access opening (Fig. 108,2) does not become detached from the guide rail (Fig. 108,1). Carefully let go of the slatted frame.

6.13.5 Fixed bed (gas-pressure springs)

A storage compartment is underneath the bed. Lift up the slatted frame to place items in the storage compartment or to empty it from the inside of the vehicle.

Opening: Lift the mattress forwards and set it down on the panel. Lift slatted frame. The gas-pressure springs (Fig. 109,1) hold the slatted frame open.

Closing: Press the slatted frame downwards against the resistance of the gas-pres- sure springs. If necessary, push the mattress behind the panel.

Fig. 108 Fixed bed

Fig. 109 Fixed bed

94 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.13.6 Fixed bed (adjustable head section)

Depending on the configuration, the head section of the slatted frame can be adjusted in several stages.

Raising the head section: Raise the head section (Fig. 110,2) of the slatted frame to the desired posi- tion. The support (Fig. 110,1) locks automatically into place.

The head section remains locked in the required position.

Lowering the head section: Raise the head section (Fig. 110,2) of the slatted frame until the lock is released. Guide the head section downwards slowly.

6.13.7 Fixed bed, electrically adjustable (partially special equipment)

The fixed bed (Fig. 111) can be adjusted in length via a manual control unit. This simplifies passage around the bed. When the foot section of the bed is shortened, the head sections are positioned at the same time (Fig. 112).

Do not let the slatted frame fall down when closing the bed!

Fig. 110 Adjustable head section

Fig. 111 Fixed bed, pulled out Fig. 112 Fixed bed, retracted

95I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living 6

Retracting: On the manual control unit (Fig. 113,3) push the " " button (Fig. 113,2) and keep it pressed. The foot section is retracted. The head sections are raised.

Extending: On the manual control unit (Fig. 113,3) push the " " button (Fig. 113,1) and keep it pressed. The foot section is extended. The head sections are lowered.

Adjusting the head sections: On the manual control unit (Fig. 113,3), press the " " button (Fig. 113,2) or " " button (Fig. 113,1) until the desired position is reached.

The head sections remain in the desired position.

Emergency operation Proceed as follows if the bed can no longer be adjusted via the manual control unit:

Remove the connection (e.g. pin and cotter pin (Fig. 114,1 and 3)) between the push rod (Fig. 114,2) and the slatted frame (Fig. 114,4). Slowly push the slatted frame all the way forward. When doing this, hold onto the head sections of the slatted frames. Contact customer service.

Fig. 113 Manual control unit

Fig. 114 Drive

96 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Living6

6.13.8 Widening single beds (special equipment)

Remove the bedside locker cover (Fig. 115,2) and put it to one side. If a locking mechanism is attached to the extension (Fig. 116,3): Reach behind the surround and unlock the extension. Pull out the slatted frame (Fig. 116,4) and/or the extension as far is it will go. Place the additional cushion (Fig. 117,5) between the mattresses (Fig. 117,1).

Fig. 115 Prior to conversion

Fig. 116 During conversion

Fig. 117 After conversion

1 Mattress 2 Bedside locker cover 3 Bedside locker extension 4 Slatted frame and/or extension 5 Additional cushion

97I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas system 7

7Gas systemChapter overview This chapter contains instructions regarding the gas system of the vehicle. The instructions address the following topics:

safety changing the gas bottles gas isolator taps external gas connection automatic switching facility the gas alarm system

The operation of the gas operation appliances of the vehicle is described in chapter 9.

7.1 General

Before commencing the journey, when leaving the vehicle or when gas equipment is not in use, close all gas isolator taps and the main isolator tap on the gas bottle. No appliance operated by a naked flame (e.g. heater or refrigerator) may be in operation when filling the tank, on ferries or in the garage. Danger of explosion! Do not use appliances operated with a naked flame in closed spaces (e.g. garages). Danger of poisoning and suffocation! Only have the gas system maintained, repaired or altered by an author- ised specialist workshop. Have the gas system checked by an authorised specialist workshop according to the national regulations before commissioning. This also applies for not registered vehicles. For modifications to the gas system have the gas system immediately checked by an authorised specialist workshop. The gas pressure regulator and exhaust gas pipes must also be inspected. The gas pressure regulator has to be replaced after 10 years at the latest. The vehicle owner is responsible for seeing that this is car- ried out. In case of a defect of the gas system (gas odour, high gas consumption) there is danger of explosion! Close regulator tap on the gas bottle imme- diately. Open doors and windows and ventilate well. If the gas system is defective: Do not smoke; do not ignite any open flames, and do not operate electric switches (light switches etc.). Before using the cooker make sure that there is sufficient ventilation. Open windows or the skylight. Do not use the gas cooker or gas oven for heating purposes. If there are several gas devices, each gas device must have its own gas isolator tap. If individual gas devices are not in use, close the respective gas isolator tap. Ignition safety valves must close within 1 minute after the gas flame has extinguished. A clicking sound is audible. Check function from time to time. The built-in gas devices are exclusively meant for use with propane or butane gas or a mixture of both. The gas pressure regulator as well as all built-in gas devices are designed for a gas pressure of 30 mbar.

98 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas system7

7.2 Gas bottles

Propane gas is capable of gasification up to -42 C, whereas butane gas gasifies at 0 C. Below these temperatures no gas pressure is available. Butane gas is unsuitable for use in winter. Regularly inspect the gas tube fitted to the gas bottle connection for tightness. The gas tube must not have any tears and must not be porous. Have the gas tube replaced by an authorised specialist work- shop no later than ten years after the manufacturing date. The operator of the gas system must see to it that the parts are replaced. Due to its function and construction, the gas bottle compartment is a space which is open to the exterior. Never cover or block up the standard forced ventilations. Otherwise gas that is emitted can not be diverted to the outside. Do not use the gas bottle compartment as storage space as it is not moisture-proof. Secure the gas bottle compartment against unauthorised access. To do this, lock the compartment. The regulator tap on the gas bottle must be accessible. Only connect gas-operated devices (e.g. gas grill) which have been designed for a gas pressure of 30 mbar. The exhaust gas pipe must be fitted tightly to the heating system and to the vent and must be sealed. The exhaust gas pipe must not show any evidence of damage. Exhaust fumes must be able to escape into the atmosphere unhindered and fresh air must be able to enter unhindered. For this reason, keep the exhaust pipe and intake openings clean and unobstructed (e.g. free from snow and ice). For this reason, no snow walls or aprons may lie against the vehicle.

Gas bottles are only to be transported within the designated gas bottle compartment. Place the gas bottles in vertical position in the gas bottle compartment. Fasten the gas bottles so that they are unable to turn or tilt. If the gas bottles are not connected to the gas tube, always place the protective cap on top. Close the regulator tap on the gas bottle before the gas pressure regu- lator or gas tube are removed from the gas bottle. Use your hands only to connect the gas pressure regulator or the gas tube to the gas bottles. Do not use any tools. Only use special gas pressure regulators with a safety valve designed for vehicle use. Other gas pressure regulators are not permitted and cannot meet the demanding requirements. Use the gas pressure regulator defroster if the temperature falls below 5 C. Use only 11 kg or 5 kg gas bottles. Camping gas bottles with built-in check valve (blue bottle with max. 2.5 or 3 kg content) are can be used in exceptional cases with a safety valve.

99I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas system 7

7.3 Changing gas bottles

Open external gas bottle compartment (see chapter 6). Close the regulator tap (Fig. 118,1) on the gas bottle (Fig. 118,2). Pay attention to the direction of the arrow. Unscrew the gas tube (Fig. 118,3) by hand from the gas bottle. Release the fixing belts and remove the gas bottle. Place a filled gas bottle in the gas bottle compartment. Fix gas bottle in place with the fixing belts. Screw gas tube on gas bottle by hand.

Use the shortest possible tube lengths (150 cm max.) for external gas bottles. Never block the floor ventilation openings below the gas bottles.

With some models, the gas bottle compartment is located right next to the conversion door. With these models, only open the gas bottle compartment when the conversion door is closed. Danger from damages.

For gas-operated units the gas pressure must be reduced to 30 mbar. Connect gas pressure regulator complete with safety valve directly to bottle valve. The gas pressure regulator reduces the gas pressure in the gas bottle down to the operating pressure of the gas devices. For filling and connecting the gas bottles in Europe the accessories shops have corresponding Euro filling sets and Euro bottle sets. Information available at the dealers or service centre. For information on the gas supply in Europe see chapter 17.

When changing gas bottles, do not smoke or create any open fire. When you have changed the gas bottle, check whether gas escapes at the connection points and unions. Use a leakage search spray to spray the relevant connection point or union. These agents are available at the accessories shop.

Fig. 118 Gas bottle compartment

100 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas system7

7.4 Gas isolator taps

A gas isolator tap (Fig. 119) for every gas device is built into the vehicle. The gas isolator taps are located in the vehicle at different positions, and can also be fitted separately.

7.5 External gas connection (special equipment)

The external gas connection (Fig. 120) is located at the rear or to the left or right of the vehicle depending on the model.

Fig. 119 Symbols for the gas isolator taps

1 Oven 2 Refrigerator 3 Heater/boiler 4 Cooker

If the external gas connection is not in use, always close the gas isolator tap. Only gas appliances with a suitable adapter should be connected to the external gas connection. Connect only external gas appliances which are designed for an opera- tion pressure of 30 mbar. Once you have made the connection and opened the gas isolator tap, make sure that no gas is escaping at the connection point. If there is a leak in the external gas connection, gas will escape into the open air. Immediately close the gas isolator tap and the regulator tap on the gas bottle. Have the external gas connection checked by an authorised spe- cialist workshop. When connecting an external gas appliance, make sure that there is nothing near the external gas connection that could cause a spark. Do not use the external gas connection to fill gas bottles. Observe the information stickers on the external gas connection.

Fig. 120 External gas connection, gas isolator tap closed

101I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas system 7

Connect the external gas device to the connection point (Fig. 120,1). Open the gas isolator tap (Fig. 120,2).

7.6 Crash protection unit switching facility (special equipment)

The crash protection unit is an automatic switching facility with a control unit for a two-bottle gas system. The switching facility automatically switches gas supply from the primary bottle to the reserve bottle as soon as the primary bottle is either empty or no longer ready for operation. The gas appliances may still continue operation. The switching facility is suitable for all commercial gas bottles from 3 kg to 33 kg. In the event of an accident or a too high angle of the vehicle the gas supply will automatically be interrupted.

Construction of the unit The crash protection unit consists of two flow restrictors with manual release button (Fig. 121,6) a reversing valve (Fig. 121,4) with pressure regulator (Fig. 121,2), an electrovalve (Fig. 121,5) and the operating unit with tricol- oured LED. The reversing valve is installed between the two gas tubes (Fig. 121,1). Use the knob (Fig. 121,3) on the reversing valve to select which of the gas bot- tles is to be used as a primary bottle and which is to be used as a reserve bottle.

Do not use the switching facility in closed spaces.

When the vehicle is equipped with the crash protection unit the living area heater may be operated during the journey. If the vehicle is equipped with a panel of the DT series and the switching facility is operated via this panel, the operating unit is redundant. Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 121 Crash protection unit switching facility

102 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas system7

Only the electrical functions can be switched at the operating unit (Fig. 122). The regulator taps on the gas bottles (Fig. 121,7) and the release buttons (Fig. 121,6) must be opened manually. The reversing valve provides a constant gas pressure, regardless of which gas bottle is being drawn upon. The display in the reversing valve shows the filling level of the primary bottle. The gas supply comes from the primary bottle when the display is green. When the display is red the primary bottle is empty. In this case, the reserve bottle is used for the gas supply. The indicator lamp on the operating unit shows the condition of the gas system. The system is okay when the indicator lamp (Fig. 122,1) lights up green. When the indicator lamp lights up or flashes red a fault has occurred. The gas supply is interrupted.

Putting into operation: Open the regulator taps of the gas bottles (Fig. 121,7). Press the release buttons (Fig. 121,6) successively for 10 seconds. Use the knob (Fig. 121,3) on the reversing valve (Fig. 121,4) to select the gas bottle which is to be the primary source of gas (primary bottle). Always turn the knob as far as it will go. Switch on the switching facility on the operating unit (Fig. 122). For this, set the rocker switch (Fig. 122,2) to "ON". The reversing valve is now deaerated. The indicator lamp (Fig. 122,1) flashes yellow (system test) and lights up green.

Switching off: Set the rocker switch (Fig. 122,2) to "OFF". The indicator lamp (Fig. 122,1) goes out. Close the regulator taps of the gas bottles (Fig. 121,7).

Changing gas bottles: Turn the knob on the reversing valve. The display is green again. Should the display stay red the reserve bottle is also empty and has to be changes as well. Close regulator tap on the empty gas bottle. Unscrew the gas tube of the gas bottle. Release the fixing belts and remove the gas bottle. Place a new gas bottle in the gas bottle compartment. Fix gas bottle in place with the fixing belts. Connect the full gas bottle to the gas tube.

Fig. 122 Operating unit

When changing gas bottles, do not smoke or create any open fire.

103I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas system 7

Open regulator tap on the gas bottle. Press the release button for 10 seconds. Turn the knob on the reversing valve to the changed bottle. Open the release button when the display is green. Set the knob on the reversing valve with a half-turn, so that the newly replaced gas bottle will serve as a reserve bottle.

7.7 DuoControl switching facility (special equipment)

The DuoControl is an automatic switching facility with a remote display for a two-bottle gas system. The DuoControl switching facility automatically switches gas supply from the primary bottle to the reserve bottle as soon as the primary bottle is either empty or no longer ready for operation. The gas appliances may still continue operation. The DuoControl switching facility is suitable for all commercial gas bottles from 3 kg to 33 kg.

Construction of the unit The DuoControl switching facility consists of a reversing valve (Fig. 123,3) and an operating unit (Fig. 124). The reversing valve is installed between the gas tubes (Fig. 123,2 and 5). The knob (Fig. 123,4) on the reversing valve is used to select which of the gas bottles is to be used as a primary bottle and which is to be used as a reserve bottle. The reversing valve is equipped with the regulator defroster Eis-Ex. This pre- vents damage to the gas system during the winter months. Only the electrical functions can be switched at the operating unit (Fig. 124). The regulator taps on the gas bottles (Fig. 123,1 and 6) must be opened man- ually. The reversing valve provides a constant gas pressure, regardless of which gas bottle is being drawn upon. The two indicator lamps on the operating unit indi- cate the level of the primary bottle. When the green indicator lamp (Fig. 124,6) illuminates, the primary bottle is full. When the red indicator lamp (Fig. 124,5) illuminates, the primary bottle is empty. In this case, the reserve bottle is used for the gas supply.

Do not use the switching facility in closed spaces.

Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 123 DuoControl switching facility Fig. 124 Operating unit

104 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas system7

Operating modes The DuoControl switching facility has two operating modes:

Winter operation "On and heating" Summer operation "On"

Putting into operation: Open the regulator taps on the gas bottles (Fig. 123,1 and 6). Use the knob (Fig. 123,4) on the reversing valve (Fig. 123,3) to select the gas bottle which is to be the primary source of gas (primary bottle). Always turn the knob as far as it will go. Switch on the DuoControl switching facility at the operating unit (Fig. 124). To do so, set the rocker switch (Fig. 124,7) to winter operation "On and heating" (Fig. 124,2) or to summer operation "On" (Fig. 124,4). The reversing valve is now deaerated. The yellow indicator lamp (Fig. 124,1) illuminates if the winter operation has been selected and the regulator defroster is activated.

Switching off: Set the rocker switch (Fig. 124,7) to " " (Fig. 124,3). The yellow indicator lamp (Fig. 124,1) goes out. Close the regulator taps on the gas bottles (Fig. 123,1 and 6).

Remote display The indicator lamps on the operating unit (Fig. 124,5 and 6) indicate in the vehicle interior whether the primary bottle is ready for operation.

Changing gas bottles If the green indicator lamp (Fig. 124,6) stops illuminating during operation and the red indicator lamp (Fig. 124,5) illuminates, the gas bottle selected as pri- mary bottle is empty and needs to be changed. The reserve bottle continues supplying the gas appliances with gas.

Changing gas bottles: Close the regulator tap on the empty gas bottle. Unscrew the gas tube of the gas bottle. Connect the full gas bottle to the gas tube. Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle. Set the knob on the reversing valve with a half-turn, so that the newly replaced gas bottle will serve as a reserve bottle.

When changing gas bottles, do not smoke or create any open fire.

105I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas system 7

7.8 Gas alarm system (special equipment)

The gas alarm system has two functions:

Alarm in the case of an attack with narcotic gas Alarm if there is a leak in the gas system

The gas alarm system is ready for operation as soon as the 12 V power supply is supplied with power.

The flashing LED (Fig. 125,2) next to the terminal block of the gas sensor (Fig. 125,1) indicates readiness for operation.

Switching off the buzzer: Briefly switch off the 12 V power supply and switch it on again (e.g. on the safety cut-out in the power pack).

If the gas sensor or a cable is defective, the buzzer sounds until the defect has been rectified. If a deodorant spray, hairspray or a powerful cleaning agent is used in the immediate vicinity of the gas sensor, a false alarm may be triggered. Extended time in a tunnel (traffic jam) may also trigger a false alarm. Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 125 Gas sensor

106 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas system7

107I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

8Electrical systemChapter overview This chapter contains instructions regarding the electrical system of the vehicle. The instructions address the following topics:

safety explanations of terms relating to the battery 12 V power supply the radio selector switch starter battery living area battery transformer/rectifier panel fuel cell solar installation 230 V power supply connection to the 230 V power supply fuse rating external socket electrical wiring

The operation of the electrical appliances of the housing body is described in chapter 9.

8.1 General safety instructions

8.2 Terms

Off-load voltage The off-load voltage is the voltage of the battery in idle condition, i. e. no cur- rent is consumed and the battery is not being charged.

Closed circuit current Some electrical appliances, such as the clock and the indicator lamps, require continuous electric current, for this reason they are referred to as inactive appliances. This closed circuit current flows even if the device has been switched off.

Only allow qualified personnel to work on the electrical system. All electronic devices (e.g. mobile telephones, radios, televisions or DVD players) which have been retrofitted to the vehicle and are operated during the journey must have certain features: These are the CE certifi- cation, the EMC inspection (electromagnetic compatibility) and the "e"-inspection. Only in this way can the functional reliability of the vehicle be ensured. Otherwise the airbag may be triggered or interference to the on-board electronics may result.

During a storm, to protect the electrical devices disconnect the 230 V con- nection and retract the antennae.

The battery must remain idle for a while before measuring. After charging the last time, or after the last current has been drained by consumers, wait approximately 2 hours before measuring the idle voltage.

108 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

Total discharge Total discharge of the battery is imminent, if a battery is completely discharged by an active appliance and by closed circuit current and the off-load voltage falls below 12 V.

Capacity Capacity refers to the amount of electricity which can be stored in a battery. The capacity of a battery is given in ampere hours (Ah). The so-called K20 value is normally used. The K20 value indicates how much current a battery is able to dispense over a time period of 20 hours without causing damage, or how much current is required to charge a flat battery within 20 hours. For example, if a battery can dispense 4 amps for 20 hours, then it has a capacity of 4 A x 20 h = 80 Ah. If more current flows, the capacity of the battery reduces proportionately. External influences, such as temperature and age may alter the storage capacity of the battery. Capacity details refer to new batteries operating at room temperature.

8.3 12 V power supply

8.3.1 Selector switch for radio (special equipment)

Switching the radio on and off with the ignition:

Set the selector switch to the "0" position. The radio will be switched on and off with the ignition.

Total discharge damages the battery.

Depending on battery technology, capacity details have a conversion factor of 1.3 to 1.7, which lowers the real capacity by this value.

Only connect devices with a maximum of 10 A to the sockets of the 12 V power supply.

Depending on the equipment level, a radio with integrated navigation device or a multimedia station will be present, referred to below simply as a "radio".

Fig. 126 Selector switch for operating behaviour

109I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Operating the radio from the living area battery:

Set the selector switch to the "1" position. The radio will be powered at all times from the living area battery.

8.3.2 Starter battery The starter battery serves for starting the engine and supplies the electrical appliances of the base vehicle as well as optional devices such as the radio, navigation system or central locking system with voltage. See the instruction manual of the base vehicle for the position of the starter battery.

Discharging This section contains information regarding the discharge of the starter bat- tery.

The starter battery will be totally discharged via a closed circuit current (inac- tive appliances). Inactive appliances are optional devices such as a radio, alarm system, navigation system or a central locking system. Inactive appli- ances discharge the starter battery when the vehicle engine is switched off. Low temperatures outside reduce the capacity available.

Charging This section contains information regarding the charging of the starter battery.

The starter battery can only be fully charged with an external charger. When the vehicle is connected to the 230 V power supply, the transformer/rectifier charges the starter battery with a float charge only. Even in mobile operation, the vehicle engine alternator has a limited capability of completely charging the starter battery.

For models with a Fiat base vehicle, the radio in the driver's cabin is con- nected to the living area battery.

Total discharge damages the battery. Once a battery with acid is discharged, it can freeze in temperatures of below zero. This damages the battery. Recharge battery in good time.

The acid in the battery is poisonous and corrosive. Any contact with the skin or the eyes is to be avoided. In the case of charging with an external charger there is danger of explo- sion. Sparks can be caused by attaching the battery terminals. Only charge the battery in a well ventilated area and away from naked flames or possible sources of sparks. Batteries can develop and release gases.

Charge the battery for at least 20 hours before laying up. Do not connect the battery cables to the wrong poles. If the starter battery or living area battery are disconnected, do not apply the ignition. There is a danger of short circuit from exposed cable ends. Before disconnecting or connecting the terminals of the battery, switch off the vehicle engine as well as the 230 V and 12 V power supplies and all appliances. Danger of short circuit! Observe the instruction manuals for the base vehicle and the charger.

110 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

When charging the starter battery with an external charger, proceed as fol- lows:

Turn off the vehicle engine. Switch off the 12 V power supply on the panel. The indicator lamps or the displays on the panel go out. Switch off all gas appliances, all gas isolator taps and close the regulator tap on the gas bottle. Disconnect the starter battery from the vehicle (e.g. remove the battery ter- minals). There is a danger of short circuit when disconnecting the battery poles. For this reason, first disconnect the negative terminal on the starter battery and then the positive. Check that the external charger is turned off. Connect the external charger to the starter battery. Pay attention to the polarity: First connect the positive terminal "+" to the positive terminal of the starter battery, then connect the negative terminal "" to the negative pole of the starter battery. Switch on the external charger. See the instructions for use of the connected charger for information con- cerning charge period required for the battery. See the specifications on the battery for information concerning its strength. Disconnect the charger in reverse order (the negative terminal first). Connect the battery terminals again (first the positive terminal).

8.3.3 Living area battery Use only the built-in transformer/rectifier to load the living area battery. Prior to commencing a journey ensure the living area battery is fully charged. For this reason charge the living area battery for at least 20 hours before commencing the journey. During the trip, use every opportunity to charge the living area battery. Charge the living area battery for at least 20 hours after the journey. Charge the battery for at least 20 hours before laying up. When the living area battery is changed, only use batteries of the same type. If there are several living area batteries, always change all the batteries together. The batteries must always be the same age and have the same capacity. When changing the living area battery, use only batteries which meet the minimum capacity of the charger. Observe the separate instruction manual for the charger. Lower-capacity batteries will generate a great deal of heat when they are charged. Danger of explosion! If the living area battery is replaced and the charging unit does not provide at least 10 % of the rating of a new battery, install an auxiliary charging unit. Example: With a battery capacity of 80 Ah, the charging unit must supply at least 8 A charging current.

111I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

When the vehicle is not connected to the 230 V power supply or the 230 V power supply is switched off, the living area battery supplies the living area with 12 V DC. The living area battery has a limited power supply only. For this reason, electrical appliances such as the radio and the lights should not be operated for a long time without using the 230 V power supply.

Position See chapter 16.

Discharging The living area battery is discharged by the closed circuit current which some electrical appliances continuously require.

A completely charged living area battery will be totally discharged via a closed circuit current (inactive appliances). Low temperatures outside reduce the capacity available. The self-discharge rate of the battery is also dependant on temperature. At 20 to 25 C the self-discharge rate is approx. 3 % of the capacity per month. The self-discharge rate will increase with rising temperatures: At 35 C the self-dis- charge rate is approx. 20 % of the capacity per month. An older battery no longer has the complete capacity available. The higher the number of active electrical appliances, the faster the energy of the living area battery is consumed.

Charging Only use the transformer/rectifier to charge the living area battery. Therefore, connect the vehicle to a 230 V power supply system as often as possible.

8.4 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 99)

Before disconnecting or connecting the terminals of the battery, switch off the vehicle engine as well as the 230 V and 12 V power supplies and all appliances. Danger of short circuit! If the starter battery or living area battery are disconnected, do not apply the ignition. There is a danger of short circuit from exposed cable ends.

For models with a Fiat base vehicle, the radio in the driver's cabin is con- nected to the living area battery.

Total discharge damages the battery. Recharge battery in good time.

Charge the battery for at least 48 hours after a total discharge.

Further information can be obtained in the separate documentation for the living area battery.

Do not cover the ventilation slots. Danger of overheating!

112 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

Functions The transformer/rectifier has the following functions:

The transformer/rectifier charges the living area battery. The transformer/ rectifier charges the starter battery with a float charge only. The transformer/rectifier monitors the voltage in the living area battery. The transformer/rectifier distributes the current to the 12 V circuits and secures them. Devices with a maximum of 10 A can be connected to the sockets. The transformer/rectifier provides connections for a solar charge regulator, an auxiliary charging unit, as well as other control and monitoring functions. When the engine is turned off, the transformer/rectifier separates the starter battery electrically from the living area battery. This prevents the 12 V living area appliances from discharging the starter battery. The battery cut-off switch in the transformer/rectifier separates all the appli- ances from the living area battery.

The transformer/rectifier only works in conjunction with a panel. The power in the transformer/rectifier (> 18 A) is divided into charging current and current to the appliances. The charging current is always just the portion that is not being used by any appliances. If the current to the appliances exceeds the current available, then the living area battery is discharged.

Position See chapter 16.

Depending on the model, not all slots for the fuses are occupied. If there are several living area batteries, use an auxiliary charging unit. Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 127 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 99)

1 Main supply socket 230 V~ 2 Block 1: Refrigerator output (D+, heating cartridge) 3 Block 2: Refrigerator output from starter battery, alternator D+ 4 Block 4: Heating output, basic light (lighting in the entrance area), entrance step 5 Block 3: Panel outlet 6 Block 5: Reserve output 2, reserve 3, reserve 4, appliance with constant positive

(e.g. satellite device, defroster) 7 Block 6: Solar charge regulator input (if fitted) 8 Block 7: Auxiliary charging unit input, fuel cell 9 Block 8: Appliance circuit output 1, appliance circuit 2, TV, water pump, reserve 1,

reserve 5, reserve 6 10 Battery selector switch ("Blei-Sure/Blei-Gel" (lead acid/dryfill)) 11 Fuses 12 Battery cut-off switch ("Batterie Ein/Aus" (battery On/Off))

113I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

8.4.1 Battery cut-off switch The battery cut-off switch switches off all the appliances in the living area, even inactive ones. Even appliances such as the entrance step, basic lighting or the refrigerator will stop working. This prevents the living area battery from slowly discharging if the vehicle is not used for a longer period of time (e.g. temporary lay-up). If the vehicle is connected to the 230 V power supply, the batteries can then be charged from the transformer/rectifier, even if the battery cut-off switch is switched off. This also applies for charging via a solar installation or fuel cell.

8.4.2 Battery selector switch

8.4.3 Battery monitor

The battery monitor in the transformer/rectifier monitors the voltage in the living area battery. If the battery voltage falls below 10.5 V, the battery monitor in the transformer/ rectifier switches off all the 12 V appliances. The battery cut-off switch is acti- vated.

Measures: Switch off all electrical appliances that are not absolutely essential at the corresponding switch. If necessary, use the 12 V main switch to switch the 12 V power supply back on for a short while. This is only possible, however, when the battery voltage is above 11 V. If the voltage is below this level, the 12 V power supply cannot be switched on again until the living area battery has been recharged.

8.4.4 Charging the battery When the vehicle engine is running, a relay in the transformer/rectifier alter- nator switches on the living area battery and the starter battery together and recharges them with the vehicle generator. When the vehicle engine is switched off, the batteries are automatically disconnected from one another again by the transformer/rectifier. This prevents the starter battery from being run down by electrical appliances in the living area. The starting capability of the vehicle is thus preserved. The terminal voltage of the living area battery or the starter battery can be read on the panel.

If the battery selector switch is set incorrectly, there is the danger of the formation of detonating (oxy-hydrogen gas). Danger of explosion!

Incorrect setting of the battery selector switch damages the living area bat- tery. The factory settings of the battery selector switch must not be changed.

You must fully recharge a discharged living area battery as soon as pos- sible.

114 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

If the vehicle is connected to the 230 V power supply, the living area battery and the starter battery are automatically charged by the charger module on the transformer/rectifier. The starter battery is only charged with a float charge. The charging current is adapted to suit the charging condition of the battery. This ensures that it is not possible to overload the battery. To make use of the maximum output from the charger module on the trans- former/rectifier, switch off all electrical appliances during charging.

8.5 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 220) Do not cover the ventilation slots. Danger of overheating!

Depending on the model, not all slots for the fuses are occupied. If there are several living area batteries, use an auxiliary charging unit. Further information can be obtained in the device manufacturer's instruc- tion manual.

Fig. 128 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 220)

1 Connections BL 2 - auxiliary charging unit 1 2 Connections BL 1 - auxiliary charging unit 2 3 Flat fuses 4 Connections BL 9 - solar charge regulator 5 Mains connection 230 V 6 Connections BL 10 - panel 7 Battery selector switch "Blei-Sure/Blei-Gel" (lead acid/dryfill) 8 Connections BL 13 - panel 9 Connections BL 12 - sensor for living area battery D+

10 Change-over switch D+ active to +12 V (D+ active to ground (factory setting)) 11 Connections BL 11 - panel 12 Connections BL 8 - entrance step, TV, antenna 13 Connections BL 6 - heater, water pump, spare 14 Connections BL 7 - awning, tank heater, awning light 15 Selector switch for the number of auxiliary charging units 16 Connections BL 5 - solar charge regulator 17 Connections BL 4 - refrigerator from starter battery 18 Connections BL 3 - refrigerator

115I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Functions The transformer/rectifier has the following functions:

The transformer/rectifier charges the living area battery. The transformer/ rectifier charges the starter battery with a float charge only. The transformer/rectifier monitors the voltage in the living area battery. The transformer/rectifier distributes the current to the 12 V circuits and secures them. Devices with a maximum of 10 A can be connected to the sockets. The transformer/rectifier provides connections for a solar charge regulator, an auxiliary charging unit, as well as other control and monitoring functions. When the engine is turned off, the transformer/rectifier separates the starter battery electrically from the living area battery. This prevents the 12 V living area appliances from discharging the starter battery.

The transformer/rectifier only works in conjunction with a panel. The power in the transformer/rectifier (> 18 A) is divided into charging current and current to the appliances. The charging current is always just the portion that is not being used by any appliances. If the current to the appliances exceeds the current available, then the living area battery is discharged.

Position See chapter 16.

8.5.1 Battery separation

The battery separation switches off all 12 V appliances in the living area, even inactive ones. Even appliances such as the entrance step, basic lighting or the refrigerator will stop working. This prevents the living area battery from slowly discharging if the vehicle is not used for a longer period of time (e.g. temporary lay-up). If the vehicle is connected to the 230 V power supply, the batteries can then be charged from the transformer/rectifier, even if the battery separation is acti- vated. This also applies for charging via a solar installation or fuel cell.

Activating/deactivating See section 8.8.2

8.5.2 Battery selector switch

Also switch off a refrigerator with automatic power selection system. The refrigerator will otherwise switch to gas operation. After deactivation of the battery separation, it may be necessary to reset the date and time. The remaining settings will be saved at the activation of the battery separation and will be maintained.

If the battery selector switch is set incorrectly, there is the danger of the formation of detonating (oxy-hydrogen gas). Danger of explosion!

Incorrect setting of the battery selector switch damages the living area bat- tery. The factory settings of the battery selector switch must not be changed.

116 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

8.5.3 Battery monitor

The battery monitor in the transformer/rectifier monitors the voltage in the living area battery. If the battery voltage falls below 10.5 V, the battery monitor in the transformer/ rectifier switches off all the 12 V appliances. The battery cut-off switch is tripped.

Measures: Switch off all electrical appliances that are not absolutely essential at the corresponding switch. If necessary, use the 12 V main switch to switch the 12 V power supply back on for a short while. This is only possible, however, when the battery voltage is above 11 V. If the voltage is below this level, the 12 V power supply cannot be switched on again until the living area battery has been recharged.

8.5.4 Charging the battery When the vehicle engine is running, a relay in the transformer/rectifier alter- nator switches on the living area battery and the starter battery together and recharges them with the vehicle generator. When the vehicle engine is switched off, the batteries are automatically disconnected from one another again by the transformer/rectifier. This prevents the starter battery from being run down by electrical appliances in the living area. The starting capability of the vehicle is thus preserved. The terminal voltage of the living area battery or the starter battery can be read on the panel. If the vehicle is connected to the 230 V power supply, the living area battery and the starter battery are automatically charged by the charger module on the transformer/rectifier. The starter battery is only charged with a float charge. The charging current is adapted to suit the charging condition of the battery. This ensures that it is not possible to overload the battery. To make use of the maximum output from the charger module on the trans- former/rectifier, switch off all electrical appliances during charging.

8.6 Panel IT 96-2

You must fully recharge a discharged living area battery as soon as pos- sible.

Fig. 129 Panel IT 96-2

1 "ALARM" warning light for the living area battery

2 V/tank gauge 3 230 V indicator lamp 4 Rocker switch for water pump On/

Off 5 Switch for reading the filling level in

the water tank 6 Switch for reading the filling level in

the waste water tank 7 12 V main switch "OFF" 8 12 V indicator lamp 9 12 V main switch "ON"

10 Switch for reading the battery voltage of the living area battery

11 Switch for reading the battery voltage of the starter battery

117I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

8.6.1 12 V main switch The 12 V main switch (Fig. 129,7 and 9) switches the panel and the 12 V power supply to the living area on and off. Exception: Depending on the model, heater, basic light (lighting in the entrance area), entrance step, spare 4 and a refrigerator with automatic power selection system (AES) remain ready to operate.

Switching on: Press switch (Fig. 129,9) "12 V": The 12 V living area power supply is switched on. The indicator lamp (Fig. 129,8) lights up green.

Switching off: Press switch (Fig. 129,7) "O": The 12 V living area power supply is switched off. The indicator lamp (Fig. 129,8) goes out.

8.6.2 V/tank gauge for battery voltage and water or waste water levels

Battery voltage The V/tank gauge is for the indication of the battery voltage of the starter bat- tery or the living area battery. With the V/tank gauge (Fig. 129,2), note the top scale. The gauge automati- cally lights up as soon as a switch is pressed.

Displays: Press switch (Fig. 129,11) " ": The battery voltage of the starter battery is displayed.

Press switch (Fig. 129,10) " ": The battery voltage of the living area bat- tery is displayed.

The following tables will help you correctly interpret the battery voltage of the living area battery displayed on the panel IT 96.

When leaving the vehicle, switch off the main 12 V power supply at the panel. This prevents any unnecessary discharge of the living area battery. Appliances, such as control units (e.g. solar charge regulator, defroster or panel) or fitted appliances (e.g. heating, refrigerator or step) continue to take power from the battery capacity, even if the 12 V power supply on the panel is switched off. Therefore disconnect the living area battery from the 12 V power supply via the switch on the transformer/rectifier if the vehicle will not be used for a long period of time.

118 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

Battery voltage (values during operation)

Mobile operation (vehicle moving, no 230 V con- nection)

Battery opera- tion (vehicle station- ary, no 230 V connection)

Power operation (vehicle station- ary, 230 V con- nection)

Danger of total discharge (battery

alarm)

11 V or less 1)

1) The battery guard switches all the appliances off (at 10.5 V).

12 V power sup- ply overload

If appliances are switched off: Bat- tery flat If appliances are switched on: Bat- tery overload

12 V power sup- ply overload

The battery is not charged by the al- ternator, the alter- nator's regulator is defective

The battery is not charged by the transformer/rectifi- er, the transform- er/rectifier is defective

11.5 V to 13.2 V 12 V power sup- ply overload 2)

2) If the voltage does not exceed this range for several hours.

Normal range 12 V power sup- ply overload 2)

The battery is not charged by the al- ternator, the alter- nator's regulator is defective

The battery is not charged by the transformer/rectifi- er, the transform- er/rectifier is defective

13.3 V to 13.7 V Battery is being charged (main charge)

Occurs only brief- ly after charging

Battery is being charged (main charge)

13.8 V to 14.4 V Battery being charged (float charge)

Battery being charged (float charge)

Over 14.5 V Battery is over- charged, defec- tive alternator control

Battery is over- charged, defec- tive transformer/ rectifier

Values for off-load voltage Charging condition of the battery

Less than 11 V Totally discharged

12.0 V 0 %

12.2 V 25 %

12.3 V 50 %

12.5 V 75 %

More than 12.8 V 100 %

Total discharge causes irreparable damage to the battery.

Measure the off-load voltage preferably several hours after the previous charging (e.g. in the morning) and not directly after a current drain.

119I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Volume of water/waste water

The V/tank gauge is for the indication of the quantity of water or waste water. With the V/tank gauge (Fig. 129,2), use the bottom scale. The gauge automat- ically lights up as soon as a switch is pressed.

Displays: Press switch (Fig. 129,5) " ": The volume of water is displayed.

Press switch (Fig. 129,6) " ": The volume of waste water is displayed.

8.6.3 Switch for water pump

Switching on: Press the upper part of the rocker switch (Fig. 129,4) "I": The water supply is ON.

Switching off: Press the lower part of the rocker switch (Fig. 129,4) "O": The water supply is OFF.

8.6.4 Battery alarm for the living area battery The red "ALARM" warning light (Fig. 129,1) flashes as soon as the voltage of the living area battery falls below 11 V (measured under operation) and there is a risk of a total discharge.

Measures: When the battery alarm comes on, switch off the appliances and charge the living area battery, either by mobile operation or by connection to a 230 V power supply.

8.6.5 12 V indicator lamp The 12 V indicator lamp (Fig. 129,8) illuminates whenever the 12 V main switch (Fig. 129,9) is switched on.

8.6.6 230 V indicator lamp The yellow 230 V indicator lamp (Fig. 129,3) illuminates whenever line voltage is available at the transformer/rectifier input.

Only read the tank levels briefly. Keeping the reading option on for a long time can damage the transducers.

If the vehicle is not connected to the 230 V power supply and the water pump is not used for a longer period of time: Switch off the power supply for the water pump. The pump relay uses around 4 Ah current each day.

Total discharge damages the battery.

If the battery voltage falls below 10.5 V, the battery monitor in the trans- former/rectifier switches off all the 12 V appliances. The battery cut-off switch is activated.

Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.

120 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

8.7 Panel IT 994

8.7.1 V/tank gauge for battery voltage and water or waste water levels

Battery voltage The V/tank gauge is for the indication of the battery voltage of the starter bat- tery or the living area battery. With the V/tank gauge (Fig. 130,1), note the top scale. The gauge automati- cally lights up as soon as a switch is pressed.

Displays: Press the lower part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,13): The battery voltage of the starter battery is displayed. Press the upper part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,13): The battery voltage of the living area battery is displayed.

The following tables will help you correctly interpret the battery voltage of the living area battery displayed on the panel IT 994.

Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 130 Panel IT 994

1 V/tank gauge 2 Digital clock/temperature gauge 3 230 V indicator lamp 4 Current gauge 5 12 V indicator lamp 6 12 V main switch 7 Rocker switch for water pump On/

Off 8 Rocker switch C for reading

internal temperature or external temperature

9 Setting the digital clock - minutes 10 Setting the digital clock - hours 11 Rocker switch display On/Off 12 Rocker switch for reading the level

in the water or waste water tanks 13 Rocker switch for reading the bat-

tery voltage of the starter and living area batteries

14 ALARM warning light for the living area battery

121I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Battery voltage (values during operation)

Mobile operation (vehicle moving, no 230 V con- nection)

Battery opera- tion (vehicle station- ary, no 230 V connection)

Power operation (vehicle station- ary, 230 V con- nection)

Danger of total discharge (battery

alarm)

11 V or less 1)

1) The battery guard switches all the appliances off (at 10.5 V).

12 V power sup- ply overload

If appliances are switched off: Bat- tery flat If appliances are switched on: Bat- tery overload

12 V power sup- ply overload

The battery is not charged by the al- ternator, the alter- nator's regulator is defective

The battery is not charged by the transformer/rectifi- er, the transform- er/rectifier is defective

11.5 V to 13.2 V 12 V power sup- ply overload 2)

2) If the voltage does not exceed this range for several hours.

Normal range 12 V power sup- ply overload 2)

The battery is not charged by the al- ternator, the alter- nator's regulator is defective

The battery is not charged by the transformer/rectifi- er, the transform- er/rectifier is defective

13.3 V to 13.7 V Battery is being charged (main charge)

Occurs only brief- ly after charging

Battery is being charged (main charge)

13.8 V to 14.4 V Battery being charged (float charge)

Battery being charged (float charge)

Over 14.5 V Battery is over- charged, defec- tive alternator control

Battery is over- charged, defec- tive transformer/ rectifier

Values for off-load voltage Charging condition of the battery

Less than 11 V Totally discharged

12.0 V 0 %

12.3 V 50 %

12.5 V 75 %

More than 12.8 V Full

Total discharge causes irreparable damage to the battery.

Measure the off-load voltage preferably several hours after the previous charging (e.g. in the morning) and not directly after a current drain.

122 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

Volume of water/waste water

The V/tank gauge is for the indication of the quantity of water or waste water. With the V/tank gauge (Fig. 130,1), use the bottom scale. The gauge automat- ically lights up as soon as a switch is pressed.

Displays: Press the upper part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,12): The volume of water is displayed. Press the lower part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,12): The volume of waste water is displayed.

8.7.2 Battery alarm for the living area battery The red ALARM warning light (Fig. 130,14) flashes as soon as the voltage of the living area battery falls below 11 V (measured under operation) and there is a risk of a total discharge.

Measures: When the battery alarm comes on, switch off the appliances and charge the living area battery, either by mobile operation or by connection to a 230 V power supply.

8.7.3 Digital clock/temperature gauge

Digital clock The buttons under the gauge can be used to switch the digital clock on and off and to set it.

Switching on: Press the upper part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,11): Digital clock display is switched on. Temperature display is ready to operate.

Switching off: Press the lower part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,11): Digital clock display and temperature display are switched off.

Adjusting: Press a thin device, such as a biro, into the opening for the hour display (Fig. 130,10) until the correct hours are displayed. Press a thin device, such as a biro, into the opening for the minute display (Fig. 130,9) until the correct minutes are displayed.

Only read the tank levels briefly. Keeping the reading option on for a long time can damage the transducers.

Total discharge damages the battery.

If the battery voltage falls below 10.5 V, the battery monitor in the trans- former/rectifier switches off all the 12 V appliances. The battery cut-off switch is activated.

The digital clock will go on running even when the digital clock display is switched off. The actual time can always be read. The digital clock loses the current time when the living area battery is dis- connected. When the living area battery is reconnected, the display reads 00:00 and must be re-set.

123I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Temperature display The digital clock/temperature gauge is for the indication of the internal or external temperature. The temperature display is only ready for operation if the digital clock display is switched on. After a reading, the respective temperature will be displayed for approx. 6 seconds.

Displays: Press the upper part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,8): The internal temper- ature is displayed. Press the lower part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,8): The external temper- ature is displayed.

8.7.4 Current gauge for charging/discharging the living area battery The battery current actually flowing is permanently displayed on the current gauge (Fig. 130,4). The gauge automatically lights up as soon as a switch is pressed.

Red "discharging" zone: Battery is being discharged at the discharging cur- rent indicated between 0 and 30 A. Indicator "0": Battery is neither being charged nor discharged. Green "charging" zone: Battery is being charged at the charging current indicated between 0 and 30 A.

Display Mobile operation (vehicle moving, no 230 V con- nection)

Battery opera- tion (vehicle station- ary, no 230 V connection)

Power operation (vehicle station- ary, 230 V con- nection)

Notes for charging/ discharge display

Red "discharg- ing" zone (dis- charging current)

No charge! Too many appli- ances are switched on or the alternator is de- fective

Appliances are on Battery is being discharged

No charge! Too many appli- ances are switched on

0 A (there is no current)

Battery fully or vir- tually charged 1)

1) If the indicator falls from the green range to 0 and all appliances are switched off (apart from the refrigerator).

Appliances are switched off

Battery fully or vir- tually charged 2)

2) If the indicator falls from the green range to 0 and all appliances are switched off.

Green zone (charging current)

Battery is being charged (up to 30 A possible)

Battery is being charged (only possible with solar power)

Battery is being charged (up to max. 16 A possi- ble; with 32 A auxiliary charging unit)

124 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

8.7.5 12 V main switch The 12 V main switch (Fig. 130,6) switches the panel and the 12 V power supply of the living area on and off. Exception: Depending on the model, heater, basic light (lighting in the entrance area), entrance step, spare 4 and a refrigerator with automatic power selection system (AES) remain ready to operate.

Switching on: Press the upper part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,6): The 12 V living area power supply is switched on. The indicator lamp (Fig. 130,5) lights up green.

Switching off: Press the lower part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,6): The 12 V living area power supply is switched off. The indicator lamp (Fig. 130,5) goes out.

8.7.6 12 V indicator lamp The 12 V indicator lamp (Fig. 130,5) illuminates whenever the 12 V main switch (Fig. 130,6) is switched on.

8.7.7 230 V indicator lamp The yellow 230 V indicator lamp (Fig. 130,3) illuminates whenever line voltage is available at the transformer/rectifier input.

8.7.8 Switch for water pump

Switching on: Press the upper part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,7): The water supply is ON.

Switching off: Press the lower part of the rocker switch (Fig. 130,7): The water supply is OFF.

8.8 Panel LT 510

When leaving the vehicle, switch off the main 12 V power supply at the panel. This prevents any unnecessary discharge of the living area battery. Appliances, such as control units (e.g. solar charge regulator, defroster or panel) or fitted appliances (e.g. heating, refrigerator or step) continue to take power from the battery capacity, even if the 12 V power supply on the panel is switched off. Therefore disconnect the living area battery from the 12 V power supply via the switch on the transformer/rectifier if the vehicle will not be used for a long period of time.

If the vehicle is not connected to the 230 V power supply and the water pump is not used for a longer period of time: Switch off the power supply for the water pump. The pump relay uses around 4 Ah current each day.

The luminance of the LEDs and the symbols adapts automatically to the ambient light. The displays can only be called up if the 12 V power supply is switched on. As soon as a button is pressed, the gauge is automatically illuminated. The display goes out 20 seconds after the last key has been pressed. Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.

125I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

8.8.1 230 V indicator lamp The 230 V indicator lamp (Fig. 131,1) illuminates whenever line voltage is available at the transformer/rectifier input.

8.8.2 12 V main switch The 12 V main switch (Fig. 131,18) switches the panel and the 12 V power supply of the living area on and off. Exception: Heater, basic light (lighting in the entrance area) and entrance step remain operational.

Switching on: Briefly press the 12 V power supply button (Fig. 131,18). The 12 V living area power supply is switched on. The "12 V" indicator lights up.

Fig. 131 Panel LT 510

1 230 V indicator lamp 2 Batteries gauge 3 Volt symbol 4 Interior temperature button 5 External temperature button 6 Tank heater button 7 Water tank symbol 8 Tanks gauge 9 Light control button

10 Water pump button 11 Waste water tank symbol 12 Digital display, temperature 13 Tanks button 14 Starter battery button 15 Living area battery button 16 Symbol for starter battery and living area battery 17 Ampere symbol 18 Button for 12 V power supply (12 V main switch)

The 230 V indicator lamp also lights up whenever the 12 V main switch is switched off.

126 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

Switching off: Briefly press the 12 V power supply button (Fig. 131,18). The 12 V living area power supply is switched off. The "12 V power supply" indicator goes out.

Activating battery separation (transformer/

rectifier without battery cut- off switch):

Switch off 12 V power supply. Press button for living area battery (Fig. 131,15) and hold it down for approx. 10 seconds. The "V" volt symbol (Fig. 131,3) and the "12 V" indi- cator flash three times. The living area battery is disconnected from the 12 V power supply.

Deactivating battery separation (transformer/

rectifier without battery cut- off switch):

Press the 12 V power supply button (Fig. 131,18) and hold it down for approx. 5 seconds. The "V" volt symbol (Fig. 131,3) and the "12 V" indi- cator flash three times. The living area battery is connected to the 12 V power supply. The indicator lights up after approx. 5 seconds.

8.8.3 Batteries gauge The voltage and charging/discharging of the living area battery or the starter battery voltage can be indicated using the batteries gauge.

Displays: Press button for living area battery (Fig. 131,15). The "V" volt symbol (Fig. 131,3) lights up. Depending on whether the battery is being charged or discharged, the "A" ampere symbol (Fig. 131,17) lights up white or red respectively. The battery voltage and current of the living area battery are displayed using the LEDs in the gauge. Press button for starter battery (Fig. 131,14). The "V" volt symbol (Fig. 131,3) lights up. The battery voltage of the starter battery is displayed using the LEDs in the gauge.

The tables below will help you interpret the statuses displayed on the panel.

If, after switching on, the "11.0" LED of the volt indicator and the "V" volt symbol (Fig. 131,3) in the batteries gauge (Fig. 131,2) flash, the voltage of the living area battery is too low. Charge battery. If, after switching on, the "12 V" indicator and the "V" volt symbol (Fig. 131,3) flash three times, battery separation is activated. Deactivate battery separation.

When leaving the vehicle, switch off the main 12 V power supply at the panel. This prevents any unnecessary discharge of the living area battery. Appliances, such as control units (e.g. solar charge regulator, defroster or panel) or fitted appliances (e.g. heating, refrigerator or step) continue to take power from the battery capacity, even if the 12 V power supply on the panel is switched off. Therefore disconnect the living area battery from the 12 V power supply via the switch on the transformer/rectifier if the vehicle will not be used for a long period of time.

Volt indicator (blue) 1 LED 2 LEDs 3 LEDs 4 LEDs 5 LEDs 6 LEDs 7 LEDs 8 LEDs

< 11.0 V 11.5 V 12.0 V 12.2 V 12.5 V 12.7 V 13.0 V > 13.5 V

127I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Battery voltage (values during operation)

Mobile operation (vehicle moving, no 230 V con- nection)

Battery opera- tion (vehicle station- ary, no 230 V connection)

Power operation (vehicle station- ary, 230 V con- nection)

Danger of total discharge (battery

alarm)

11 V or less 1)

1) The battery guard switches all the appliances off (at 10.5 V).

12 V power sup- ply overload

If appliances are switched off: Bat- tery flat If appliances are switched on: Bat- tery overload

12 V power sup- ply overload

The battery is not charged by the al- ternator, the alter- nator's regulator is defective

The battery is not charged by the transformer/rectifi- er, the transform- er/rectifier is defective

11.5 V to 13 V 12 V power sup- ply overload 2)

2) If the voltage does not exceed this range for several hours.

Normal range 12 V power sup- ply overload 2)

The battery is not charged by the al- ternator, the alter- nator's regulator is defective

The battery is not charged by the transformer/rectifi- er, the transform- er/rectifier is defective

Over 13.5 V Battery is being charged (main charge)

Occurs only brief- ly after charging

Battery is being charged (main charge)

Values for off-load voltage Charging condition of the battery

Less than 11 V Totally discharged

12.0 V 0 % (discharged)

12.2 V 25 %

12.3 V 50 %

12.5 V 75 %

More than 12.8 V Full

Total discharge causes irreparable damage to the battery.

Measure the off-load voltage preferably several hours after the previous charging (e.g. in the morning) and not directly after a current drain.

Ampere indicator (blue) 1 LED 2 LEDs 3 LEDs 4 LEDs 5 LEDs 2 LEDs 3 LEDs 4 LEDs

Discharging with: Charging with:

Ap- prox. 0 A

> 1 A > 3 A > 10 A > 30 A > 1 A > 3 A > 10 A

128 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

8.8.4 Tank gauge The water and waste water quantities can be indicated using the tank gauge.

Displays: Press tanks button (Fig. 131,13). The water tank (Fig. 131,7) and waste water tank (Fig. 131,11) symbols light up. The fill levels of the water tank (upper scale) and of the waste water tank (lower scale) are indicated using the LEDs in the gauge.

The table below will help you interpret the levels displayed on the panel.

8.8.5 Alarms

The table below will help you interpret the alarms displayed on the panel.

Current displayed System status "A" ampere symbol

-30 A to -10 A Battery is being heavily discharged

Lights up red

-10 A to -1 A Battery is being dis- charged

Lights up white

0 A Battery current is low or 0 A

Lights up white

+1 A to +10 A Battery is being charged Lights up white

Level indicator (blue) 1 LED 2 LEDs 3 LEDs 4 LEDs 5 LEDs 6 LEDs 7 LEDs 8 LEDs

25 % 50 % 75 % 100 %

Perform display checks regularly. It is best to perform checks in the morning, before the 12 V appliances are switched on.

Total discharge damages the battery.

If the battery voltage falls below 10.5 V, the battery monitor in the trans- former/rectifier switches off all the 12 V appliances. The battery cut-off switch is tripped.

129I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Tank alarm The water tank symbol (Fig. 131,7) or waste water tank symbol (Fig. 131,11) flashes when the water tank is empty or the waste water tank is full.

Measures: Fill water tank or empty waste water tank.

8.8.6 Temperature display The internal and external temperatures can be indicated using the digital dis- play (Fig. 131,12).

Displays: Press the button for the internal temperature (Fig. 131,4). The internal tem- perature is displayed. Press external temperature button (Fig. 131,5). The external temperature is displayed.

8.8.7 Switch for tank heater The tank heater can be turned on and off using the tank heater button (Fig. 131,6).

Switching on: Press the tank heater button (Fig. 131,6). The tank heater symbol lights up.

Switching off: Press the tank heater button (Fig. 131,6). The tank heater symbol goes out.

Display Signification Remedy

The "V" volt symbol (Fig. 131,3) and the LED "11.0" flash when the val- ues for the living area battery are called up

The battery voltage has fallen below 11 V. Dan- ger of total discharge

Switch off all 12 V appli- ances and charge the battery either by mobile operation or by connec- tion to a 230 V supply

The "V" volt symbol (Fig. 131,3) flashes when the 12 V power supply is switched off

The 12 V power supply can no longer be switched on

Switch off all 12 V appli- ances and charge the battery either by mobile operation or by connec- tion to a 230 V supply

Battery overvoltage Contact customer service

The "V" volt symbol (Fig. 131,3) and the LEDs "11.0" and "12.0" flash when the values for the starter battery are called up

The battery voltage has fallen below 11 V. Dan- ger of total discharge

Switch off all 12 V appli- ances and charge the battery either by mobile operation or by connec- tion to a 230 V supply

If, when the fill levels are called up, the LEDs in the scale flash in addition to the tank symbol, a sensor error has occurred. Clean tank sensors.

The tank heater is not switched off when the 12 V power supply is switched off. The tank heater must always be switched off separately. Although the tank heater can be switched off when the 12 V power supply is switched off, it cannot be switched on.

130 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

8.8.8 Switch for water pump The water pump can be turned on and off using the water pump button (Fig. 131,10).

Switching on: Press the water pump button (Fig. 131,10). The symbol lights up.

Switching off: Press the water pump button (Fig. 131,10). The symbol goes out.

8.9 Fuel cell (EFOY) (special equipment)

The switch status of the water pump is saved when the 12 V power supply is switched off. This means: If the water pump was switched on when the 12 V power supply was switched off, it is also switched on after the 12 V power supply is switched back on.

Methanol is toxic. Avoid inhaling, swallowing or any contact with the skin or the eyes. If methanol leaks, there is a danger of fire. Keep away from sources of ignition and ventilate well. Methanol evaporates without residue. Always adhere to the safety data sheet from the manufacturer. The fuel cell must not be opened. The tank cartridge must not be opened with force or refilled. Keep fuel cell and tank cartridges including empty or half-empty tank cartridges out of the reach of children. When used in vehicles, the fuel cell and the tank cartridges must be secured to avoid accidents.

Do not store the fuel cell at temperatures above 45 C or below 1 C. Do not operate the fuel cell at temperatures above 40 C or below -20 C. When the appliance is connected to an intact battery, the frost protection switches on automatically if the ambient temperature drops below 3 C, even if the fuel cell is switched off. Therefore always connect a full tank car- tridge and a sufficiently charged battery, if it is stored below 3 C. If the fuel cell freezes despite taking all precautions, leave the appliance to defrost at room temperature for approx. 24 hours in a switched off state. Then it can be used again. Do not cover the ventilation holes on the fuel cell. Danger of overheating! The fuel cell is not waterproof. Clean casing only with a slightly damp cloth and ensure that water does not enter the device.

The minimum running time of the fuel cell is 30 minutes. If the On/Off key is pressed during this period, the fuel cell only shuts down when this min- imum operating time expires. The LEDs light up on during this time. Further information can be obtained in the instruction manual for the fuel cell.

131I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

The fuel cell consists of several components that are installed in the rear storage space (Fig. 132) and of an operating unit (Fig. 134) in the living area. The following components are on the fuel cell (Fig. 132,6):

The connector for the air discharge hose (Fig. 132,4) or the filling hole for the service fluid the off-heat tube (Fig. 132,5) electrical connections (Fig. 132,3) with data interface (Fig. 133,2), device connection (Fig. 133,3) and connection for the operating panel (Fig. 133,1)

A tank cartridge belongs to the fuel cell (Fig. 132,6). It is connected to the fuel cell via a tank connection (Fig. 132,2). The tank cartridge is firmly fixed in the tank cartridge holder (Fig. 132,1). The fuel cell automatically charges the living area batteries if their voltage falls below 12,3 V and if the fuel cell is switched on using the On/Off key (Fig. 134,8).

Operating unit The display (Fig. 134,1) of the operating unit has four lines. The first line displays the selected operating mode:

Automatic On Off

The second line displays the current operating status:

Standby Charging mode Shutdown procedure Battery protection Antifreeze

The other two rows show information such as battery voltage, charging current and filling level of the tank cartridge.

Fig. 132 Fuel cell with tank cartridge Fig. 133 Connector panel of the fuel cell

Fig. 134 Operating unit fuel cell

1 Display 2 Scroll upwards through menu 3 Scroll downwards through menu 4 Confirmation/OK 5 Fault display (red LED) 6 Back 7 Menu 8 On/Off

132 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

The main menu can be accessed with the menu key (Fig. 134,7):

Operating mode Fuel cartridge System information Language System reset

In the event of faults, the red fault indicator (Fig. 134,5) lights up and a mes- sage appears on the display. The message consists of an error code and infor- mation on how to rectify the fault. After rectifying the fault, carry out a system reset. If the tank cartridge needs to be changed or service fluid replenished, this will also be indicated.

Switching on: Press the On/Off key. Select the desired operating mode and confirm with "OK".

Switching off: Press the On/Off key. Select the "Manual Off" operating mode and confirm with "OK". The fuel cell switches itself off in a controlled way. This procedure can take a while. "Shutdown procedure" appears on the display.

Automatic mode Automatic mode starts as soon as the device is attached to the power supply. The device monitors the battery voltage independently. The fuel cell switches itself on automatically when the battery voltage falls below 12.3 Volts. The battery is then charged to reach the switch-off threshold (14.2 Volts). When started, the device runs through a start phase lasting up to 20 minutes. Only after this period is its full nominal power reached.

Battery protection This function prevents the battery from discharging completely when the oper- ating mode is set to "Off". Battery protection is activated automatically when the battery voltage falls below 11.2 Volts for more than 15 minutes. The "Battery protection" charge mode ends when the voltage of 12.8 Volts is reached.

Frost protection This mode is triggered automatically as soon as the temperature falls below 3 C. It prevents the device from freezing.

Replacing the tank cartridge:

Unscrew the tank cartridge connection from the empty tank cartridge. Loosen the securing belt on the tank cartridge. Remove empty tank cartridge from the tank cartridge holder. After use, firmly close the cap of the tank cartridge. Insert a new, sealed original tank cartridge into the tank cartridge holder. Secure the tank cartridge with the securing belt. Open cap and keep safe.

Observe the safety instructions for methanol.

133I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Screw tank cartridge connection onto the new tank cartridge. In the "Main Menu > Fuel Cartridge" menu, specify the tank cartridge size used and confirm with "OK".

8.10 Solar installation (special equipment)

The solar installation provides an environmentally compatible power supply independent of the mains. It converts energy from sunlight into electric current. The solar installation supplies additional current for the battery and appli- ances. The solar charge regulator has an integrated overload protection and back flow valve. The charging current is automatically reduced or the solar collec- tors (solar modules) are switched off if the solar power is not sufficient (e.g. at night).

The operating display is by means of two LEDs (Fig. 135,1 and 2). The LEDs indicate the current operating status by means of different brightness. The higher the charge status of the battery, the brighter the LED lights "100 % " (Fig. 135,1) and, the lower the charge status of the battery, the lower the LED lights "20 % " (Fig. 135,2).

Protect the solar collectors (solar module) against mechanical overload.

The solar installation supplies the most current under optimal sunlight con- ditions. Provide the solar collectors (solar module) open access to sunlight. Sunlight is greater in the open air than under trees and bridges. Tarpaulins block out sunlight. Always keep collector surfaces free of contamination. Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 135 Solar charge regulator

LED Status Signification

100 % 20 %

Off Off

Solar power insufficient

100 % 20 %

Lights Lights

Battery being charged

100 % Lights brightly Charging current limited to trickle charging cur- rent

20 % Glows weakly

134 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

8.11 230 V power supply

The 230 V power supply provides electricity for:

sockets with earth contact for appliances with maximum 16 A refrigerator transformer/rectifier an auxiliary charging unit air conditioning unit

The electrical appliances connected to the 12 V power supply of the living area are supplied with voltage by the living area battery. Connect the vehicle to an external 230 V power supply system as often as possible. The charger module in the transformer/rectifier automatically charges the living area battery. In addition to this, the starter battery is charged with a float charge of approx. 2 A. Depending on the equipment, the air conditioning unit and other optional devices are fuse-protected by their own safety cut-out (16 A).

8.11.1 230 V connection Requirements concerning

the 230 V connection The connection cable, the plug connectors at the point of supply and the plug connector to the vehicle must comply with IEC 60309. The standard designation for the plug connectors is "CEE blue". Use H07RN-F rubber sheathed cable with a minimum cable cross-section of 2.5 mm and a maximum length of 25 m. Earth contact connectors (safety) are not permitted. The interconnection of CEE/safety adapters is also prohibited.

8.11.2 Connecting 230 V power supply

The vehicle can be connected to an external 230 V power supply.

Only allow qualified personnel to work on the electrical system. Have the vehicle's electrical system checked by a qualified electrician at least once every 3 years. If the vehicle is used frequently, an annual check is recommended.

The external 230 V power supply must be protected by fuse with a fault current protection switch (FI-switch, 30 mA). To prevent overheating, the cable must be fully uncoiled from the cable reel. In case of doubt or if the 230 V supply is not available or is faulty, contact the operator of the power supply device.

The 230 V connection in the vehicle is equipped with a fault current protec- tion switch (FI-switch). For the connection points on camp sites (camping distributors) fault current protection switches (FI-switches, 30 mA) are obligatory.

135I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Connecting the vehicle: Check whether the power supply device is suitable regarding connection, voltage, frequency and current. Check whether the cables and connections are suitable. Check the plug connectors and cables for visible damage. Switch off the safety cut-out (Fig. 136,1 and 2) in the fuse box (Fig. 136,3). Open the cover of the 230 V connection on the vehicle (Fig. 137) and insert the plug connector. Ensure that the detent of the spring-mounted pivoting cover is engaged in position. Plug the connector of the connecting cable into the socket of the power supply device. Ensure that the detent of the spring-mounted pivoting cover is engaged in position. Switch on the safety cut-out in the fuse box.

Checking the fault current protection switch:

When the vehicle is connected to the 230 V supply, press the check button (Fig. 136,5) of the fault current protection switch (FI-switch) (Fig. 136,4) in the fuse box (Fig. 136,3). The fault current protection switch must trip. Switch the fault current protection switch back on again.

Unplugging the connection: Switch off the safety cut-outs (Fig. 136,1 and 2) in the fuse box (Fig. 136,3). Loosen the detent on the power supply device and unplug the connection cable from the socket. Loosen the detent on the vehicle, unplug the plug connector and close the cover of the 230 V connection.

8.12 Fuses

8.12.1 12 V fuses The appliances connected to the 12 V power supply in the living area are fused individually. The fuses can be accessed in the driver's cabin, on the bat- teries, on or next to the transformer and on the appliances.

Fig. 136 230 V fuse box with safety cut- out and FI-switch

Fig. 137 230 V connection on vehicle

Only replace defective fuses when the cause of the defect is known and has been remedied. Replace defective fuses only after the power supply has been turned off. Never bridge or repair fuses. Only replace faulty fuses with a new fuse with the same rating.

136 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

An intact 12 V fuse can be detected by the unbroken fuse element (Fig. 138,1). If the fuse element is broken (Fig. 138,2), change the fuse. Before changing fuses, take the function, value and colour of the relevant fuses from the following specifications. When changing fuses, only use flat fuses with the values shown below.

Fuses on the starter battery

The fuses are installed in the vicinity of the starter battery. The starter battery is on the floor between the seats in the driver's cabin and can be accessed under a cover.

Fuses on the living area battery

The fuses are fitted next to the living area battery.

Fuses on the relay box AD01

A relay box (AD01) is installed in one of the two seat consoles. The relay box helps generate the signals for the chassis lighting not provided by the base vehicle. The relay box can be used anywhere. The circuit used by us can vary from the circuit provided by the manufacturer. Consequently, the circuit can also vary from the display on the relay box type plate, which the manufacturer affixed.

Fig. 138 12 V fuse

1 Unbroken fuse element 2 Broken fuse element

Fig. 139 Fuses on the starter battery

1 Flat fuse 20 A/yellow (for the refrigerator)

2 Jumbo flat fuse 50 A/red

Fig. 140 Fuses on the living area battery

1 Jumbo flat fuse 50 A/red (for the transformer/rectifier)

2 Flat fuse 2 A/grey (for battery sensor, living area bat- tery)

137I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

FuNo Function Value/colour

B2 Cl. 15 (Ignition On) 15 A blue

B3 Cl. 30 (constant position) 15 A blue

B5 D+ Signal Internal polyswitch (2 A)

B6 Spare 15 A blue

B7 Front side marker lights (white/red) 5 A light brown

Function Value/colour

Fuses on the transformer/rectifier

(EBL 99)

Internal charger module 20 A yellow

Compressor/AES refrigerator 20 A yellow

Heater 10 A red

Basic light/electrically operated entrance step/radio 25 A white

Spare 4 25 A white

Spare 3 25 A white

Spare 2 15 A blue

Spare 1 15 A blue

Solar 15 A blue

Spare 5 15 A blue

Spare 6 15 A blue

Auxiliary charging unit 20 A yellow

Circuit 1 10 A red

Circuit 2 10 A red

TV 10 A red

Water pump 5 A light brown

Function Value/colour

Fuses on the transformer/rectifier

(EBL 220)

Auxiliary charging unit 2 25 A white

Auxiliary charging unit 1 25 A white

Internal charger module 20 A yellow

Spare 2 15 A blue

Pump (for water) 7.5 A brown

Circuit 3 10 A red

Circuit 2 15 A blue

Circuit 1 15 A blue

Spare 1 15 A blue

Circuit 5 15 A blue

Refrigerator 15 A blue

Heater 10 A red

Circuit 4 15 A blue

Refrigerator control 2 A grey

138 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

Fuse for the Thetford toilet (swivel toilet)

The fuse is located in the locker wall of the Thetford cassette.

Changing: Open the flap for the Thetford cassette on the outside of the vehicle. Pull out the Thetford cassette completely. Replace fuse (Fig. 141,1).

Fuse for the Thetford toilet (fixed seat)

The fuse is located in the locker wall of the Thetford cassette.

Changing: Open the flap for the Thetford cassette on the outside of the vehicle. Remove the Thetford cassette and swing out the flap in the housing panel. Replace fuse (Fig. 142,1).

Awning light 5 A light brown

Antenna 10 A red

TV 10 A red

Solar 15 A blue

Step 15 A blue

Awning 10 A red

Gas alarm 2 A grey

Pull-down bed 25 A white

Function Value/colour

Fig. 141 Fuse for the Thetford toilet

1 Flat fuse 3 A/purple

Fig. 142 Fuse for the Thetford toilet

1 Flat fuse 3 A/purple

139I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Fuse for the Dometic toilet The fuse is located on the rear side of the control unit for the toilet.

Changing: Lift the control unit for the toilet (Fig. 143,1) with a suitable tool and pull it from the wall. Replace fuse (Fig. 143,2).

Fuel cell fuse (special equipment)

Two fuses are located next to the living area battery.

Fuse on the solar charge regulator (special

equipment)

The fuse is located on the solar charge regulator.

Changing: Disconnect all 12 V appliances. Replace fuse (Fig. 145,1).

Fig. 143 Fuse for toilet

1 Control unit 2 Flat fuse 10 A/red

Fig. 144 Fuses for fuel cell

1 Flat fuse 2 A/grey 2 Flat fuse 15 A/blue

Fig. 145 Solar charge regulator fuse

1 Flat fuse 5 A/light brown

140 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

8.12.2 230 V fuse

A fault current protection switch (FI-switch) (Fig. 146,4) in the fuse box (Fig. 146,3) protects the complete vehicle from fault current (0.03 A). The downstream safety cut-out (10 A) (Fig. 146,2) secures the 230 V sockets, the power supply unit, the auxiliary charging unit and the refrigerator. For vehicles with special equipment, e.g. air conditioning unit, an additional safety cut-out (16 A) (Fig. 146,1) secures the device.

Position See chapter 16.

Checking fault current protection switch:

When the vehicle is connected to the 230 V power supply, press the test button (Fig. 146,5). The fault current protection switch (RCD) must be acti- vated.

8.13 External socket (special equipment)

The 230 V socket and the 12 V socket can be used to power electrical devices in the awning.

Check the fault current protection switch for each connection to the 230 V power supply, at least once every 6 months.

Fig. 146 230 V fuse box with safety cut- out and FI-switch

Fig. 147 External socket

1 TV socket 2 12 V socket 3 SAT socket 4 230 V socket

141I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Connection possibilities TV socket and SAT socket offer various possibilities for TV operation:

TV inside the vehicle (Fig. 148,4): Connection to roof antenna (Fig. 148,1) with connection cable (Fig. 148,2) TV inside the vehicle (Fig. 148,4): Connection to external antenna (Fig. 148,3) TV inside the awning (Fig. 149,4): Connection to roof antenna (Fig. 149,1) with connection cable (Fig. 149,2) TV inside the awning (Fig. 149,4): Connection to external antenna (Fig. 149,3)

Fig. 148 TV inside the vehicle Fig. 149 TV in the awning

142 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

8.14 Circuit diagrams 8.14.1 Circuit diagrams, interior

Fig. 150 Circuit diagram, interior (EBL 99)

143I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Fig. 151 Circuit diagram, interior (EBL 220)

144 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

Fig. 152 Block diagram for panel (IT 96-2)

A 1 2

2 x AMP flat pins 4.8 x 0.8 + 12 V Pump

B 1 2 3 4 5

Lumberg MSFQ 5-pin Full 3/4 1/2 1/4 Base waste water tank

C 1 2 3 4 5 6

Lumberg MSFQ 6-pin Full 3/4 1/2 1/4 Base water tank n. c.

D 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

Lumberg MSFQ 9-pin 12 V indicator 12 V main switch off 12 V main switch on + Starter battery 12 V + Living area battery sensor Negative living area battery sensor 230 V indicator n. c. n. c.

145I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

Fig. 153 Block diagram for panel (IT 994)

A 1 2

2 x AMP flat pins 4.8 x 0.8 + 12 V Pump

B 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

Lumberg MSFQ 9-pin 12 V indicator 12 V main switch off 12 V main switch on + Starter battery 12 V + Living area battery sensor Negative living area battery sensor 230 V indicator Shunt for appliances Shunt battery

C 1 2 3 4 5

Lumberg MSFQ 5-pin Full 3/4 1/2 1/4 Base waste water tank

D 1 2 3 4 5 6

Lumberg MSFQ 6-pin Full 3/4 1/2 1/4 Base water tank n. c.

E IN OUT

2 x Lumberg MSFQ 2-pin plugs External internal temperature sensor (optional) External temperature sensor

If an external internal temperature sensor is used, both gray stranded wires of the internal internal temperature sensor are separated.

146 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

Fig. 154 Block diagram, panel (LT 510)

X1 1 2 3 4 5 6

Lumberg MSFQ 6-pin Full 3/4 1/2 1/4 Base water tank n. c.

X2 1 2 3 4 5

Lumberg MSFQ 5-pin Full 3/4 1/2 1/4 Base waste water tank

X3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12

Lumberg MSFQ 12-pin Main switch relay 1 off Main switch relay 1 on Main switch relay 2 off Main switch relay 2 on Mains signal Shunt for appliances Shunt battery Negative living area battery sensor n. c. + Living area battery sensor + Starter battery 12 V + Lighting

147I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system 8

X6 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

Lumberg MSFQ 10-pin D+ Pump Tank heater Anti-freeze n. c. Solar starter battery Solar living area battery n. c. n. c. n. c.

X7 1 2

Lumberg MSFQ 2-pin KTY Pin 1 KTY Pin 2

X1 1 2 3 4

Lumberg MSFQ 4-pin ADI1 ADI2 +12 V GND

X2 1 2 3 4

Lumberg MSFQ 4-pin ADI1 ADI2 +12 V GND

148 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Electrical system8

8.14.2 Circuit diagram, exterior

Fiat

Fig. 155 Circuit diagram, exterior

Brstner colours Connection

Left side Grey Left direction indicator

Blue Fog tail light

White Earth return

Green Back-up light

Red Brake light

Black Left rear light

Right side Grey Right direction indicator

Blue Fog tail light

White Earth return

Green Back-up light

Red Brake light

Black Right rear light

149I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

9AppliancesChapter overview This chapter contains instructions regarding the appliances of the vehicle. The instructions refer exclusively to the operation of the appliances. Further information about the appliances can be found in the instruction man- uals for the appliances, included separately with the vehicle. The instructions address the following topics:

heater air conditioning unit boiler gas cooker gas oven microwave oven extractor hood refrigerator

9.1 General

The heater, air conditioning unit, boiler, cooker and refrigerator are fitted depending on the model of the vehicle. In this instruction manual a description is given only for the operation of the appliances and their particular features. To operate gas appliances, first open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap corresponding to the appliance.

The heat exchanger of the Truma hot-air heater has to be replaced after 30 years. The heat exchanger of the Alde hot-water heater has to be replaced after 10 years. Only the manufacturer of the heater or an author- ised specialist workshop is allowed to replace the heat exchanger. The operator of the heater must see to it that the parts are replaced. For safety reasons, spare parts for pieces of heating appliances must cor- respond with manufacturer's instructions and be permitted by the manufac- turer as a spare part. These spare parts may only be fitted by the manufacturer or an authorised specialist workshop.

Further information can be obtained in the instruction manual for the respective appliance.

Fig. 156 Symbols for the gas isolator taps

1 Oven 2 Refrigerator 3 Heater/boiler 4 Cooker

150 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

9.2 Heater

Start-up When lighting the heater for the first time a small amount of smoke and odour will occur. Immediately set the operating switch of the heater to its highest position. Open doors and windows and ventilate well. Smoke and odour will disappear by themselves after a while.

9.2.1 Models with waste gas vent on the right-hand side of the vehicle

9.2.2 To heat properly

Hot air distribution Several air outlet nozzles (Fig. 157) are built into the vehicle. Pipes conduct the warm air to the air outlet nozzles. Turn the air outlet nozzles in a suitable position so the air can escape as required. To avoid draft close the air outlet nozzles on the dashboard and set the air distribution of the base vehicle to air circulation.

Adjusting the air outlet nozzles

Fully open: Full hot air stream Half or partially open: Reduced hot air stream

Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion. Never run the heater in gas operation when refuelling, on ferries or in the garage. Danger of explosion! Never operate the heater in gas operation in closed spaces (e.g. garages). Danger of poisoning and suffocation! The waste gas vent may neither be closed nor blocked. Do not use the space behind the heater as a storage compartment.

The circulation fan of the hot-air heater automatically goes on when the hot-air heater is activated and is automatically switched off and on during operation by means of a thermostat control. This puts an immense strain on the living area battery, if the vehicle is connected to an external 230 V power supply. Take into consideration that the living area battery only has limited reserves of energy.

If the awning is put up and the heater is running in gas operation, exhaust gases from the heater can escape into the awning area. Danger of suffocation! Make sure the area is sufficiently ventilated.

Fig. 157 Air outlet nozzle

151I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

When five air outlet nozzles are completely opened, less warm air escapes through each nozzle. However, if only three air outlet nozzles are opened, more warm air flows out of each nozzle.

9.2.3 Truma Combi hot-air heater

Depending on the equipment, different heaters are installed in the vehicles. The heaters differ with regard to the energy type with which they can be oper- ated.

Operating modes All heaters have two operating modes:

Winter operation Summer operation

It is only possible to heat the vehicle in the "Winter" operating mode. With the "Summer" operating mode only water in the boiler is heated. It is not possible to heat the vehicle in this operating mode.

Selecting operating mode: Set the operating mode using the rotary switch (Fig. 158,3).

The power supply of the heater cannot be interrupted by means of the 12 V main switch.

Variant: Heater with gas operation

The heater is operated exclusively with gas.

Winter operation The heater selects the necessary burner setting according to the required room temperature. When the required room temperature is reached, the burner is switched off. In "Heater and boiler" operating mode (Fig. 158,6) water in the boiler is also heated. In the operating mode "Heater without boiler" (Fig. 158,5) the heater can be operated with an empty boiler.

Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Heater/ boiler". Turn the temperature control knob (Fig. 158,1) on the operating unit to the desired heating level. Set rotary switch (Fig. 158,3) to winter operation "Heater without boiler" (Fig. 158,5) or to winter operation "Heater and boiler" (Fig. 158,6).

Green indicator lamp (Fig. 158,7) is on.

When there is a danger of frost the heater is not in operation, empty the heating system.

Fig. 158 Operating unit for heater/boiler

1 Temperature control knob 2 Summer operation water tempera-

ture 40 C or 60 C 3 Rotary switch 4 Off 5 Winter operation "Heater without

boiler" 6 Winter operation "Heater and boiler" 7 Green indicator lamp "Heating opera-

tion" 8 Red indicator lamp "Fault" 9 Yellow indicator lamp "Boiler heating-

up phase"

152 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

The circulation fan automatically switches on when the heater is activated.

Switching off: Set the rotary switch (Fig. 158,3) to " " (Fig. 158,4). Close the gas isolator tap "Heater/boiler" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.

After switching off the heater, the circulation fan may still run for a moment to use up the residual heat.

Summer operation It is not possible to heat the vehicle in "Summer" operating mode. In "Summer" operating mode, only the water in the boiler is heated.

Variant: Heater with gas and 230 V electrical

operation

The heater can be operated with different types of energy:

Gas operation (Fig. 159,3) 230 V electrical operation with the output levels 900 W (Fig. 159,2) or 1800 W (Fig. 159,1) Gas and 230 V electrical operation (mixed operation) with the output levels 900 W (Fig. 159,4) or 1800 W (Fig. 159,5)

The combination gas operation and 230 V electrical operation reduces the heating-up time (only possible when the heater is set to winter operation at the operating unit (Fig. 158)). When 230 V electrical operation is selected, the yellow indicator lamp illumi- nates (Fig. 159,6).

230 V electrical operation is only possible when the vehicle is connected to the 230 V power supply. Select the output level for 230 V electrical operation so that it corresponds to the fuse protection of the 230 V connection (900 W for 3.9 A fuse, 1800 W for 7.8 A fuse). When the heater on the operating unit is set to summer operation and the energy selector switch is set to mixed operation, the heater still runs only in 230 V operation. The gas burner is not switched on.

Fig. 159 Energy selector switch for heater/boiler

1 230 V electrical operation (1800 W) 2 230 V electrical operation (900 W) 3 Gas operation 4 Gas and 230 V electrical operation

(900 W) 5 Gas and 230 V electrical operation

(1800 W) 6 Yellow indicator lamp "230 V elec-

trical operation"

Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual. For further information about the use of the boiler see section "Boiler".

153I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

9.2.4 Alde hot-water heater (partially special equipment)

The hot-water heater is installed at the bottom of the wardrobe or under the beds.

Operating unit The operating unit is divided into two sections:

Display (touch screen) Control buttons

Control buttons The control buttons have the following functions:

Display The display (Fig. 160,1) is designed as a touch screen. Touching the symbols calls up the relevant function.

Never run hot-water heater without heating fluid. Observe notes in chapter 12. Never drill holes in the floor. This might damage the hot-water pipes.

The circulating pump must always be turned on when the hot-water heater is in operation. We recommend to bleed the heating system after the initial heater opera- tion and to check the glycol content. Observe notes in chapter 12. When the heater is turned on, it starts with the last settings used. For further information, see the separate manufacturer's instruction manual and observe the maintenance instructions found in chapter 12. For further information about the use of the boiler see section "Boiler".

Fig. 160 Operating unit for hot-water heater

1 Display (touch screen) 2 "Menu" button 3 On/Off button

When no button is pressed, the operating unit automatically switches to home position after two minutes. Changes to the settings are saved automatically after 10 seconds.

Pos. in Fig. 160

Button Function

2 MENU Open adjustment menu

3 Activate heating

154 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

Start screen The Start screen appears on the display after the heater is switched on. The Start screen contains the following information:

Adjustment menu The "MENU" button calls up the adjustment menu. The meanings of the indi- vidual symbols are described in the following table. The values can be increased or reduced via the "+" or "-" symbols.

Tool menus The various heater functions can be called up and adjusted via the tool menus. The arrow symbols are used to change between the menus. The meanings of the individual symbols are described in the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Selecting the operating mode

The hot-water heater can be operated with the following energy sources:

Gas operation 230 V electrical operation Gas and 230 V electrical operation

The operating mode is selected from the operating unit.

Selecting gas operation: Press the "On" button next to the " " symbol. The gas operation is acti- vated.

Selecting 230 V electrical operation:

Press the "+" button next to the " " symbol until the desired heat output is reached.

Selecting gas and 230 V electrical operation:

Select gas operation and 230 V electrical operation on the operating unit.

Symbol Signification

This symbol appears when the circulating pump is activated

This symbol appears when a switching facility for gas cylinders is activated

This symbol appears when a voltage of 230 V is present at the heater

The internal temperature is displayed next to this symbol

The external temperature is displayed next to this symbol if an external sensor is fitted

Symbol Signification

Set the desired temperature of +5 C to +30 C

Set the water temperature in the boiler

Set the heat output in electrical operation

Activate the function "Heating in gas operation"

Call up the enabling menu for the tool menus

Select the output level during 230 V electrical operation in such a way that it corresponds to the 230 V connection protection: Level 1 (1050 W) at 6 A Level 2 (2100 W) at 10 A Level 3 (3150 W) at 16 A

155I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

When the heater is turned on, it starts with the last set operating mode.

Switching on the heater: Press " " button. The Start screen appears in the display. The heater starts automatically.

Switching the heater off: Press " " button. The heater is turned off.

Setting the rotational speed of the circulating

pump

The rotational speed of the circulating pump can be set with the control knob (Fig. 161,2). At a lower rotary speed, the operating sounds of the pump are quieter. The control knob is located on the circulating pump (Fig. 161,1).

Setting the output: Turn the control knob (Fig. 161,2) in an anticlockwise direction. The output is reduced. Rotate the control knob in a clockwise direction. The output is increased.

3-way valve For models with a rear bed, a 3-way valve is connected to the hot water heater circulation. The 3-way valve is installed in the rear garage. The 3-way valve can be accessed via an external flap.

If gas and 230 V electrical operation is selected and if the vehicle is con- nected to the 230 V power supply, then the hot-water heater at first only operates in 230 V electric operation. Only if the heat output is insufficient does the gas operation also automatically switch on. The gas operation is only possible when the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap are opened. 230 V electrical operation is only possible when the vehicle is connected to the 230 V power supply.

The hot-water heater is equipped with a very powerful pump. Only operate the pump for approx. 5 minutes on full output when the system is emptied or the pipes are bled. Otherwise, this will increase wear; loud operating noises are the result.

Fig. 161 Speed reduction

156 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

Opening the heat circulation in the rear area:

Set the lever (Fig. 162,2) of the 3-way valve (Fig. 162,1) parallel to the straight flow direction (Fig. 162).

Locking the heat circulation in the rear area:

Set the lever (Fig. 162,2) of the 3-way valve (Fig. 162,1) transverse to the straight flow direction.

Alde heat exchanger (special equipment)

The heat exchanger can be used to heat the living area of the vehicle during travel without operating the hot-water heater in the living area. The heat exchanger is connected to the vehicle engine's cooling circuit and thus has the same function as the vehicle heater. Heat output is set with the living area's heating regulator. The heat exchanger stopcock is located directly on the exchanger.

Turning on: Set stopcock handle (Fig. 163,1) parallel to the pipe.

Shutting off: Set drain cock handle (Fig. 163,1) at a right angle to the pipe.

Position The heat exchanger is installed in the rear bench seat of the central seating group.

Fig. 162 3-way valve

The heat exchanger only works when the vehicle engine is running. If the heat exchanger is not being used (as in the summer), the heat exchanger on the stopcock should be shut off.

Fig. 163 Alde heat exchanger

157I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

Alde auxiliary circulating pump (special equipment)

The auxiliary circulating pump (Fig. 164,1) can be used to heat the vehicle engine when parked. The auxiliary circulating pump is connected to the vehicle engine's cooling cir- cuit and thus functions as an engine heater.

The auxiliary circulating pump switch (Fig. 165,2 or Fig. 166) is located next to the hot-water heater operating unit. The yellow indicator lamp (Fig. 165,1) illu- minates when the pump is operated.

9.2.5 Auxiliary heat exchanger (partially special equipment)

The auxiliary heat exchanger is built into the bench seat. The auxiliary heat exchanger may be used to provide the vehicle's living area with additional heat during the journey. The auxiliary heat exchanger is integrated into the heat circulation of the base vehicle and is therefore only in operation when the vehicle engine is running.

The auxiliary circulating pump works only if the heat exchanger has been installed and started, and the hot-water heater is running.

Fig. 164 Auxiliary circulating pump

Fig. 165 Operating switch for auxiliary circulating pump

Fig. 166 Operating switch for auxiliary circulating pump (alternative)

The fan on the auxiliary heat exchanger can be used for ventilation. The heat output is continuously adjusted.

158 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

Switching on: Push the sliding regulator (Fig. 167,1) of the flow control downward to the desired position. The water circulation is open. Turn the fan switch (Fig. 167,2) for the circulation fan in a clockwise direc- tion.

Switching off: Turn the fan switch (Fig. 167,2) to " ". Push the sliding regulator (Fig. 167,1) of the flow control upward as far as it goes.

9.2.6 Electrical floor warming unit (special equipment)

The transformer (Fig. 168,1) for the electrical floor warming unit is installed either in the bench seat, in the bedding box or in the rear garage, depending on the model.

Fig. 167 Operating controls for auxiliary heat exchanger

On models with electrical floor warming unit, never drill holes in the floor or screw in any screws. Careful with sharp objects. There is danger of a power cut or a short circuit due to damage to a heater wire.

Do not cover the transformer. Danger of overheating!

The electrical floor warming unit only operates if the vehicle is connected to the 230 V power supply. The output of the electrical floor warming unit alone is not sufficient to heat the living area.

Fig. 168 Transformer for electrical floor warming unit

Fig. 169 Switch for electrical floor warming unit

159I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

Switching on: Connect the vehicle to the 230 V power supply (see chapter 8). Press the rocker switch (Fig. 169,2). The indicator lamp (Fig. 169,1) on the switch is illuminated.

Switching off: Press the rocker switch (Fig. 169,2). The indicator lamp (Fig. 169,1) on the switch goes off.

After switching off, the floor remains warm for a while, due to residual heat. If the transformer is overloaded, the overload protection is actuated. The pin (Fig. 168,2) jumps out.

Switching on overload protection:

Press the pin (Fig. 168,2) on the overload protection when the transformer is cooled.

9.2.7 Independent vehicle heater (special equipment)

The inside and the engine can be heated with the independent vehicle heater. The heating of the engine can be switched off. The independent vehicle heater can be turned on and off manually or with a timer. The time for the heating to start can be exactly preselected from 1 minute to 24 hours. It is possible to program three switching on times, of which only one can be activated. The maximum permitted operation time is 60 minutes.

Switching on manually: Press the button (Fig. 170,7). The heating mode is displayed by the symbol (Fig. 170,9). The fan will only be switched on when there is a coolant tem- perature of 30 C.

Switching off manually: Press the button (Fig. 170,7). The symbol (Fig. 170,9) goes off.

Switching on the engine heating:

Press the lower part of the switch (Fig. 170,4). Engine is preheated. The fan is switched on immediately.

Switching off the engine heating:

Press the upper part of the switch (Fig. 170,4). Engine stays cold.

Do not operate the heater in closed spaces. Danger of suffocation! Do not operate the heater at petrol stations. Danger of explosion!

Fig. 170 Operating unit for independent vehicle heater

160 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

Setting the time: Press the button (Fig. 170,2). The time setting is displayed by the symbol (Fig. 170,8). Set the time with the buttons (Fig. 170,3 and 6).

Programming heating start: Press the button (Fig. 170,5). Set the switching on time within ten seconds, with the buttons (Fig. 170,3 and 6).

Selecting programmed switching on time:

Keep pressing the button (Fig. 170,5) until the selected programme number (Fig. 170,1) appears in the display.

9.3 Air conditioning unit (special equipment) 9.3.1 Dometic

To execute the individual switching commands, always point the remote con- trol in the direction of the ceiling unit.

Operating modes The air conditioning unit has the following operating modes:

Automatic Ventilation, manual Cooling, manual Heating, manual

Switching on: Press the ON/OFF button (Fig. 171,9). Press the "Mode" button (Fig. 171,11) as often as required until the required mode (Fig. 171,1, 2, 3 or 4) is indicated on the display (Fig. 171,20).

If the unit is operating, always open at least one ventilation flap.

In the winter, vehicle heating can be supported but not replaced by the air conditioning unit. Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 171 Remote control

1 Symbol for automatic mode 2 Symbol for cold mode 3 Symbol for warm mode 4 Symbol for ventilation mode 5 Symbol for discharged batteries 6 Time 7 Temperature display 8 Fan speed display 9 ON/OFF button

10 Fan speed button 11 "MODE" button 12 "CLOCK" button 13 Reset key 14 Interior temperature display button

"ROOM" 15 Store button "SET" 16 Light button "LIGHT"(optional) 17 Temperature unit change button

"F/C" 18 Temperature decrease button "-" 19 Temperature increase button "+" 20 Display

161I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

Use the "+" (Fig. 171,19) and "" (Fig. 171,18) buttons to set the desired temperature. Use the fan speed button (Fig. 171,10) to select the desired fan level.

Switching off: Press the ON/OFF button (Fig. 171,9).

LED The LED (Fig. 172,4) on the ceiling unit (Fig. 172,1) displays the operating status of the air conditioning unit:

Air current The air current can be directed in different directions. The distribution of the air current toward the front or back is continuously adjustable.

Adjusting air current: Align the two deflectors (Fig. 172,3 and 5) in the desired position. Rotate knob (Fig. 172,2) on sliding regulator in an anticlockwise direction. The sliding regulator for air distribution is released. Slide the sliding regulator forwards or backwards to the desired position. The side on which the sliding regulator is located is closed. Turn the knob tight in the clockwise direction.

9.3.2 Telair

Fig. 172 Air conditioning unit (Dometic)

Status LED Signification

Off Air conditioning unit off

Orange Air conditioning unit ready to operate

Green Air conditioning unit in operation

Red (continuous) No 230 V power connection

Red (flashes once intermit- tently)

Fault in the interior temperature gauge

Red (flashes twice intermit- tently)

Fault in the exterior temperature gauge

Always wait at least 2 minutes between switching off and switching on again. Otherwise the compressor will be damaged. If the unit is operating, always open at least one ventilation flap.

The air conditioning unit only runs if the vehicle is connected to a 230 V power supply. In the winter, vehicle heating can be supported but not replaced by the air conditioning unit.

162 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

To execute the individual switching commands, always point the remote con- trol in the direction of the receiver.

Operating modes Automatic Cooling Heater

Switching on: Press the "ON/OFF" button (Fig. 173,7). Press the "Mode" button (Fig. 173,10) as often as required until the required mode (Fig. 173,1, 2 or 3) is indicated on the display. The corre- sponding indicator lamp on the diffusor display (Fig. 174,3) lights up. Use the temperature increase button (Fig. 173,6) or temperature reduction button (Fig. 173,8) to set the required temperature. Use the ventilation speed button (Fig. 173,9) to select the required ventila- tion level.

Switching off: Press the "ON/OFF" button (Fig. 173,7).

Following switch-on the air conditioning unit needs approx. 3 minutes until the compressor starts to run and cold air or hot air is output. Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 173 Remote control

1 Symbol for automatic 2 Symbol for cooling 3 Symbol for heater 4 Temperature (set) display 5 Fan speed display 6 Temperature increase button 7 "ON/OFF" button 8 Temperature reduction button 9 Ventilation speed button

10 "Mode" button 11 Display

Fig. 174 Display on the diffusor

1 Mains connection indicator lamp 2 Temperature (current) display 3 Mode indicator lamp

Green: Cooling Red: Heater

If the air conditioning unit has run in heating mode, the blower will run on for some minutes in order to dissipate the heat completely.

163I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

9.4 Boiler

9.4.1 Models with waste gas vent on the right-hand side of the vehicle

9.4.2 Truma Combi boiler

The boiler is integrated into the heater and is operated with gas (gas opera- tion) or with gas and/or electricity (gas and 230 V electrical operation). The boiler is switched on by turning the rotary switch (Fig. 175,2) on the operating unit (Fig. 175). The type of energy is pre-selected (gas and 230 V electrical operation) with the energy selector switch (Fig. 177). In winter operation "Heater and boiler" (Fig. 175,3) the water is automatically heated up when the heater is switched on. If the heater switches off after the required room temperature has been reached, the boiler will continue to heat up until the set water temperature has been reached.

Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion. Never run the boiler in gas operation when refuelling, on ferries or in the garage. Danger of explosion! Never operate the boiler in gas operation in closed spaces (e.g. garages). Danger of poisoning and suffocation! The water in the boiler can be heated up to 65 C. Risk of scalding!

Never use boiler when empty. If the boiler is not being used, empty it if there is any risk of frost. Only operate the boiler with the maximum temperature setting if you require a large quantity of warm water. This protects the boiler against the build-up of limescale.

Do not use the water from the boiler as drinking water.

If the awning is put up and the boiler is running in gas operation, exhaust gases from the boiler can escape into the awning area. Danger of suffo- cation! Make sure the area is sufficiently ventilated.

Fig. 175 Operating unit for heater/boiler

1 Summer operation water tempera- ture 40 C or 60 C

2 Rotary switch 3 Winter operation "Heater and boiler" 4 Red indicator lamp "Fault" 5 Yellow indicator lamp "Boiler heating-

up phase"

164 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

In summer operation (Fig. 175,1) only the water in the boiler is heated up to either 40 C or 60 C. The water is heated to 60 C in approx. 25 minutes. The yellow indicator lamp (Fig. 175,5) illuminates during the boiler heating-up period. The power supply for the appliance cannot be interrupted by means of the 12 V main switch. When there is a fault, the red indicator lamp (Fig. 175,4) on the operating unit illuminates (see chapter 14).

Safety/drainage valve The boiler is equipped with a safety/drainage valve (Fig. 176). The safety/ drainage valve prevents water in the boiler from freezing, when there is frost and the heater is not switched on.

Position See chapter 16.

Variant: Boiler with gas operation

The boiler is operated exclusively with gas.

Winter operation In the "heater and boiler" switch setting in winter operation, the boiler is already switched on.

Summer operation In summer operation the water can be heated up to 40 C or 60 C.

Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Heater/ boiler". Set the rotary switch (Fig. 175,2) on the operating unit (Fig. 175) to "Summer operation" (Fig. 175,1).

The yellow indicator lamp (Fig. 175,5) is illuminated during the heating up period. When the set water temperature is reached, the period of heating up is finished and the yellow indicator lamp fades.

When the vehicle is not used for a long period of time, open the safety/ drainage valve and empty the boiler. At temperatures below 2 C the safety/drainage valve opens automatically. Only if the temperature of the safety/drainage valve lies above 6 C can it be shut again. The water pump and the water fittings are not protected against freezing by the safety/drainage valve.

The drainage neck of the safety/drainage valve has to be free of dirt (e.g. leaves, ice) at all times.

Fig. 176 Safety/drainage valve of the boiler

165I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

Switching off: Set the rotary switch (Fig. 175,2) on the operating unit (Fig. 175) to " ". Close the gas isolator tap "Heater/boiler" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.

Variant: Boiler with gas and 230 V electrical

operation

The boiler can be operated with different types of energy:

Gas operation (Fig. 177,3) 230 V electrical operation with the output levels 900 W (Fig. 177,2) or 1800 W (Fig. 177,1) Gas and 230 V electrical operation (mixed operation) with the output levels 900 W (Fig. 177,4) or 1800 W (Fig. 177,5)

The combination gas operation and 230 V electrical operation reduces the heating-up time (only possible when the boiler is set to winter operation at the operating unit (Fig. 175)). When 230 V electrical operation is selected, the yellow indicator lamp illumi- nates (Fig. 177,6).

Filling/emptying the boiler The boiler can be supplied with water from the water tank.

Filling the boiler with water: Switch on 12 V power supply on the panel. Close the safety/drainage valve. Turn the knob (Fig. 176,1) perpendicular to the safety/drainage valve and push the push button (Fig. 176,2) in. Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them. The water pump is turned on. The warm water pipes are filled with water. Keep the taps open until the water flowing out of the taps has no bubbles in it. This is the only way to ensure that the boiler is full of water. Close all water taps.

230 V electrical operation is only possible when the vehicle is connected to the 230 V power supply. Select the output level for 230 V electrical operation so that it corresponds to the fuse protection of the 230 V connection (900 W for 3.9 A fuse, 1800 W for 7.8 A fuse). When the boiler on the operating unit is set to summer operation and the energy selector switch is set to mixed operation, the boiler still runs only in 230 V operation. The gas burner is not switched on.

Fig. 177 Energy selector switch for heater/boiler

1 230 V electrical operation (1800 W) 2 230 V electrical operation (900 W) 3 Gas operation 4 Gas and 230 V electrical operation

(900 W) 5 Gas and 230 V electrical operation

(1800 W) 6 Yellow indicator lamp "230 V elec-

trical operation"

166 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

Emptying the boiler: Set the rotary switch (Fig. 175,2) on the operating unit (Fig. 175) to " ". Open the safety/drainage valve. To do this turn the knob (Fig. 176,1) par- allel to the safety/drainage valve. The push button (Fig. 176,2) jumps out. The boiler is drained to the outside by the safety/drainage valve. Check whether the water has been drained completely from the boiler (approx. 12 litres).

9.4.3 Alde boiler (partially special equipment)

Switching the boiler on/ off

The boiler is integrated in the hot-water heater. A separate operation is not possible. For operating the hot-water heater, see section 9.2.4.

Filling/emptying the boiler The boiler can be supplied with water from the water tank.

Filling the boiler with water: Close the drain cock(s). Position the rocking lever (Fig. 178,1) horizontally. Switch on 12 V power supply on the panel. Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them. The water pump is turned on. The warm water pipes are filled with water. Keep the taps open until the water flowing out of the taps has no bubbles in it. This is the only way to ensure that the boiler is full of water. Close all water taps.

Emptying the boiler: Switch off boiler. Open all water taps and set to the central position. Open drain cock(s) (Fig. 178). To do so, set the rocking lever (Fig. 178,1) in a vertical position. The boiler is drained to the outside. Check whether the water has been drained completely from the boiler (approx. 10 litres).

Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Depending on the model, the vehicle is fitted with one or two drain cocks.

Fig. 178 Drain cock

167I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

Position of the drain cock(s)

See chapter 16.

9.5 Cooker

9.5.1 Gas cooker

The vehicle kitchen unit is fitted with a three-burner gas cooker. The operating controls for the gas cooker are located directly at the gas cooker.

Manual ignition The gas cooker must be lit manually.

For further information, see the separate manufacturer's instruction manual and observe the maintenance instructions found in chapter 12.

Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion. Before using the cooker make sure that there is sufficient ventilation. Open windows or the skylight. Do not use gas cooker or gas oven for heating. Do not fit any curtains in the immediate proximity of the cooker. Fire hazard! Always protect your hands with cooking gloves or potholders when han- dling hot pots, pans and similar items. There is a risk of injury.

During activation and operation of the gas cooker, no flammable objects or highly inflammable objects such as dishcloths, napkins etc. must be near the gas cooker. Fire hazard! The process of ignition must be visible from above and must not be cov- ered by cooking pans placed on the cooker. If there is a flame protection, always put it up when using the gas cooker. Depending on the model, the gas cooker lid is held closed by a spring. When closing there is danger of getting injured!

Do not place hot objects such as cooking pans on the sink cover. The plastic can become deformed. Do not use the glass gas cooker lid as a hob. Do not close the gas cooker lid while the gas cooker is in operation. Do not apply pressure on the gas cooker lid when it is closed. Do not place hot cooking pans on the gas cooker lid. Keep the gas cooker lid open after cooking until the burners are cool. Oth- erwise the glass plate could shatter.

Only use pots and pans whose diameter is appropriate for the gas cooker burners. When the flame goes out, the thermocouple automatically cuts the gas supply. Further information can be obtained in the device manufacturer's instruc- tion manual.

168 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Cooker". Open the gas cooker lid (Fig. 179,3). Depending on the model, either fold out or set up the flame protection (Fig. 179,1). Turn the control knob (Fig. 179,2) on the burner you wish to use to the igni- tion position (large flame). Press the control knob down and hold it. Light the burner with a gas lighter, a match or other suitable means of lighting. Once the flame is burning, the control knob must be held down for 10 to 15 seconds, until the thermocouple automatically keeps the gas supply open. Release the control knob and turn to the desired setting. If ignition is unsuccessful, repeat the entire procedure.

Switching off: Turn the control knob to the 0-position. The flame fades. Close the gas isolator tap "Cooker" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.

Automatic ignition (with lighting knob)

The gas cooker is equipped with electronic ignition.

Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Cooker". Open the gas cooker lid. Depending on the model, fold out and lock the flame protection. Turn the control knob (Fig. 180,1) on the burner you wish to use to the igni- tion position (large flame). Press the control knob down and hold it.

Fig. 179 Gas cooker

Fig. 180 Operating controls for gas cooker

169I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

Press lighting knob (Fig. 180,2). Ignition sparks are generated at the burner. Once the flame is burning, the control knob must be held down for 10 to 15 seconds, until the thermocouple automatically keeps the gas supply open. Release the control knob and turn to the desired setting.

Switching off: Turn the control knob to the 0-position. The flame fades. Close the gas isolator tap "Cooker" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.

Automatic ignition (without lighting knob)

The gas cooker is equipped with electronic ignition.

Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Cooker". Open the gas cooker lid. Depending on the model, fold out and lock the flame protection. Turn the control knob (Fig. 181,1) on the burner you wish to use to the igni- tion position (large flame). Press the control knob down and hold it. The automatic ignition produces ignition sparks. A clicking noise can be heard. Once the flame is burning, the control knob must be held down for 10 to 15 seconds, until the thermocouple automatically keeps the gas supply open. Release the control knob and turn to the desired setting.

Switching off: Turn the control knob to the 0-position. The flame fades. Close the gas isolator tap "Cooker" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.

9.5.2 Gas oven (Dometic) (special equipment)

Fig. 181 Operating controls for gas cooker

Keep the ventilation openings on the gas oven open at all times. There must be no flammable objects near the gas oven when it is being lit. If ignition has not taken place, repeat the entire procedure. If necessary, check if there is gas and/or current in the gas oven. If the gas oven still does not work, close the gas isolator tap and notify your service centre.

170 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

The gas oven is equipped with electronic ignition.

The meaning of the symbols on the control knobs (Fig. 182,1 and Fig. 183,1) of the two gas ovens is identical:

and mean oven and mean grill.

Switching the oven on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Oven". Open oven door completely. The safety switch then releases the ignition. Press and hold control knob and turn it anti-clockwise to the required set- ting. Keep control knob pressed for a further 5-10 seconds. Ignition will take place automatically.

If the burner flame is accidentally extinguished, turn the control knob to " " and leave the burner off for at least 1 minute. Then ignite it again. Parts of the gas oven become very hot during operation. Never touch hot parts with bare hands. Place the meals, wire rack and drip pan into the gas oven so that they do not come into contact with the flame. Only ignite the oven and grill when the oven door is open. Always leave the oven door half open when grilling. Do not use the grill for longer than 25 minutes.

There are two different versions of the gas oven, depending on the model. Although their appearance is not identical, operation is the same for both. Depending on the model the gas oven may come equipped with a grill. Before using the gas oven for the first time run it for 30 minutes at max- imum temperature without any contents. When the flame goes out, the thermocouple automatically cuts the gas supply. A safety switch prevents ignition when the oven door is closed. If the ignition procedure fails repeatedly, turn the control knob to " ". Wait at least 1 minute and then ignite the gas oven manually. If necessary, check if there is gas and/or current in the gas oven. If the gas oven still does not work, close the gas isolator tap and notify your service centre. Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.

Fig. 182 Gas oven (Dometic TecTower) Fig. 183 Gas oven (Dometic)

171I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

Release control knob. Close oven door.

Switching the grill on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Oven". Open the oven door to at least the first locking position (approx. 45). Press and hold control knob and turn it clockwise to the grill symbol. Keep control knob pressed for a further 5-10 seconds. Ignition will take place automatically. Release control knob.

Switching off: Turn the control knob to " ". The flame fades. Close the gas isolator tap "Oven" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.

9.5.3 Microwave oven (special equipment)

Do not close the oven door when grilling.

Only qualified personnel may repair the microwave oven. Improper repairs can cause major risks to the user. The protection device against the escape of microwave energy should never be removed. Use the microwave oven only if it has been properly installed. Only use the microwave oven when the door seal is free of damage. Never leave the microwave oven unattended when it is in operation. If there is smoke, keep the microwave oven closed, switch it off and interrupt the power supply.

Operate the microwave oven only with the rotary plate and the rotary cross in place. Use only crockery suitable for microwave use.

The microwave oven only functions with correct 230 V power supply. In the case of fluctuations of the voltage or of voltage below 230 V, the microwave oven switches itself off completely. Therefore, do not switch on additional 230 V appliances when the microwave oven is in operation. Particularly in southern countries it happens that the line voltage is described as having 230 V but it really does not amount to this value. So it may happen that the microwave oven cannot be operated in these countries. Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.

172 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

Switching on: Press the key (Fig. 184,3) to open the door and place food into the cooking area. Close the door. A clicking noise can be heard when it engages. Select the output on the control knob (Fig. 184,1). Select the cooking time with the control knob (Fig. 184,2). Cooking begins.

The end of the cooking process is signalled by a signal tone. The microwave oven will switch off automatically.

Switching off: Press the key (Fig. 184,3) to open the door and take out the food.

9.5.4 Extractor hood (special equipment)

The cooking area is equipped with an extractor hood. The powerful fan blows the cooking steam directly outside. To switch on the extractor hood, press the right flip switch (Fig. 185,2 or Fig. 186,2). Use the left flip switch (Fig. 185,1 or Fig. 186,1) to switch on the two lights in the extractor hood.

Fig. 184 Operating controls for micro- wave oven

Fig. 185 Extractor hood Fig. 186 Extractor hood (alternative)

173I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

9.6 Refrigerator During the journey, only operate the refrigerator via the 12 V power supply. At high ambient temperatures the refrigerator is unable to reach its full cooling power. At high external temperatures, the full cooling power of the cooling unit is only guaranteed if the refrigerator is ventilated sufficiently. In order to achieve a better ventilation the refrigerator ventilation grill can be removed.

9.6.1 Refrigerator ventilation grill

Removal: Push sliding trap (Fig. 187,1) upward. Remove refrigerator ventilation grill.

Removal: Turn screw (Fig. 188,1) one quarter turn using a coin. Remove refrigerator ventilation grill.

When leaving the vehicle, always mount the refrigerator ventilation grill. Otherwise water can enter during rain. The cooling power of the refrigerator depends on the vehicle setup. The cooling power can decrease if the vehicle is inclined by 5 or more. There- fore, always park the vehicle on level ground. Absorption refrigerators operate at normal room temperature (approx. 21 C) within the specified temperature range. At significantly higher ambient temperatures (> 30 C), the cooling power is reduced. This is because the "evaporating temperature" of the refrigerant is lower in absorption refrigerators than it is in compressor refrigerators.

Fig. 187 Refrigerator ventilation grill (with sliding trap)

Fig. 188 Refrigerator ventilation grill (with screw)

174 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

9.6.2 Operation (Dometic 7 series with automatic power selection AES and frame heater)

Operating modes The refrigerator is equipped with automatic power selection (AES). If the selector switch is set to "AUTO", the AES automatically selects the optimum energy source and regulates the refrigerator operation. Manual intervention to select the type of power is possible but not required. The AES selects from the following types of power:

230 V AC Gas 12 V DC

Choosing the available energy source highest on the list.

230 V operation If the automatic mode is selected and the 230 V supply is switched on, the AES selects this energy source first.

12 V operation 12 V operation is only selected by the AES if the vehicle's engine is running and the alternator supplies sufficient 12 V operating power.

Gas operation

If the 230 V power supply is not connected and the vehicle's engine is not run- ning the AES selects the gas supply. When selecting gas operation the igni- tion fuse is opened automatically so gas can get into the burner. At the same time the electronic ignition is activated. If the gas flame is extinguished, e.g. by blast of wind, the ignition is activated immediately and re-ignites the gas. When the gas operation is faulty, the "GAS" indicator lamp (Fig. 189,4) flashes red.

The refrigerator always requires a 12 V control voltage, regardless of which type of energy it is using. The control voltage is present as soon as the transformer/rectifier is switched on. Therefore the closed circuit current always flows even if the refrigerator is switched off. Always switch off the transformer/rectifier for a temporary lay-up.

Fig. 189 Operating controls for the refrigerator (Dometic 7 series with AES and FH)

1 Frame heater (FH) button 2 Indicator lamp 3 Energy selector switch 4 Indicator lamps 5 Indicator lamps 6 Control knob for setting the tempera-

ture

Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion. It is not permitted to operate the refrigerator with car gas.

Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Refriger- ator".

175I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

Change-over between energy sources

When changing over from 230 V or 12 V to gas, delay times are built into the AES. For example, when changing over from 12 V operation to gas operation, a 15 minute delay is built in the AES. This prevents a change-over to gas oper- ation when the vehicle is stopped briefly and the engine is switched off (e.g. stop to fill tank).

Refrigerating temperature control

When turned on the first time the refrigerator automatically selects the middle thermostat position. This position can be adjusted manually by using the con- trol knob (Fig. 189,6). The indicator lamps (Fig. 189,5) show the selected ther- mostat position. The refrigerating temperature for the three types of energy is set with the control knob. It takes a few hours till the refrigerator reaches its normal operating temperature. When changing over the operating mode the thermostat setting will be maintained. The refrigerating temperature is retained regardless of the type of power being used.

Frame heater (FH)

High external temperatures and high humidity can cause drops of water to form on the metal frame of the freezer compartment. This is why the refriger- ator is equipped with a frame heater for the freezer compartment. If the tem- perature and humidity are high, switch on the frame heater by pressing the button (Fig. 189,1). This prevents corrosion. If the frame heater is switched on, the indicator lamp (Fig. 189,2) will be lit.

Manual operation

Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Refriger- ator". Select the energy type with the energy selector switch (Fig. 189,3). The respective indicator lamp (Fig. 189,4) lights up green. Adjust refrigerating temperature with the control knob (Fig. 189,6). The indicator lamps (Fig. 189,5) show the selected thermostat position.

When the gas operation is faulty, the "GAS" indicator lamp (Fig. 189,4) flashes red. When operated with 12 V, the refrigerator draws power only from the living area battery.

Open flames are prohibited at petrol stations. If the stop takes longer than 15 minutes, the refrigerator has to be turned off at the energy selector switch.

If the frame heater is switched on, it will always consume current. There- fore, switch off the frame heater if the vehicle engine is off and the vehicle is not connected to the 230 V power supply.

If the refrigerator is manually set to "12 V", it will constantly consume cur- rent. Therefore, switch over to gas operation when the vehicle engine is not running, and the vehicle is not connected to the 230 V power supply.

176 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

Switching off: Turn the energy selector switch (Fig. 189,3) to " ". No indicator lamp (Fig. 189,4) is lit. Close the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.

9.6.3 Operation (Dometic 8 series with automatic power selection AES)

Operating modes

The refrigerator is equipped with automatic power selection (AES). If auto- matic operation (AU) is selected, the AES automatically selects the optimum energy source and regulates the refrigerator operation. Manual intervention to select the type of power is possible but not required. The AES selects from the following types of power:

230 V AC Gas 12 V DC

Choosing the available energy source highest on the list.

In the case of a fault, the LED display fault will flash " " (Fig. 190,3).

230 V operation If the automatic mode is selected and the 230 V supply is switched on, the AES selects this energy source first.

12 V operation If the automatic mode is selected, the AES selects the 12 V operation only if the vehicle engine is running.

Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual "Refrigerator".

Fig. 190 Operating controls for the refrigerator (Dometic 8 series with AES)

1 On/off switch/energy selector switch 2 Display-LED "open door" (only for central locking system of the refrigerator door) 3 Display-LED "fault" 4 Operating indicator 5 Display-LED "temperature range" 6 Switch for temperature setting 7 Door opener (only for refrigerator door central locking system)

The refrigerator always requires a 12 V control voltage, regardless of which type of energy it is using. The control voltage is present as soon as the transformer/rectifier is switched on. Therefore the closed circuit current always flows even if the refrigerator is switched off. Always switch off the transformer/rectifier for a temporary lay-up.

177I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

Gas operation

If the automatic mode is selected, 230 V power supply is not connected and the vehicle's engine is not running, the AES selects the gas supply. When selecting gas operation the ignition fuse is opened automatically so gas can get into the burner. At the same time the electronic ignition is activated. If the gas flame is extinguished, e.g. by blast of wind, the ignition is activated imme- diately and re-ignites the gas. In the case of a fault in gas operation the text "GAS" flashes in the operating indicator (Fig. 190,4).

Change-over between energy sources

When changing over from 230 V or 12 V to gas, delay times are built into the AES. For example, when changing over from 12 V operation to gas operation, a 15 minute delay is built in the AES. This prevents a change-over to gas oper- ation when the vehicle is stopped briefly and the engine is switched off (e.g. stop to fill tank).

Refrigerating temperature control

When turned on the first time the refrigerator automatically selects the middle thermostat position. This position can be adjusted manually by using the switch for temperature setting (Fig. 190,6). The indicator LEDs (Fig. 190,5) show the selected thermostat position. The refrigerating temperature for the three types of energy is set with the switch. It takes a few hours till the refrig- erator reaches its normal operating temperature. When changing over the operating mode the thermostat setting will be maintained. The refrigerating temperature is retained regardless of the type of power being used.

Manual operation

Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Refriger- ator". Press the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 190,1) down for 2 sec- onds in order to switch on the appliance. The operating mode selected most recently is shown in the operating indicator (Fig. 190,4). Select the energy type with the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 190,1). Set the refrigerating temperature on the switch for temperature setting (Fig. 190,6). The indicator LEDs (Fig. 190,5) show the selected thermostat position.

When operated with 12 V, the refrigerator draws power only from the living area battery.

Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion.

Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Refriger- ator".

Open flames are prohibited at petrol stations. If the stop takes longer than 15 minutes, the refrigerator has to be turned off at the energy selector switch.

178 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

Switching off: Press down the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 190,1) for 2 sec- onds. All displays close. Close the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.

9.6.4 Refrigerator door locking mechanism With some models, the refrigerator has a separate freezer compartment. The specifications in this section correspondingly also apply to the door of the freezer compartment.

There are two positions for locking the refrigerator door in place:

Closed refrigerator door during travel and when the refrigerator is in oper- ation Slightly opened refrigerator door as a ventilation position when the refrig- erator is switched off

Dometic 7 series with separate freezer

compartment

Opening: Push the lock (Fig. 191,1) to the side, so that the open lock " " (Fig. 191,3) is completely visible. Use recessed grip to open refrigerator door/freezer compartment door.

If the refrigerator is manually set to "12 V", it will constantly consume cur- rent. Therefore, switch over to gas operation when the vehicle engine is not running, and the vehicle is not connected to the 230 V power supply.

Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual "Refrigerator".

During the journey the refrigerator door must always be closed and locked in the closed position.

Lock the refrigerator door in ventilation position when the refrigerator is switched off. This prevents mould forming.

Fig. 191 Locking of the refrigerator door/freezer compartment door (Dometic 7 series with separate freezer compartment)

Fig. 192 Refrigerator door/freezer com- partment door in ventilation position (Dometic 7 series with separate freezer compartment)

179I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances 9

Closing: Fully close the refrigerator door/freezer compartment door.

Push the lock (Fig. 191,1) to the side, so that the closed lock " " (Fig. 191,2) is completely visible.

Locking in the ventilation position:

Slightly open refrigerator door/freezer compartment door. Push the lock completely to the right. The door latch (Fig. 192,1) keeps the refrigerator door/freezer compartment door in a fixed position. The refriger- ator door/freezer compartment door will then stay slightly open (Fig. 192).

Dometic 8 series

Opening: Press the release button (Fig. 193,1) and open the refrigerator door.

Closing: Close the refrigerator door. The lock hook engages audibly.

When the vehicle has been positioned, the lock hook can be fixed. The refrig- erator door can now be opened without having to press the release button.

Fixing the lock hook: Press the fixture (Fig. 194,1) upwards. The lock hook (Fig. 194,2) is pressed upwards and has no function.

Unlocking the lock hook: Push the lock hook (Fig. 194,2) down. The lock hook functions again.

Locking in the ventilation position:

Open the refrigerator door. Press down the unlocking device (Fig. 195,2). Push locking device (Fig. 195,1) forwards (Fig. 196).

If the refrigerator door is closed now, a gap will remain between the refrigerator door and the refrigerator.

Fig. 193 Release button of the refriger- ator door (Dometic 8 series)

Fig. 194 Lock hook fixture

Fig. 195 Locking device in normal posi- tion

Fig. 196 Locking device in ventilation position

180 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Appliances9

181I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

10Sanitary fittingsChapter overview This chapter contains instructions regarding the sanitary fittings of the vehicle. The instructions address the following topics:

water tank waste water tank waste water tank heater complete water system toilet compartment toilet

10.1 Water supply, general

The vehicle is equipped with a fitted water tank. An electric water pump pumps the water to the individual water taps. Opening a water tap automatically switches on the water pump and pumps water to the tap. The waste water tank collects the waste water. The water level in the water and waste water tanks can be checked on the panel.

Fill water tank from supply systems that have been verified to provide drinking water quality. Only use such hoses or containers when filling that have been approved for use with drinking water. Thoroughly rinse filling hose or container with drinking water before use (2 to 3 times capacity). Empty filling hose or container completely after use and close openings of the filling hose or container. Water left standing in the water tank or in the water pipes becomes undrinkable after a short period. Therefore, before each use of the vehicle, thoroughly clean the water pipes and the water tank. After each use of the vehicle completely empty the water tank and the water pipes. In the case of lay-ups lasting more than a week disinfect the water system before using the vehicle.

If the vehicle is not used for several days or if it is not heated when there is a risk of frost, empty the entire water system. Make certain that the water pump is switched off on the panel. Otherwise, the water pump will overheat and may get damaged. Leave the water taps on in central position. Leave the safety/drainage valve (if there is one) and all drain cocks open. Frost damage to appliances, frost damage to the vehicle and deposits in water- carrying components can be avoided in this way. The water pump will overheat without water and can get damaged. Never operate water pump when the water tank is empty.

Before the water fittings can be used, the 12 V power supply and water pump on the panel must be turned on. Otherwise the water pump will not work. When the water tank is re-filled, an air bubble may form at the bottom of the pump. This air bubble will prevent water from being drawn in. Shake the water pump up and down energetically in the water.

182 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

10.2 Water tank 10.2.1 Volumes

10.2.2 Auxiliary water tank (special equipment) The auxiliary water tank holds 70 litres or 130 litres, depending on the model. It is integrated in the double floor and can be accessed via a service flap at the side.

The auxiliary water tank and the water tank are both filled via the drinking water filler neck. Both tanks are connected to each other via a hose. When the emptying valve (Fig. 197,2) is open, the fill quantity of the auxiliary water tank is limited to approximately 30 litres; excess water will drain off. When the emptying valve is shut, the entire tank volume is available. When the stopper (Fig. 198,1) is pulled in the inside of the auxiliary water tank, the water drains away via the drain (Fig. 197,3). The stopper can be accessed via the service opening (Fig. 197,1).

Filling with water: Ensure that the stopper (Fig. 198,1) in the auxiliary water tank is shut (handle (Fig. 198,2) is folded out). Ensure that the emptying valve (Fig. 197,2) is shut. Add water via the drinking water filler neck until both tanks are full.

Draining water: Open the service opening (Fig. 197,1) in the auxiliary water tank. Open the emptying valve until no more water runs out. Access the handle (Fig. 198,2) of the stopper (Fig. 198,1) via the service opening, turn the handle to the vertical position and remove the stopper.

Draining water down to trip reserve (approx. 30 litres):

Open the emptying valve (Fig. 197,2) on the auxiliary water tank.

The water tank contains 120 litres. However, the volume has been limited to 60 litres (overflow installed) for payload reasons. The panel has not been adjusted to this volume. The level indicator on the panel shows the actual amount of water in the tank. If necessary or if there is a sufficiently large residual vehicle payload, the water tank can be filled up to its actual capacity. To do this, close overflow. The handle is on the water tank.

Fig. 197 Auxiliary water tank Fig. 198 Stopper

183I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

10.2.3 Drinking water filler neck with cap

The drinking water filler neck is on the right or left side of the vehicle, depending on the model. The drinking water filler neck is labelled by the word "WASSER" (water)

(Fig. 199,1) or marked by the symbol " " (Fig. 200,1). The cap is open and closed using the key for the external flap locks.

Opening: Insert key into locking cylinder (Fig. 199,2 or Fig. 200,2) and turn a quarter turn in an anticlockwise direction. Remove cap.

Closing: Place cap on the drinking water filler neck. Turn key one quarter turn in a clockwise direction. Remove the key. Check that the cap sits firmly on the drinking water filler neck.

10.2.4 Closing/opening the overflow

The cap for the drinking water filler neck and for the fuel filler neck are very similar. Before filling the tank, always check the label.

Fig. 199 Cap for the drinking water filler neck

Fig. 200 Cap for the drinking water filler neck (alternative)

When filling the water tank, observe the maximum permissible gross weight of the vehicle. Luggage must be reduced accordingly when the water tank is full.

184 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

Closing: Turn the handle (Fig. 201,1) on the water tank in a clockwise direction as far as it will go. Fill the water tank with drinking water.

Opening: Turn the handle (Fig. 201,1) on the water tank in an anticlockwise direction as far as it will go. Excess water will drain away leaving 60 litres in the tank.

10.2.5 Filling with water

Open drinking water filler neck. Fill the water tank with drinking water. Use a water hose, a water canister with a funnel or similar for filling. Close drinking water filler neck.

10.2.6 Draining water (handle with overflow)

Turn the handle (Fig. 202,1) on the water tank in an anticlockwise direction as far as possible beyond the resistance to fully open the drainage opening.

10.3 Waste water tank

Fig. 201 Water tank with handle

When filling the water tank, observe the maximum permissible gross weight of the vehicle. Luggage must be reduced accordingly when the water tank is full.

Fig. 202 Water tank with handle

Never pour boiling water directly into the sink outlet. Boiling water could cause deformation and leaks in the waste water pipe system.

185I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

10.3.1 Drain cock underneath the vehicle

The waste water tank is in the rear area of the vehicle. It is located underneath the floor of the vehicle. Waste water from the kitchen and washing unit flows through plastic pipes into the waste water tank. The drain cock and the cleaning opening are located on the underside of the waste water tank. The waste water tank holds 90 litres.

Emptying: Attach the waste water hose to the drain pipe. Turn the handle (Fig. 203,1) of the drain cock in flow direction. Completely empty waste water tank. Turn the drain cock handle perpendicular to the flow direction. Remove the waste water hose.

10.3.2 Drain cock in the vehicle

The waste water tank is in the double floor of the vehicle. The waste water tank can be accessed via an external flap or a cover. Waste water from the kitchen and washing unit flows through plastic pipes into the waste water tank. The drain cock and the cleaning opening are located on the underside of the waste water tank. The waste water tank holds 90 litres.

Only empty the waste water tank at disposal stations, camping sites or car- avan sites especially provided for this purpose.

In case of frost add so much anti-freeze (such as kitchen salt) to the waste water tank so that the waste water cannot freeze.

Fig. 203 Drain cock

If the living area heater is out of order, the waste water tank no longer is sufficiently protected against frost. Therefore in case of frost, empty the waste water tank and leave the drain cock open or add enough anti-freeze (e.g. kitchen salt) to the waste water tank to prevent the waste water from freezing.

186 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

Depending on the model, the vehicle is equipped either with a manually oper- ated drain cock or with an electrically operated drainage valve.

The drain cock (Fig. 204,1) is accessible from the side storage flap.

A red line in the inspection window (Fig. 205,2) of the electrically operated drainage valve shows the valve setting:

horizontal line = valve open vertical line = valve shut

Emptying: Attach the waste water hose to the drain pipe. Manually operated drain cock: Turn the handle (Fig. 204,1) of the drain cock in flow direction. This drains the waste water through a spherical valve. Electrically operated drainage valve: Press the operating switch (Fig. 206) at the top. The waste water is drained. Completely empty waste water tank. Manually operated drain cock: Close the drain cock handle at a right angle to the flow direction once all of the waste water has run out. Electrically operated drainage valve: Once all the waste water has drained completely, press the operating switch (Fig. 206) at the bottom. Remove the waste water hose.

Emergency drainage (electrically operated

drainage valve):

Set the operating switch (Fig. 206) to the "0" position (power off). Pull out the rotary knob (Fig. 205,1) on the electrically operated drainage valve and rotate (in any direction).

Fig. 204 Drain cock

Fig. 205 Electrically operated drainage valve

Fig. 206 Operating switch for electri- cally operated drainage valve (special equipment)

187I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

10.3.3 Waste water tank heater (special equipment)

The waste water tank may be heated and is insulated. The integrated frost guard prevents waste water from freezing. A switch (Fig. 207,1 or Fig. 208) on the front of the bench seat or bed may be used to switch the frost guard on and off. The frost guard begins to heat the waste water as soon as the water temper- ature drops to approx. 5 C. The frost guard ends the heating process when the waste water reaches a temperature of approx. 10 C.

10.4 Filling the water system

Position the vehicle horizontally. Switch on 12 V power supply on the panel.

Fig. 207 Operating switch Fig. 208 Operating switch (alternative)

When filling the water tank, observe the maximum permissible gross weight of the vehicle. Luggage must be reduced accordingly when the water tank is full.

The water pump will overheat without water and can get damaged. Never operate water pump when the water tank is empty.

The Truma system (heater/boiler) has a safety/drainage valve and, depending on the model, one or two drain cocks for emptying. Depending on the model, the Alde system (heater/boiler) has one or two drain cocks for emptying. The water quantity can be monitored on the panel while the water tank is filled.

Fig. 209 Drain cock (with rocking lever) Fig. 210 Drain cock (with twist cap)

188 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

If necessary, switch on the water pump on the panel. Clean or disinfect water system. Close the safety/drainage valve (Truma). Turn the knob perpendicular to the safety/drainage valve and press the push button in. If the temperature is below 6 C, the safety/drainage valve cannot be closed. Therefore switch on the living area heater and wait until the tem- perature of the safety/drainage valve exceeds 6 C. Close all drain cocks. To do this, position the drain cock's rocking lever (Fig. 209,1) horizontally or turn the drain cock's cap (Fig. 210,1) in a clock- wise direction. Close the drainage opening of the water tank. Close all water taps. Open the drinking water filler neck on the outside of the vehicle. Fill the water tank with drinking water. Use a water hose, a water canister with a funnel or similar for filling. Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them. The water pump is turned on. The warm water pipes are filled with water. Keep the taps open until the water flowing out of the taps has no bubbles in it. This is the only way to ensure that the boiler is full of water. Set all water taps to "Cold" and leave them open. This will fill the cold water pipes with water. Keep the taps open until the water flowing out of the taps has no bubbles in it. Close all water taps. Close drinking water filler neck. Check that the cap on the water tank is not leaking.

Position of the drain cocks and safety/

drainage valve

See chapter 16.

10.5 Emptying the water system If the vehicle is not used for several days or if it is not heated when there is a risk of frost, empty the entire water system. Make certain that the water pump is switched off on the panel. Otherwise, the water pump will overheat and may get damaged. Leave the water taps on in central position. Leave the safety/drainage valve (if there is one) and all drain cocks open. Frost damage to appliances, frost damage to the vehicle and deposits in water- carrying components can be avoided in this way. If the water pump can be turned off from the panel, always turn off the water pump from the panel before you empty the water system. Otherwise the water pump runs until it overheats or the battery is empty.

The Truma system (heater/boiler) has a safety/drainage valve and, depending on the model, one or two drain cocks for emptying. Depending on the model, the Alde system (heater/boiler) has one or two drain cocks for emptying.

189I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

To empty and ventilate the water system, proceed as follows. This will avoid frost damage:

Position the vehicle horizontally. Switch off water pump on panel. Switch off the 12 V power supply on the panel. Shut off the boiler (see section 9.4). Open all drain cocks. To do this, position the drain cock's rocking lever (Fig. 211,1) vertically or turn the drain cock's cap (Fig. 212,1) in an anti- clockwise direction. Open the safety/drainage valve (Truma). To do this turn the knob parallel to the safety/drainage valve. The push button jumps out. Open the water tank drain. Open all water taps and set to the central position. Hang the shower handset up in the shower position. Hold the water pump up until the water pipes are completely empty. Check whether the water tank is completely empty. Blow out the remaining water in the water pipes (max. 0.5 bar). To do this, remove the pipe from the water pump and blow into the pipe. Empty the waste water tank. Take note of the environmental tips in this chapter. Empty toilet cassette or sewage tank. Take note of the environmental tips in this chapter. Clean the water tank and then rinse it out thoroughly. Let the water system dry for as long as possible. After emptying, leave all water taps on in the central position. Leave all drain cocks open.

Position of the drain cocks and safety/

drainage valve

See chapter 16.

10.6 Toilet compartment

Fig. 211 Drain cock (with rocking lever) Fig. 212 Drain cock (with twist cap)

Do not transport any loads in the shower tray. The shower tray or other items of equipment in the toilet compartment can be damaged.

190 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

10.7 Toilet

The flushing of the toilet is fed directly from the water system of the vehicle.

10.7.1 Swivel toilet (Thetford C-200)

Preparing toilet: Open the flap for the Thetford cassette and pull the retaining clip upwards to remove the Thetford cassette.

For ventilation purposes during or after a shower, and for drying wet clothing, close the toilet compartment door and open the window or the toilet compartment skylight. This improves the air circulation. Close the shower curtain completely when showering, so that no water is able to enter the area between the wash room wall and the shower tray. After taking a shower, rinse soap residue from the shower tray, otherwise cracks can appear in the shower tray over time. After using the shower, wipe it dry to prevent moisture from collecting. Further information about cleaning the toilet compartment can be found in the section 11.2.

If there is any risk of frost and the vehicle is not heated, empty the sewage tank (cassette). Do not sit on the lid of the toilet. The lid is not designed to bear the weight of a person and could break. Use a suitable chemical for this toilet. The ventilation will merely remove the odour but not germs and gases. Germs and gases will have a detri- mental effect on the sealing rubbers. Never put the sanitary liquid directly in the toilet bowl.

Further information can be obtained in the device manufacturer's instruc- tion manual.

Only empty the sewage tank (cassette) at disposal stations, at camping sites or caravan sites, that are especially provided for this purpose.

The Thetford cassette can only be taken out if the sliding trap is closed.

Fig. 213 Pulling the retaining clip

191I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

Pull out the Thetford cassette as far as it can go. Tip the Thetford cassette slightly and then pull it out completely.

Place the Thetford cassette upright. Turn the drainage neck upwards. Remove the cap of the drainage neck.

Fill the Thetford cassette with the specified quantity of sanitary liquid. Then add enough water to completely cover the bottom of the Thetford cas- sette. Close drainage neck with the cap. Return the drainage neck to its original position.

Fig. 214 Removing the Thetford cas- sette

Fig. 215 Turning drainage neck

Never put the sanitary liquid directly in the toilet bowl.

Fig. 216 Filling with sanitary liquid

192 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

Push the Thetford cassette back to its original position.

Ensure that the Thetford cassette is secured by the retaining clip. Lock the flap for the Thetford cassette.

Using the toilet: Move the toilet bowl into a convenient position.

When inserting, do not use force. The Thetford cassette can be damaged.

Fig. 217 Inserting the Thetford cassette

Fig. 218 Thetford cassette secured

Fig. 219 Rotating the toilet bowl

193I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

Fill the toilet bowl with some water. Press the flush button. Flushing con- tinues as long as the button is pressed. Use the toilet.

C-200 S cassette With the C-200 S cassette, proceed as follows to flush the toilet:

Open the sliding trap. To do this, turn the slide lever in an anticlockwise direction.

Flush the toilet. Press the flush button. After flushing close the sliding trap.

C-200 E cassette With the C-200 E cassette, proceed as follows to flush the toilet:

Fig. 220 Pre-flush

Fig. 221 Operating the sliding trap

Fig. 222 Operating the flush

194 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

Open the sliding trap. To do this, press the left side of the sliding trap button.

Flush the toilet. Press the flush button. After flushing close the sliding trap. To do this, press the right side of the sliding trap button.

Emptying the Thetford cassette:

Open the flap for the Thetford cassette and pull the retaining clip upwards to remove the Thetford cassette. Pull out the Thetford cassette as far as it can go. Tip the Thetford cassette slightly and then pull it out completely.

Fig. 223 Opening the sliding trap

Fig. 224 Closing the sliding trap

The Thetford cassette can only be taken out if the sliding trap is closed.

Fig. 225 Removing the Thetford cas- sette

195I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

Take the Thetford cassette to a proper disposal area. As you do this, point the drainage neck upwards.

Turn the drainage neck upwards. Remove the cap of the drainage neck. Point the Thetford cassette with the drainage neck downwards. Activate the aeration knob with your thumb. The Thetford cassette empties. Rinse the Thetford cassette thoroughly with fresh water. Close drainage neck with the cap. Return the drainage neck to its original position.

Prepare the Thetford toilet for use. Push the Thetford cassette back to its original position. Ensure that the Thetford cassette is secured by the retaining clip. Lock the flap for the Thetford cassette.

Fig. 226 Carrying the Thetford cassette

Fig. 227 Emptying the Thetford cas- sette

Fig. 228 Inserting the Thetford cassette

196 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

10.7.2 Toilet with fixed seat (Thetford C-402)

Preparing toilet: Open the flap for the Thetford cassette and pull the retaining clip upwards to remove the Thetford cassette.

Pull out the Thetford cassette as far as it can go. Tip the Thetford cassette slightly and then pull it out completely.

Place the Thetford cassette upright. Turn the drainage neck upwards. Remove the cap of the drainage neck.

The Thetford cassette can only be taken out if the sliding trap is closed.

Fig. 229 Pulling the retaining clip

Fig. 230 Removing the Thetford cas- sette

Fig. 231 Turning drainage neck

Never put the sanitary liquid directly in the toilet bowl.

197I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

Fill the Thetford cassette with the specified quantity of sanitary liquid. Then add enough water to completely cover the bottom of the Thetford cas- sette. Close drainage neck with the cap. Return the drainage neck to its original position.

Push the Thetford cassette back to its original position.

Ensure that the Thetford cassette is secured by the retaining clip. Lock the flap for the Thetford cassette.

Fig. 232 Filling with sanitary liquid

When inserting, do not use force. The Thetford cassette can be damaged.

Fig. 233 Inserting the Thetford cassette

Fig. 234 Thetford cassette secured

198 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

Using the toilet: Fill the toilet bowl with some water. Press the flush button. Flushing con- tinues as long as the button is pressed. Use the toilet.

Open the sliding trap. To do this, turn the slide lever in an anticlockwise direction.

Flush the toilet. Press the flush button. After flushing close the sliding trap again. To do this turn the slide lever in a clockwise direction.

Fig. 235 Pre-flush

Fig. 236 Operating the sliding trap

Fig. 237 Operating the flush

The Thetford cassette can only be taken out if the sliding trap is closed.

199I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

Emptying the Thetford cassette:

Open the flap for the Thetford cassette and pull the retaining clip upwards to remove the Thetford cassette. Pull out the Thetford cassette as far as it can go. Tip the Thetford cassette slightly and then pull it out completely.

Place the Thetford cassette upright on the wheels. Press down the handle of the draw bar and move away from the Thetford cassette. The lock of the draw bar releases itself. Pull the draw bar out completely by the handle. Take the Thetford cassette to a proper disposal area. Insert the draw bar completely using the handle.

Turn the drainage neck upwards. Remove the cap of the drainage neck. Point the Thetford cassette with the drainage neck downwards.

Fig. 238 Removing the Thetford cas- sette

Fig. 239 Transporting the Thetford cas- sette

Fig. 240 Emptying the Thetford cas- sette

200 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

Activate the aeration knob with your thumb. The Thetford cassette empties. Rinse the Thetford cassette thoroughly with fresh water. Close drainage neck with the cap. Return the drainage neck to its original position.

Prepare the Thetford toilet for use. Push the Thetford cassette back to its original position. Ensure that the Thetford cassette is secured by the retaining clip. Lock the flap for the Thetford cassette.

10.7.3 Toilet (Dometic)

Preparing toilet: Open the flap for the sewage tank on the outside of the vehicle. Insert the key into the locking cylinder of the push-button lock (Fig. 242,1) and turn a quarter turn. Remove the key. Press both push-button locks (Fig. 242,2) simultaneously with your thumb and open the flap. Pull up the retaining clip (Fig. 243,3) and use the handle (Fig. 243,2) to lift the sewage tank (Fig. 243,1) straight up. Tilt the sewage tank slightly and remove fully.

Fig. 241 Inserting the Thetford cassette

The sewage tank (cassette) can only be taken out if the sliding trap is closed.

Fig. 242 Flap for sewage tank Fig. 243 Sewage tank

201I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings 10

Put the sewage tank down vertically. Turn the drainage neck upwards. Remove the cap of the drainage neck. Fill the stated amount of sanitary liquid into the sewage tank. Then add enough water to completely cover the bottom of the sewage tank. Close drainage neck with the cap. Return the drainage neck to its original position. Push the sewage tank back to its original position without applying any force. Ensure that the sewage tank is secured by the retaining clip. Lock the flap for the sewage tank.

Let some water run into the toilet bowl before using the toilet. In order to do so press the flush button (Fig. 247,3) on the control and operating unit (Fig. 246,2).

Flushing: Before flushing open the sliding trap of the toilet. For this pull out the slide lever (Fig. 246,1). For flushing, press the flush button (Fig. 247,3). After flushing close the sliding trap. To do so, push the slide lever back.

The indicator lamp (Fig. 247,2) goes on whenever the sewage tank is filled up to 3/4. The indicator lamp (Fig. 247,1) goes on whenever the sewage tank has to be emptied.

Fig. 244 Turning drainage neck Fig. 245 Filling with sanitary liquid

Fig. 246 Toilet bowl with control and operating unit

Fig. 247 Control and operating unit toilet

202 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Sanitary fittings10

Removal of sewage tank: Push the slide lever (Fig. 246,1) in. The sliding trap is closed. To empty, the sliding trap of the toilet must be closed. Open the flap for the sewage tank on the outside of the vehicle. Pull up the retaining clip (Fig. 243,3) and use the handle (Fig. 243,2) to lift the sewage tank (Fig. 243,1) straight up. Tilt the sewage tank slightly and remove fully. The display "Sewage tank removed" (Fig. 247,4) lights up on the control and operating unit.

Emptying the sewage tank: Take the sewage tank to a disposal point especially provided for this pur- pose. Turn the drainage neck as far upwards as possible. Remove the cap of the drainage neck. Point the sewage tank with the drainage neck downwards. Activate the aeration knob with your thumb. The sewage tank empties. Flush the sewage tank with water. Close drainage neck with the cap. Return the drainage neck to its original position. Push the sewage tank back to its original position without applying any force. Ensure that the sewage tank is secured by the retaining clip. Lock the flap for the sewage tank.

Fig. 248 Emptying the sewage tank

203I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care 11

11CareChapter overview This chapter contains instructions regarding the care of the vehicle. The instructions address the following topics:

exterior of the vehicle interior water system extractor hood air conditioning unit winter operation

At the end of the chapter there is a checklist of measures you must carry out if you are not going to use the vehicle for an extended period of time. The checklist address the following topics:

temporary lay-up winter lay-up start-up after a lay-up

11.1 External care 11.1.1 General

Standard external care consists of regular washing. The use and the environ- mental conditions will determine how often the vehicle needs to be washed. Wash the vehicle more frequently in areas which are exposed to heavy air pol- lution or heavy traffic or roads treated with de-icing salts. If the vehicle is exposed to salty and humid air (coastal areas, humid climates), wash the vehicle more frequently. Do not park under trees if at all possible. The resin-like discharge which many trees secrete, give the paintwork a matt look and can promote the onset of cor- rosion. Wash off bird droppings straight away and thoroughly, as the acid it contains is extremely corrosive.

11.1.2 Washing with a high-pressure cleaner

Before cleaning the vehicle with a high-pressure cleaner, observe the oper- ating instructions of the high-pressure cleaner. When cleaning with the nozzle for circular jet between the vehicle and the cleaning nozzle, maintain a minimum distance of approx. 700 mm. Take into consideration that the jet of water comes out of the cleaning nozzle with pressure. The vehicle may be damaged by incorrect handling of the high- pressure cleaner. The temperature of the water should not be above 60 C. Keep the jet of water in constant movement during the washing process. Do not direct the water jet at clearances, built-in electrical parts, plugs, seals, the ventilation grill or the skylights. The vehicle may be damaged or water may enter the interior.

Do not clean the tyres with a high-pressure cleaner. The tyres might be damaged. Do not spray external applications (deco-films) directly with the high-pres- sure cleaner. The external applications could come off.

204 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care11

11.1.3 Washing the vehicle

Wash the vehicle only on a washing site intended for this purpose. Avoid full sunshine. Observe environmental measures. Only clean external applications and synthetic parts with plenty of warm water, dish washing liquid and soft cloth. Wash down the vehicle with plenty of water, a clean sponge or a soft brush. In the case of stubborn dirt add dish washing liquid to the water. Painted exterior walls may also be cleaned with a caravan cleaner. Add-on parts made of glass-fibre reinforced plastic (GRP) require a regular follow-up treatment with a polisher. This way these parts will not turn yellow and the sealing of the surface remains intact. Treat rubber seals of doors and storage flaps with talc. Treat locking cylinder of doors and storage flaps with graphite dust.

11.1.4 Windows of acrylic glass Acrylic glass windows are delicate and require very careful handling.

11.1.5 Underbody The underbody of the vehicle is partly coated with an age-resistant underbody protection. Should the underbody protection be damaged, repair immediately. Do not treat areas coated with underbody protection with spray oil.

Never clean the vehicle in the car wash. Water can enter the refrigerator grills, the waste gas vents, the ventilation of the extractor hoods or the forced ventilations. The vehicle could be damaged.

Never rub acrylic glass windows dry as dust particles might damage the surface! Only clean acrylic glass windows with plenty of warm water, some dish washing liquid and a soft cloth. Never use glass cleaning agents with chemical, abrasive or alcohol-con- taining additives. Premature brittleness of the panes and associated cracks may result from their use. Avoid contact of cleansing agents used for the body (e.g. tar- or silicone- removing agents) with acrylic glass. Do not clean vehicle in car wash. Do not attach stickers to the acrylic glass windows. Having cleaned the vehicle rinse acrylic glass with sufficient clear water. Apply talcum powder to rubber seals.

An acrylic glass cleanser with antistatic effect is suitable for a follow-up treatment. Small scratches can be treated with an acrylic glass polish. These agents are available at the accessories shop.

Only use products approved by the manufacturer. Our authorised dealers and service centres will be happy to advise you.

205I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care 11

11.1.6 Waste water tank Clean the waste water tank after every use.

Cleaning: Empty the waste water tank. Open the cleaning opening on the waste water tank and the drain cock. Thoroughly rinse out the waste water tank with fresh water. If possible, clean waste water sensors through the cleaning opening by hand.

11.1.7 Entrance step If the entrance step is lubricated, coarse particles of dirt can settle on the lubri- cant during the journey and cause damage to the operating mechanism of the entrance step. Therefore, do not lubricate the moving parts of the entrance step.

11.2 Interior care

Surface and knobs of furniture, lamps and synthetic parts in the toilet and living area should be cleaned with water and a wool cloth. A mild cleanser may be added to the water. If required, use furniture polish for the painted surfaces. Clean upholstery with dry foam specially manufactured for the use on upholstery or with the foam of a mild detergent. Do not wash upholstery. Always have it cleaned. Protect upholstery from direct sunlight so that it does not loose its colour.

Clean upholstery made of novalife with clear water only.

If possible, treat stains immediately. Acrylic glass windows are delicate and require very careful handling (see section 11.1.4). Synthetic parts in the toilet and living area are very delicate and should be treated with care. Do not use solvents, alcohol-containing cleansers or scourers. This procedure will help you to avoid brittleness and formation of cracks. Hair colourants, nail varnish, cigarette ash and similar substances may cause permanent stains or discolouration. For this reason, you should pre- vent these substances from getting onto plastic parts. If they do get onto plastic parts, you should remove these substances immediately. Do not pour any corrosive agents into the drain holes. Never pour boiling water directly into the drain holes. Corrosive agents and boiling water cause damage to drainage pipes and siphon traps. Do not use vinegar based products to clean the toilet and water system, or for decalcification of the water system. Vinegar-based products may cause damage to seals or parts of the installation. Use standard decalcifying products for decalcification. Save water. Mop up all remaining water. Vacuum off carpets and cushions with a suitable brush attachment.

For information about the use of maintenance products, our representa- tives and service centres will be glad to advise.

206 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care11

Leather covers should be cleaned with a cotton cloth and a mild soap (curd soap). Make sure that the leather is not soaked through and that no water seeps through the seams of the leather covers. Curtains and net curtains should be dry cleaned. Vacuum clean the carpet, if necessary clean with carpet shampoo. Clean PVC-floor covering with a mild, soapy cleanser for PVC floors. Do not place carpet on wet PVC-floor covering. The carpet and the PVC-floor covering may stick together. Never clean the sink or the gas cooker with a scourer. Avoid anything which may cause scratching or grooves. Clean the burners on the gas cooker using a damp cloth only. Prevent any water from penetrating the burner covers. Water may damage the burners on the gas cooker. Brush insect screens on doors, windows and skylights with a soft brush or vacuum with the brush attachment of the vacuum cleaner. Brush blinds with a soft brush or vacuum with the brush attachment of the vacuum cleaner. Grease or stubborn dirt may be removed with a mild soap at 30 C (curd soap). Brush Roman shades with a soft brush or vacuum with the brush attach- ment of the vacuum cleaner. Grease or stubborn dirt may be removed with a mild soap at 30 C (curd soap). Unrolled seat belts can be cleaned with warm soapsuds. The seat belt must be completely dry before being rolled up. Wipe the fuel cell with a soft, damp cloth.

11.3 Water system 11.3.1 Cleaning the water tank

Empty the water tank and close the drainage opening. Remove the cap of the water tank. Fill water tank with water and some washing-up liquid (do not use any scourers). Using a trade standard brush for washing dishes, scrub the water tank until there is no longer any visible deposit. Scrub also the pump housing. If possible, clean fresh water sensors through the cleaning openings by hand. Rinse water tank with copious amounts of drinking water.

11.3.2 Cleaning the water pipes Only use suitable cleaning agents as sold by the specialist trade.

Collect any emerging mixture of water and cleaning agent for correct dis- posal.

207I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care 11

Empty the water system. Close all drain holes and drain cocks. Fill mixture of water and cleaning agent into the water tank. Observe the manufacturer's instructions regarding the mixing ratio. Open the drain cocks one by one. Leave the drain cocks open until the mixture of water and cleaning agent has reached the respective drain. Close the drain cocks. Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them. Leave the water taps open until the mixture of water and cleaning agent has reached the drain. Set all water taps to "Cold" and open them. Leave the water taps open until the mixture of water and cleaning agent has reached the drain. Close all water taps. Flush the toilet several times. Allow the cleaning agent to act in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. Empty the water system. Collect the mixture of water and cleaning agent for correct disposal. For rinsing fill the entire water system with drinking water and empty again several times over.

11.3.3 Disinfecting the water system

Empty the water system. Close all drain holes and drain cocks. Fill mixture of water and disinfectant into the water tank. Observe the man- ufacturer's instructions regarding the mixing ratio. Open the drain cocks one by one. Leave the drain cocks open until the mixture of water and disinfectant has reached the respective drain. Close the drain cocks. Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them. Leave the water taps open until the mixture of water and disinfectant has reached the drain. Set all water taps to "Cold" and open them. Leave the water taps open until the mixture of water and disinfectant has reached the drain. Close all water taps. Flush the toilet several times.

Only use suitable disinfectants as sold by the specialist trade.

Collect any emerging mixture of water and disinfectant for correct disposal.

208 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care11

Allow the disinfectant to act in accordance with the manufacturer's instruc- tions. Empty the water system. Collect the mixture of water and disinfectant for correct disposal. For rinsing fill the entire water system with drinking water and empty again several times over.

11.4 Extractor hood Clean the extractor hood filter occasionally. How often cleaning is necessary depends on how often the extractor hood is used. Do not wait to clean the filter until the performance of the extractor hood has noticeably decreased.

Cleaning the filter: Wash the filter with warm water and some washing-up liquid.

11.5 Air conditioning unit 11.5.1 Dometic

A lint filter and an activated carbon filter are each located in the lower part of the air conditioning system ceiling unit (Fig. 249,2) behind the ventilation grills (Fig. 249,1 and 3). The lint filters must be cleaned at regular intervals and replaced if necessary. The manufacturer recommends replacing the activated carbon filter yearly. On the left side of the ceiling unit (outside of the vehicle) is located the drainage opening for the condensation. Keep the drain openings free from dirt, leaves or similar to allow the condensation to be drained.

11.5.2 Telair Every now and then clean the filter and the ventilation grilles on the outside of the housing. How often cleaning is necessary depends on how often the air conditioning unit is used. Do not wait to clean the filter and the ventilation grill until the performance of the air conditioning unit has noticeably decreased.

Cleaning the filter: Wash the filter with warm water and some washing-up liquid. Allow the filter to dry thoroughly before reassembly.

Fig. 249 Air conditioning unit (Dometic)

Only use mild cleaning solutions to clean the filter, never use benzene or solvents.

209I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care 11

Cleaning the ventilation grill: Use a brush to remove coarse dirt or deposits from the external ventilation grilles. If a cleaning solution is used, ensure that no water ingresses into the inside of the housing.

11.6 Winter care De-icing salt damages the underbody and the parts open to water spray. We recommend that you wash the vehicle more frequently during wintertime. Mechanical and surface treated parts and the underside are under particular strain, and should therefore be cleaned thoroughly.

11.6.1 Preparations

Check the vehicle for paint and rust damage. Repair damage as neces- sary. Make certain that water cannot penetrate the automatic floor ventilation system and the heater. Use a wax-based rust inhibitor to protect the metal parts of the underbody. Use appropriate protection for external painted surfaces.

11.6.2 Winter operation During winter operation, condensation develops when the vehicle is occupied under low-temperature conditions. To ensure good interior air quality and avoid vehicle damage from condensation, sufficient ventilation is essential.

When heating the vehicle, the heater should be at the highest setting and roof storage cabinets, curtains and blinds should be opened. This ensures optimal ventilation. Only heat if the circulation system is switched on. In the morning, lift up all cushions, air out storage boxes and dry any damp areas.

If there is any risk of frost, always run heater at a minimum of 15 C. Switch the circulation fan (if there is one) to automatic. In the case of extreme external temperatures, the furniture flaps and doors should be left slightly open. The inflowing warm air can help prevent the freezing of water pipes, for example, and counteract the formation of condensation in the storage spaces. If there is any risk of frost, cover the outside surface of the windows with winter insulation mats. Keep waste gas vents and forced ventilations free of snow. Use a vent extension, if necessary.

If condensation has still developed, just wipe it off. It is only possible to guarantee unrestricted operation during winter for models without double floor in connection with the "winter package" from the original equipment.

210 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care11

11.6.3 At the end of the winter season

Thoroughly clean the underbody of the vehicle and the engine. When this is done, corrosion-inducing anti-freeze agents (salts, alkaline residues) are removed. Clean the exterior and use regular car wax to protect metal surfaces.

11.7 Lay-up 11.7.1 Temporary lay-up

Before laying up the vehicle, go through the following checklist:

If the vehicle has been stationary for a long period (approx. 10 months) have the braking and gas systems checked by an authorised specialist workshop. Take into consideration that water is undrinkable after only a short time. Animal damage to cables can lead to short circuits. Fire hazard!

Activities Done

Base vehicle Completely fill fuel tank. This prevents corrosion damage within the fuel tank system

Jack up vehicle so that the wheels do not bear any load, or move ve- hicle every 4 weeks. This prevents any pressure points from occur- ring on tyres and wheel bearings

Protect the tyres from direct exposure to the sun. Danger of forma- tion of cracks!

Inflate tyres up to the recommended maximum pressure

Always provide for sufficient ventilation in the underbody area

Humidity or lack of oxygen e.g. by covering with plastic film may cause optical irregularities to the underbody.

In addition observe the notes in the operating manual of the base ve- hicle

Body All vents should be sealed with the appropriate caps and all other openings (apart from forced ventilations) should also be sealed. This prevents animals (e.g. mice) from gaining entry

Air the interior, all storage compartments accessible from the out- side, and the parking space (e.g. garage) every 3 weeks in order to prevent the occurrence of condensation and resulting mould forma- tion

Interior Place upholstery in an upright position for ventilation, and cover

Clean refrigerator

Allow refrigerator and freezer compartment doors to remain slightly open

Search for traces of animals that have gained entry

Disconnect the flat screen from the mains and, if necessary, remove it from the vehicle

211I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care 11

11.7.2 Winter lay-up Additional measures are required if laying up the vehicle over winter:

Gas system Close regulator tap on the gas bottle

Close all gas isolator taps

Always remove gas bottles from the gas bottle compartment, even if they are empty

Electrical system Fully charge living area and starter battery

Charge the battery for at least 20 hours before laying up.

Disconnect the living area battery from the 12 V power supply. In or- der to do this switch off the battery cut-off switch on the transformer/ rectifier or activate the battery separation via the panel (see chapter 8)

Water system Empty the entire water system. Blow out the residual water from the water pipes (0.5 bar max.). Leave the water taps on in central posi- tion. Leave the safety/drainage valve (if there is one) and all drain cocks open. Observe the notes in chapter 10

Activities Done

Activities Done

Base vehicle Clean body and underbody thoroughly and spray with hot wax or protect with varnish

Fill fuel tank with winter diesel

Check antifreeze in the cooling water

Rectify damage to the paintwork

Body Clean vehicle from outside thoroughly

Keep the forced ventilation open

Clean and grease installed supports

Clean and grease all door and flap hinges

Brush oil or glycerine on all locking mechanisms

Rub all rubber seals with talc

Use graphite dust to treat locking cylinders

Interior Position de-humidifiers

Remove upholstery from the vehicle and store in a dry place

Air the interior every 3 weeks

Empty all cabinets and storage compartments, open flaps, doors and drawers

Thoroughly clean the interior

If there is a risk of frost, do not leave the flat screen in the vehicle

212 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care11

11.7.3 Starting up the vehicle after a temporary lay-up or after lay- up over winter Go through the following checklist before start-up:

Electrical system Remove the starter battery and the living area battery and store them in a place protected from frost (see chapter 8) or connect the vehicle to a 230 V supply

Water system Clean the water system using a cleaning agent from a specialised store

Complete vehicle Arrange the tarpaulins in such a way that the ventilation openings are not covered, or use porous tarpaulins

Activities Done

Activities Done

Base vehicle Check the tyre pressure on all tyres

Check the tyre pressure of the spare wheel

Body Clean the pivot bearing of the entrance step

Check the functioning of the fitted supports

Check that the doors, windows and skylights are working properly

Check that all the external locks are working, such as the external flaps, the filler neck and the conversion door

Remove the cover from the waste gas vent of the heater (if there is one)

Remove the winter cover from the refrigerator grills (if there is one)

Gas system Put the gas bottles in the gas bottle compartment, tie down and con- nect to the gas pressure regulator

Electrical system Connect to 230 V power supply using the external socket

Fully charge living area and starter battery

Charge the battery for at least 20 hours after lay-up.

Connect the living area battery with the 12 V power supply. In order to do this switch on the battery cut-off switch on the transformer/rec- tifier or deactivate the battery separation via the panel (see chapter 8)

Check that the electrical system are working, e.g. interior light, sock- et and all installed electrical appliances

Water system Disinfect water pipes and water tank

Check the functionality of the operating lever for the waste water tank

Close safety/drainage valve (if there is one), drain cocks and water taps

Check water system for leaks

213I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care 11

Appliances Check the function of the appliances

Change heating fluid of the hot-water heater every 2 years

Activities Done

214 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Care11

215I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance 12

12MaintenanceChapter overview This chapter contains instructions about inspection and maintenance work concerning the vehicle. The maintenance instructions address the following topics:

doors living area battery fuel cell Alde hot-water heater independent vehicle heater replacing light bulbs

At the end of the chapter you will find important instructions on how to obtain spare parts.

12.1 Inspection work Like any technical appliance, the vehicle must be inspected at regular inter- vals. This inspection work must be carried out by qualified personnel. Special technical knowledge, which cannot be taught within the framework of this instruction manual, is required for these tasks. Personnel possessing this technical knowledge are available for assistance at all our service centres. Their experience and regular technical instruction by the factory as well as equipment and tools guarantee expert and up-to-date inspection of the vehicle. Have the "First Programmed Inspection" carried out at one of our service cen- tres 12 months after initial registration. Further inspections should be carried out once a year. The service centre in charge will confirm the work performed. Have chassis inspections confirmed in the chassis manufacturer's customer service booklet.

12.2 Maintenance work As with every machine, this vehicle requires maintenance. The extent and fre- quency of the maintenance work required depend on conditions of operation and use. More difficult operating conditions make it necessary to service the vehicle more often. Have the base vehicle and the appliances serviced at the intervals specified in the corresponding instruction manuals.

12.3 Doors To maintain gliding capability between springs and hinges, grease the conver- sion door hinges occasionally.

Observe the inspections indicated by the manufacturer and have them car- ried out at the specified intervals. The value of the vehicle is thus pre- served. The confirmation of the inspection work carried out serves as valid proof in the event of damage and guarantee claims.

216 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance12

12.4 Living area battery

Observe the following to extend battery life:

Keep the battery surface clean and dry. Check the acid level periodically and top up with desalinated or distilled water as necessary. Never top up with acids. If water loss is considerable, have the controller voltage checked by an authorised specialist workshop. Use an acid density measurement to check the battery's charging condi- tion.

Acid density The battery must be recharged if the acid density falls below 1.21 kg/l. If battery acid with a density of 1.23 kg/l is used, the battery must be recharged when the acid density falls below 1.18 kg/l. With acid density of 1.21 kg/l, the battery is protected against freezing at temperatures up to -15 C (at 1.28 kg/l up to -70 C).

The battery has cycle stability and is thus particularly suited for vehicle power supply. Cycle stability means that several discharge/charging processes are possible.

12.5 Fuel cell 12.5.1 Replacing the tank cartridge

Unscrew the tank cartridge connection from the empty tank cartridge. Loosen the securing belt on the tank cartridge. Remove empty tank cartridge from the tank cartridge holder.

We recommend either Molykote PG 65 or Vaseline as lubricants.

When replacing the battery, only use the same type of battery (same capacity and voltage, cycle stability). Never use conventional car batteries (starter batteries). A lead acid battery must not be replaced by a dryfill battery. Do not use so-called improvers.

When changing tank cartridges, do not smoke and avoid unshielded flames. Fire hazard! Methanol is toxic. Avoid inhaling, swallowing or any contact with the skin or the eyes.

When connecting the tank, make sure that the tank hose has no kinks and that it is not squashed. Only use original SFC tank cartridges.

The tank cartridge may only be replaced if the system is running. Any methanol emerging will evaporate without residue. Original tank cartridges are available from all authorised dealers and service centres.

217I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance 12

After use, firmly close the cap of the tank cartridge. Insert a new, sealed original tank cartridge into the tank cartridge holder. Secure the tank cartridge with the securing belt. Open cap and keep safe. Screw tank cartridge connection onto the new tank cartridge. In the "Main Menu > Fuel Cartridge" menu, specify the tank cartridge size used and confirm with "OK".

12.5.2 Refilling service fluid

Turn off fuel cell and remove the device's connector plug. Remove the air discharge hose. Cut off the tip of the nozzle on the refill bottle. Pour the entire content of the refill bottle into the connection for the air dis- charge hose. Re-insert the air discharge hose. Plug the device's connector plug back on again. Press the reset button.

12.6 Alde hot-water heater

Only use original SFC refill sets. Only replenish service fluid if a message to do so appears on the operating panel. Ensure that no dirt or foreign bodies enter the filling hole.

Original refill sets are available from all authorised dealers and service cen- tres. Wipe up any spilled service fluid with a cloth.

Check the level of the heating fluid regularly on the compensator reservoir. During or after the first operating hours of the hot-water heater, the filling level may fall below the minimum mark. If this is the case, top up the heating fluid. We recommend to bleed the heating system after the initial heater opera- tion and to check the glycol content. Have heating fluid changed by an authorised dealer or a service centre at intervals of approximately two years as corrosion-protection wears off after some time. Top up heating system with a water-glycol mixture (60 : 40) only. This mix- ture offers frost protection up to approx. -25 C. When topping up hot-water heaters that are connected to the engine's cooling circuit, please observe the instructions in the instruction manuals of the manufacturers.

Further information can be obtained in the device manufacturer's instruc- tion manual.

218 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance12

12.6.1 Checking the fluid level

Switch off the hot-water heater and allow it to cool down. Check if the fluid level is between the marks "MIN" (Fig. 250,3) and "MAX" (Fig. 250,2) on the compensator reservoir (Fig. 250).

12.6.2 Topping up heating fluid

Position the vehicle horizontally. This prevents the formation of bubbles. Switch off the hot-water heater and allow it to cool down. Unscrew or pull off the panel. Open the rotary lid (Fig. 250,1) on the compensator reservoir. Remove cover. Check anti-freeze with an anti-freeze hydrometer. The frost protection con- tent must be 40 % or correspond to a frost protection of -25 C. Fill water frost protection mixture slowly into the compensator reservoir.

12.6.3 Bleeding the heating system

The bleeding valves are built in nearby the radiators. For position of the bleeding valves, see also table "Position of the bleeding valves".

Fig. 250 Compensator reservoir hot- water heater

The optimum fluid level is reached when the fluid in the compensator res- ervoir is 1 cm above the "MIN" mark when it is cooled down.

Fig. 251 Bleeding valve of hot-water heater

219I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance 12

Switch off the hot-water heater and allow it to cool down. Open bleeding valve (Fig. 251,1) and leave open until no more air escapes. Close bleeding valve. Repeat this procedure at all bleeding valves. Check to see if the hot-water heater warms up.

12.6.4 Position of the bleeding valves

Position of the bleeding valves

I 800 The drain for complete emptying is in the double floor under the water tank (under the vehicle)

Underneath the driver's and front passenger's seats

In the front bench seat of the central seating group

In the storage box of the divan

On the heat exchanger

In the kitchen to the side on the top drawer

On the steps to the rear bed to the right and left

I 810 The drain for complete emptying is in the double floor under the water tank (under the vehicle)

Underneath the driver's and front passenger's seats

In the front bench seat of the central seating group

Above the divan behind the curtain

In the lower cupboard to the left of the entrance

On the heat exchanger

In the kitchen to the side on the top drawer

On the garage flap directly on the heater

I 821 The drain for complete emptying is in the double floor under the water tank (under the vehicle)

Underneath the driver's and front passenger's seats

In the front bench seat of the central seating group

Above the divan behind the curtain

In the furniture cabinet at the left access

In the toilet compartment at the radiator

On the stairs to the rear bed

On the rear bed, left and right

On the heat exchanger

In the kitchen to the side on the top drawer

220 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance12

12.7 Independent vehicle heater Use the independent vehicle heater for 10 minutes at least once a month with a cold engine and smallest fan settings.

Position of the bleeding valves

I 890 The drain for complete emptying is in the double floor under the water tank (under the vehicle)

Underneath the driver's and front passenger's seats

In the front bench seat of the central seating group

In the storage box of the divan

In the lower cupboard to the left of the entrance

On the heat exchanger

In the kitchen to the side on the top drawer

In the panelling next to the rear bed to the right and left

On the radiator in the bathroom

In the toilet compartment

In the rear garage (below the cover of the bed panels)

Position of the bleeding valves

I 895 The drain for complete emptying is in the double floor under the water tank (under the vehicle)

Underneath the driver's and front passenger's seats

In the front bench seat of the central seating group

In the storage box of the divan

In the lower cupboard to the left of the entrance

On the heat exchanger

In the kitchen to the side on the top drawer

In the panelling next to the rear bed to the right and left

On the radiator in the bathroom

In the toilet compartment

In the rear garage (on the 3-way valve)

Position of the bleeding valves

I 900 The drain for complete emptying is in the double floor under the water tank (under the vehicle)

Underneath the driver's and front passenger's seats

In the front bench seat of the central seating group

In the storage box of the divan

In the lower cupboard to the left of the entrance

On the heat exchanger

In the kitchen to the side on the top drawer

In the panelling next to the rear bed to the right and left

221I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance 12

Before the heating season starts, have the independent vehicle heater checked by an authorised specialist workshop.

12.8 Replacing bulbs, external

Types of bulbs Different types of bulbs are used in the vehicle. Below, we have described how to change the different types of bulbs.

Bulbs and light fittings can be extremely hot. Therefore, allow lights to cool down before changing bulbs. Store bulbs in a safe place inaccessible to children. Do not use any bulb that has been dropped or which shows scratches in its glass. The bulb might burst.

A new bulb should not be touched with the fingers. Use a cloth when installing the new bulb. Use only bulbs of the same type and with the correct wattage (see table "Types of bulbs for exterior lighting"). If LEDs in lights are defect, contact an authorised dealer or service centre.

Fig. 252 Types of bulbs

Pos. in Fig. 252

Fixture type/bulb type

Changing

1 Plug-in fixture To remove, pull out the bulb

To mount, push the bulb into the socket with gentle pressure

2 Bayonet socket To remove, press the bulb down and turn in an anticlockwise direction

To insert, place the bulb in the socket and turn in a clockwise direction

3 Cylindrical bulbs To remove and to insert, carefully bend the contacts of the lamp holder outwards

4 Halogen bulb To remove, release retaining springs

After inserting, hook the retaining springs again

222 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance12

12.8.1 Front lights

Low beam/main beam The bulbs are changed in the engine compartment.

Open bonnet (see chapter 4). Put your hand behind the lamp holder (Fig. 254,1). Turn the lamp holder with the lamp in an anticlockwise direction and remove. Turn bulb in an anticlockwise direction and remove from the holder. Put in a new bulb.

Direction indicator The bulbs are changed in the engine compartment.

Open bonnet (see chapter 4). Put your hand behind the lamp holder (Fig. 255,1). Turn the lamp holder with the lamp in an anticlockwise direction and remove. Remove bulb.

Fig. 253 Front lights

1 Fog light 2 Daytime running light (LED) 3 Direction indicator 4 Low beam/main beam

Fig. 254 Low beam/main beam/parking light

Fig. 255 Direction indicator

223I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance 12

Put in a new bulb. Reassemble the direction indicator in the reverse order.

Daytime running light The lights have LEDs. To change the LEDs, contact an authorised dealer or a service centre.

Fog light The bulbs are changed in the engine compartment.

Open bonnet (see chapter 4). Put your hand behind the fog light and remove rubber cap (Fig. 256,1) from lamp housing. Press metal clip (Fig. 256,2) together and release from holder. Remove bulb (Fig. 256,3) with cable from lamp housing. Put in a new bulb. Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.

12.8.2 Front lights (variant)

Low beam/main beam The bulbs are changed in the engine compartment.

Fig. 256 Fog light

Fig. 257 Front lights

1 Fog light 2 Direction indicator 3 Parking light 4 Main beam/low beam

224 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance12

Open bonnet (see chapter 4). Put your hand behind the lamp holder (Fig. 254,1). Turn the lamp holder with the lamp in an anticlockwise direction and remove. Turn bulb in an anticlockwise direction and remove from the holder. Put in a new bulb.

Parking light The bulbs are changed in the engine compartment.

Open bonnet (see chapter 4). On the front frame, unscrew and remove 2 screws (Fig. 259,1 and 2) with washers. On the apron next to the engine bay opening, unscrew and remove 2 screws (Fig. 259,4) with washers. Unscrew and remove screw (Fig. 260,1) with washer. Holding the plastic apron (Fig. 260,2) at the side, carefully pull it a little bit forwards until the lamp housing is accessible. Turn the swivel nut on the lamp housing in an anticlockwise direction and remove. Remove the lamp housing of the parking light (Fig. 260,3) with the lamp. Remove the bulb from the lamp housing. Put in a new bulb.

Fig. 258 Low beam/main beam/parking light

Below is described how to change the bulb of the right-hand parking light. The description applies analogously to the left-hand parking light.

Fig. 259 Fixing the plastic projection Fig. 260 Plastic apron with lights

225I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance 12

Install the parking light in reverse order. Fix the plastic apron in reverse order.

Direction indicator The bulbs are changed in the engine compartment.

Open bonnet (see chapter 4). Put your hand behind the lamp holder (Fig. 255,1). Turn the lamp holder with the lamp in an anticlockwise direction and remove. Remove bulb. Put in a new bulb. Reassemble the direction indicator in the reverse order.

Fog light Put your hand behind the lamp holder. Turn the lamp holder with the lamp in an anticlockwise direction and remove. Remove bulb. Put in a new bulb. Reassemble the fog light in the reverse order.

12.8.3 Rear lights

Elongated lamps

Undo the housing screws (Fig. 262,1). Remove housing. Remove bulb.

Fig. 261 Direction indicator

Fig. 262 Rear lights

1 Housing screws 2 Rear light 3 Brake light 4 Direction indicator 5 Reverse light 6 Fog tail light

226 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance12

Put in a new bulb. Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.

Round lamps

Undo the housing screws (Fig. 263,1). Remove housing. Remove bulb. Put in a new bulb. Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.

12.8.4 Side lights

Side marker light The side marker light (Fig. 264,1) is fixed in the rear area at the top.

Direction indicator The lamp is glued in. If the bulb is faulty, contact an authorised dealer or service centre.

Marker lights The marker lights (Fig. 264,2) are fitted in the lower part of the vehicle.

Fig. 263 Rear lights

1 Housing screws 2 Rear light/brake light 3 Direction indicator 4 Reverse light (right) and fog tail light

(left)

Fig. 264 Side lights

1 Side marker light 2 Marker light 3 Direction indicator

Please have the LEDs of the side marker light replaced at a service centre.

The lights have LEDs. To change the LEDs, contact an authorised dealer or a service centre.

227I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance 12

12.8.5 Types of bulbs for exterior lighting

12.9 Replacing bulbs, internal

Exterior lighting Type of bulb

Front Main beam H7 12 V 55 W

Low beam H7 12 V 55 W

Parking light W5W 12 V 5 W (Viseo)

Direction indicator Bay 9s 12 V 21 W

BAU 15s 12 V 21 W (Viseo)

Fog light H3 12 V 55 W

Rear Rear light Ba15s 12 V 5 W

Brake light Ba15s 12 V 21 W

Direction indicator Ba15s 12 V 21 W

Fog tail light Ba15s 12 V 21 W

Reverse light Ba15s 12 V 21 W

Third brake light LED

Bulbs and light fittings can be extremely hot. Therefore, allow lights to cool down before changing bulbs. Shut off the power supply on the safety cut-out in the 230 V fuse box before changing bulbs. Store bulbs in a safe place inaccessible to children. Do not use any bulb that has been dropped or which shows scratches in its glass. The bulb might burst. Lights can get very hot. When the light is switched on, there must always be a safety distance of 30 cm between light and flammable objects. Fire hazard! Do not replace the LEDs in lamps with standard light bulbs. Risk of fire due to intense heat build up.

A new bulb should not be touched with the fingers. Use a cloth when installing the new bulb. Only use bulbs of the same type and with the correct wattage. If LEDs in lights are defect, contact an authorised dealer or service centre.

228 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance12

12.9.1 Ceiling lamp

The ceiling lamp has LEDs.

Changing bulbs: Press the two ends (Fig. 265,2) of the spring ring (Fig. 265,1) together and remove. Remove the housing (Fig. 265,3) with LED from the lamp. Pull out the plug and fully replace the housing with LED. Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.

12.9.2 Recessed halogen light

Halogen bulb 12 V/10 W The recessed halogen light (Fig. 266,1) is installed flush.

Changing bulbs: Use a screwdriver to remove the inner cover ring (Fig. 267,1) from the housing. Use a screwdriver to remove the cover ring with the glass (Fig. 267,2) from the lower section of the recessed halogen light. Remove halogen bulb (Fig. 267,3). Put in a new halogen bulb. Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.

Fig. 265 Ceiling lamp

Fig. 266 Recessed halogen light (flat) Fig. 267 Changing the halogen bulb

229I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance 12

12.9.3 Recessed halogen light (flat)

Halogen bulb G4 12 V/10 W The recessed halogen light (Fig. 268,2) is installed flush with the panel.

Changing bulbs: Use a suitable tool (e.g. a screwdriver) to lever out the internal cover ring with glass disk (Fig. 268,1) from the housing. Remove halogen bulb. Put in a new halogen bulb. Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.

12.9.4 Recessed light with LED

Changing bulbs: Contact a dealer or service centre.

Fig. 268 Recessed halogen light (flat)

Fig. 269 Recessed light

LED lamps have a very long life. It is not normally necessary to replace a lamp.

230 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance12

12.9.5 Halogen spotlight (movable)

Halogen bulb 12 V/10 W

Changing bulbs: Turn the halogen spotlight (Fig. 270,1) by 90 and remove from rail. Turn the lamp shade (Fig. 270,3) in an anticlockwise direction. Withdraw lamp shade complete with halogen bulb (Fig. 270,4) carefully from the holder (Fig. 270,2). Remove halogen bulb. Screw lamp shade onto holder. Insert new halogen spot light into the lamp shade and press into holder. Insert halogen lamp into the rail.

12.9.6 Wardrobe light

Halogen bulb 12 V/8 W

Changing bulbs: Press the light covering (Fig. 272,1) lightly together and remove it. Remove halogen bulb. Put in a new halogen bulb. Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.

Fig. 270 Halogen spotlight (movable) Fig. 271 Suction cup for replacing the lamp

A suction cup (Fig. 271,1) is included to help with changing the lamp.

Fig. 272 Wardrobe light

231I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance 12

12.9.7 Garage light

Halogen bulb 12 V/21 CP

Changing bulbs: Use a suitable tool (e.g. a screwdriver) to carefully lever out the cover (Fig. 273,2) at the notch (Fig. 273,1) and remove it. Remove halogen bulb. Put in a new halogen bulb. Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.

12.10 Spare parts

For safety reasons, spare parts for pieces of equipment must correspond with manufacturer's instructions and be permitted by the manufacturer as a spare part. These spare parts may only be fitted by the manufacturer or an author- ised specialist workshop. The authorised dealers and service centres are available for any spare parts requirement. Here are some suggestions of important spare parts:

Fuses V-belt Windscreen blades Bulbs Water pump (submerged pump)

When ordering spare parts please indicate the chassis number and the vehicle type to the dealer.

Fig. 273 Garage light

Every alteration of the original condition of the vehicle can alter road behaviour and jeopardize road safety. The special equipment and original spare parts recommended by us have been specially developed and supplied for your vehicle. These products are available at the authorised dealer or service centre. The authorised dealer or service centre is informed about admissible tech- nical details and carries out the required work correctly. The use of accessories, parts and fittings not supplied by us may cause damage to the vehicle and jeopardize road safety. Even if an expert's report, a general type approval or a design certification exists, there is no guarantee for the proper quality of the product. No liability can be assumed for damage caused by products which have not been released by us. This also applies to impermissible alterations to the vehicle.

232 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Maintenance12

The vehicle described in this instruction manual is built and equipped to factory standards. Special equipment is offered depending on its purpose or use. When fitting special equipment check if such equipment has to be entered in the vehicle documents. Observe the max. permissible gross weight. The authorised dealer or service centre will be happy to advise you.

12.11 Vehicle identification plate

The vehicle identification plate (Fig. 274) with the chassis number is mounted on the right hand side on the front. Do not remove the vehicle identification plate. The vehicle identification plate:

Identifies the vehicle Helps with the procurement of spare parts Together with the vehicle documents identifies the vehicle owner

12.12 Warning and information stickers There are warning and information stickers on and inside the vehicle. Warning and information stickers are for the sake of safety and must not be removed.

Fig. 274 Vehicle identification plate

1 Chassis number

Always include the chassis number with all inquiries for the customer service office. The chassis number of the base vehicle is located under a cover in the entrance at the passenger side for vehicle with passenger's door, for vehi- cles without passenger's door under a cover on the right hand side next to the front passenger's seat.

Replacement stickers can be obtained from an authorised dealer or a service centre.

233I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Wheels and tyres 13

13Wheels and tyresChapter overview This chapter contains instructions regarding the tyres of the vehicle. The instructions address the following topics:

tyre selection handling of tyres changing wheels spare wheel support

At the end of the chapter there is a table you can use to find the correct tyre pressure for your vehicle.

13.1 General

Observe: Check the tyres regularly (every 2 weeks) for equal tread wear, tread depth and external damage. Replace tyres at the latest, when the minimum depth of tread stipulated by law is reached. Always use tyres of the same model, same brand and same style (summer and winter tyres). Only use tyres approved for the wheel rim type fitted. The permitted rim and tyre sizes are quoted in the vehicle documents and the authorised dealer or service centre will always be glad to give you advice. Run-in new tyres for approx. 100 km (60 miles) at low speed since only then do they reach full strength.

Check tyre pressure before a journey or every 2 weeks. Wrong tyre pressure causes excessive wear and can lead to damage or even to tyre burst. You can lose control of the vehicle.

Only check the tyre pressure on cold tyres. Tubeless tyres have been installed on the vehicle. Never install tubes in these tyres. Read the instruction manual for the base vehicle.

Depending on the base vehicle and model the vehicles are only equipped with tyre repair kit as standard. In the case of a puncture, pull over to the side of the road. Make vehicle safe with a hazard warning triangle. Switch on the warning lights. Tyres on vehicles with tandem axles may wear faster. Tyres must not be older than 6 years as the material will become brittle over time. The four-digit DOT number on the tyre flank indicates the date of manufacture. The first two digits designate the week, the last two digits the year of manufacture.

Example: Week 05, year of manufacture 2011.

234 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Wheels and tyres13

Check regularly that the wheel nuts or wheel bolts are firmly seated. Re- tighten the wheel nuts or wheel bolts of a changed wheel cross-wise (Fig. 275) after 50 km (30 miles). See section 13.5.2 for tightening torque. When using new or newly painted rims, re-tighten the wheel nuts or wheel bolts once again after approx. 1,000 to 5,000 km (600 miles to 3,000 miles). For lay-ups or long periods of inactivity, keep the tyres and tyre bearings free from pressure points: Jack up the vehicle so that the wheels do not bear any load, or move the vehicle every 4 weeks in such a way that the position of the wheels is changed.

13.2 Tyre selection

The tyre sizes approved for the vehicle are given in the vehicle documents or can be obtained from the authorised dealers or service centres. Each tyre must fit the vehicle on which it will be driven. This applies to the external dimensions (diameter, width), which are indicated with the standardised size designations. In addition, the tyres must meet the requirements of the vehicle with regard to weight and speed. Weight refers to the maximum permissible axle load which can be distributed on two tyres. The maximum load-carrying capacity of a tyre is indicated by its load index (= LI, load index code). The axle geometry of a vehicle, such as wheel camber and track, is also important for tyre selection. The maximum permissible speed for a tyre (with full load-carrying capacity) is indicated by the speed index (= SI). Together, load index and speed index form the operating code of a tyre. This is an official component of the complete, standardised dimensions description which appears on every tyre. The information on the tyres must correspond to the specifications which appear in the vehicle papers.

Fig. 275 Tighten the wheel nuts or wheel bolts cross-wise

A wrong tyre can damage the tyres during the journey and even cause it to burst.

If tyres that are not approved for the vehicle are used, then the type approval for the vehicle and subsequently the insurance coverage can lapse. The authorised dealer or service centre will be happy to advise you.

235I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Wheels and tyres 13

13.3 Tyre specifications

13.4 Handling of tyres

Drive over kerbs at an obtuse angle. Otherwise the flanks of the tyres may get pinched. Driving over a kerb at a sharp angle can damage the tyre and result in it getting ruptured. Drive over high manhole covers at a slow speed. Otherwise the tyres may get pinched. Driving over a high manhole cover at high speed can damage the tyre and result in it getting ruptured. Check the shock absorbers regularly. Driving with poor shock absorbers significantly increases wear. If the tread wear is uneven, have the toe-in and the wheel camber checked. Driving with an incorrectly set toe-in or a one-sided wheel camber leads to a significant increase in wear. Avoid block brakings. Block braking gives the tyres "brake plates" of var- ying strength. This reduces driving comfort. It might even make the tyres unserviceable. Do not clean the tyres with a high-pressure cleaner. The tyres can suffer serious damage within just a few seconds and rupture as a result. Drive in such a way as to protect your tyres. Avoid braking sharply, revving up too strongly and long journeys on poor roads.

13.5 Changing wheels 13.5.1 General instructions

Description Explanation

215/70 R 15C 109/107 Q (example)

215 Tyre width in mm

70 Height-to-width proportion in percent

R Tyre design (R = radial)

15 Rim diameter in inches

C Commercial (transporter)

109 Load index code for single tyres

107 Load index code for twin tyres

Q Speed index (Q = 160 km/h)

The vehicle must be on level, firm ground, secure from slipping. Go into first gear. In the case of automatic transmission, change gear to "P" position. Before jacking up the vehicle firmly apply the handbrake. Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by blocking the opposite wheel with the wheel chocks. Under no circumstances jack the vehicle with the fitted supports. If a trailer is connected: Detach the trailer before lifting the vehicle. Position the vehicle jack underneath the axle, not under any circum- stances on the bodywork.

236 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Wheels and tyres13

13.5.2 Tightening torque Depending on the wheel rim type and the wheel manufacturer, the wheels must be tightened with different tightening torques.

Steel wheel rim Steel wheel rim 15": Tightening torque 160 Nm Steel wheel rim 16": Tightening torque 180 Nm

Alloy wheel rim Borbet

Alloy wheel rim 15" Borbet HW65560: Tightening torque 130 Nm Alloy wheel rim 16" Borbet HW65660: Tightening torque 130 Nm

Never overload the vehicle jack. The maximum permissible load is spec- ified on the vehicle jack's identification plate. Use the vehicle jack only for lifting the vehicle briefly while changing the tyre. No persons may be in the vehicle while it is is raised. Do not start the motor while the vehicle is jacked up. Whilst the vehicle is in a jacked up position, persons must not lie down under it.

Do not damage the thread of the thread bolt or wheel bold when changing the wheel. Tighten the wheel nuts or wheel bolts cross-wise (Fig. 275). When changing wheels (e.g. alloy wheel rims or wheels with winter tyres), use the correct wheel bolts of the correct length and shape. Otherwise the wheels may not be securely fixed or the braking system may not work cor- rectly. The use of wheel rims or tyres that are not approved for the vehicle can make it less than fully roadworthy; such wheel rims or tyres must be sepa- rately inspected and approved by an accredited test centre. Do not replace wheels cross-wise.

Protect the vehicle according to the national regulations, e.g. with a hazard warning triangle. Before changing the wheel, check the wheel rim and tyre size, the max. tyre load and the speed index on the tyres. Only use the wheel rim and tyre sizes stated in the vehicle documents. Further information can be found in the instruction manual of the base vehicle.

Fig. 276 Alloy wheel rim Borbet

237I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Wheels and tyres 13

Alloy wheel rim Tomason

Alloy wheel rim 15" Tomason TN3F-6515: Tightening torque 180 Nm Alloy wheel rim 16" Tomason TN3F-6516: Tightening torque 180 Nm

Alloy wheel rim Goldschmitt

Alloy wheel rim 15" Goldschmitt GSM1-1560: Tightening torque 180 Nm Alloy wheel rim 16" Goldschmitt GSM1-1665: Tightening torque 180 Nm

Fig. 277 Alloy wheel rim Tomason

Fig. 278 Alloy wheel rim Goldschmitt

238 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Wheels and tyres13

13.5.3 Changing a wheel

Park the vehicle on as even and stable a surface as possible. Switch off the engine and safeguard the area. Go into first gear. In the case of automatic transmission, change gear to "P" position. Apply the handbrake. Place wheel chocks or other appropriate objects beneath the opposite wheel of the vehicle to secure it (Fig. 279). Remove the spare wheel from the spare wheel support. If the ground is soft, place a stable support such as a wooden board beneath the vehicle jack. Apply the vehicle jack to the designated mounting points (refer to the instruction manual for the base vehicle). Turn the wheel bolts several times to loosen them, but do not remove them. Lift the vehicle until the wheel has been lifted 2 to 3 cm above the ground. Remove the wheel bolts and take off the wheel. Place the spare wheel on the wheel hub and adjust. Screw in the wheel bolts and slightly tighten them cross-wise. Crank down the vehicle jack and remove it. Using the wheelbrace, tighten the wheel bolts evenly (see section 13.5.2 for tightening torque). Have the tightening torque checked by an authorised specialist workshop.

The footplate of the vehicle jack must be levelly positioned on the ground. Do not tilt the vehicle jack.

The wheel you have replaced should be repaired immediately. Take note of the general instructions in this chapter.

Fig. 279 Securing vehicle

239I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Wheels and tyres 13

13.6 Spare wheel support (special equipment) Depending on the model, the spare wheel can be found under the vehicle or in the rear garage.

13.6.1 Spare wheel support under the vehicle The spare wheel is fitted below the body between the frame parts of the chassis. The spare wheel can be lowered or lifted with a winch.

Removing the spare wheel: Insert the crank from the on-board tool set into the holder on the winch. Turn crank in an anticlockwise direction until the retaining rope is released along the entire length. Pull the spare wheel out from under the vehicle as far as possible. Release the securing bracket and the wing nuts of the spare wheel support. Remove the spare wheel.

13.6.2 Spare wheel support under the vehicle (basket)

Removing the spare wheel: Loosen the nuts (Fig. 280,1) on the right and left rear hooks (Fig. 280,2) of the spare wheel support. Unscrew the wheel nuts approx. 3 to 4 cm. Pull the bar (Fig. 280,3) slightly upwards. At the same time, pull down the hooks and unhook the bar. Take down the basket and remove the spare wheel.

Also read the separate instruction manual of the base vehicle.

When securing the spare wheel, the inside part of the rim must point upwards. Tighten wing nut and secure it with splint. Turn the crank until the retaining rope has been totally wound up, and the spare wheel fits tightly in the holder.

Due to its weight and fitted position, the spare wheel can be raised or lowered by a very strong person only. Always get a second person to assist.

Fig. 280 Spare wheel support (basket)

240 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Wheels and tyres13

13.6.3 Spare wheel support in the rear garage

Removing the spare wheel: Open external flap of the rear garage. Loosen and remove both fixing screws (Fig. 281,2) with the on-board tool set. Remove the spare wheel (Fig. 281,1) from the support (Fig. 281,3).

13.7 Tyre pressure

The payload and the durability of tyres is directly dependent on the tyre pres- sure. Air is a volatile medium. It is unavoidable that it will escape from tyres. As a rule of thumb it can be assumed that a filled tyre loses pressure at a rate of 0.1 bar every two months. To prevent the tyres becoming damaged or burst, check the tyre pressure regularly. The contact surface of the tyre changes, depending on the tyre pressure.

Fig. 281 Spare wheel support in the rear garage

Tyres overheat if the tyre pressure is too low. This can cause serious tyre damage. Check tyre pressure before a journey or every 2 weeks. Wrong tyre pressure causes excessive wear and can lead to damage or even to tyre burst. You can lose control of the vehicle. Use only valves that are approved for the specified tyre pressure.

Only check the tyre pressure on cold tyres.

Fig. 282 Contact surface of the tyre

1 Correct tyre pressure 2 Tyre pressure too low 3 Tyre pressure too high

241I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Wheels and tyres 13

The vehicles are constantly brought up to the newest technical standards. It is possible that new tyre sizes are not yet included in this table. If this is the case, any dealer or service centre will be happy to provide the newest values.

The information on pressure levels is valid for cold tyres and loaded vehi- cles. Pressure in hot tyres must be 0.3 bar higher than in cold tyres. Recheck the pressure when the tyres are cold. Tyre pressures in bar. Over 4.75 bar requires a metal valve. The tyre pressure tolerance is +/- 0.05 bar.

Types Tyre size Front air pressure in bar

Rear air pressure in bar

All types 215/70 R 15 C (109/107) Q

4.1 4.5

All types with motorhome tyres

215/70 R 15 CP (109/107) Q

5.0 5.5

All types 225/75 R 16 C (116/114) R

4.5 5.0

All types with motorhome tyres

225/75 R 16 CP (116/114) R

5.5 5.5

All types 225/75 R 16 C (116/114) Q (tandem axle)

4.5 3.5

All types with motorhome tyres

225/75 R 16 CP (116/114) Q (tandem axle)

5.5 3.5

242 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Wheels and tyres13

243I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting 14

14TroubleshootingChapter overview This chapter contains instructions about possible faults in your vehicle. The faults are listed with their possible causes and corresponding remedies. The instructions address the following topics:

braking system electrical system fuel cell gas system heater boiler air conditioning unit gas cooker gas oven microwave oven refrigerator water supply body

The specified faults can be remedied with relative ease and without a great deal of specialised knowledge. In the event that the remedies detailed in this instruction manual should not be successful, an authorised specialist work- shop must find and eliminate the cause of the fault.

14.1 Braking system

14.2 Electrical system

Have defects on the braking system immediately remedied by an author- ised specialist workshop.

When the living area battery is changed, only use batteries of the same type.

See chapter 8 for changing the fuses.

Fault Cause Remedy

Road light system does no longer work correctly

Bulb is defective Replace bulb. Note volts and watts specifications

Interior lighting does no longer work correctly

Bulb is defective Replace bulb. Note volts and watts specifications

Fuse on the transformer/ rectifier is defective

Replace fuse on the transformer/rectifier

The electrically operated entrance step cannot be moved in or out

Fuse on the transformer/ rectifier is defective

Replace fuse on the transformer/rectifier

244 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting14

No 230 V power supply despite connection

230 V automatic circuit breaker has triggered

Switch on the 230 V au- tomatic circuit breaker

The mains connection is de-energised

Check the mains connec- tion

Starter or living area bat- tery is not charged when operated in 230 V mode

Jumbo flat fuse (50 A) on the starter or living area battery is defective

Replace jumbo flat fuse (50 A) on the starter or living area battery

Charger module in the transformer/rectifier is defective

Contact customer service

Living area battery is not charged during vehicle operation

Fuse on terminal D+ of the alternator is defective

Replace fuse

Disconnector relay in the transformer/rectifier is defective

Contact customer service

12 V power supply does not work

12 V power supply switched off

Switch 12 V power sup- ply on

Battery cut-off switch on the transformer/rectifier switched off or battery separation activated

Switch on battery cut-off switch or deactivate bat- tery separation via the panel

Living area battery is dis- charged

Charging the living area battery

Jumbo flat fuse (50 A) on the living area battery is defective

Replace jumbo flat fuse (50 A) on the living area battery

Disconnector relay in the transformer/rectifier is defective

Contact customer service

12 V power supply does not work in 230 V opera- tion

12 V power supply switched off

Switch 12 V power sup- ply on

Battery cut-off switch on the transformer/rectifier switched off or battery separation activated

Switch on battery cut-off switch or deactivate bat- tery separation via the panel

Charger module in the transformer/rectifier is defective

Contact customer service

230 V automatic circuit breaker has triggered

Contact customer service

Jumbo flat fuse (50 A) on the living area battery is defective

Replace jumbo flat fuse (50 A) on the living area battery

Starter battery is dis- charged in 12 V opera- tion

Disconnector relay in the transformer/rectifier is defective

Contact customer service

Battery cut-off switch on the transformer/rectifier switched off or battery separation activated

Switch on battery cut-off switch or deactivate bat- tery separation via the panel

Fault Cause Remedy

245I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting 14

No voltage is supplied by the living area battery

Living area battery is dis- charged

Charge living area bat- tery immediately

Total discharge damages the battery.

If the vehicle is to be laid up for a long period, fully charge the living area battery beforehand Discharging is caused by inactive appliances (see chapter 8)

The 12 V indicator lamp does not light up or there is no display on the panel

12 V power supply switched off

Switch 12 V power sup- ply on

Battery cut-off switch on the transformer/rectifier switched off or battery separation activated

Switch on battery cut-off switch or deactivate bat- tery separation via the panel

Starter or living area bat- tery is not charged

Charge the starter or liv- ing area battery

Disconnector relay in the transformer/rectifier is defective

Contact customer service

Flat fuse (2 A) in the liv- ing area battery is defec- tive

Replace flat fuse (2 A) in the living area battery

Extractor hood does not work

230 V automatic circuit breaker is switched off

Switch on the 230 V au- tomatic circuit breaker

Fuse (15 A) at the trans- former/rectifier is defec- tive

Replace fuse (15 A)

Extractor hood defective Contact customer service

Fault Cause Remedy

246 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting14

14.3 Fuel cell

14.4 Gas system

Do not open the fuel cell. The fuel cell contains no parts that could be repaired by itself. All faults are not displayed. If the faults cannot be rectified using the fol- lowing table or the instruction manual for the fuel cell, please contact the customer service.

Fault (display) Cause Remedy

Fuel cell cannot be switched on

No battery connected, battery connected incor- rectly or totally dis- charged

Inspect the connection

Fuse is defective Replace fuse; if it hap- pens again, contact the customer service

Failure: Environment too warm

Ambient temperature too high (40 C)

Fuel cell restarts when the ambient temperature is between 0 C and 40 C

In case of a defect of the gas system (gas odour, high gas consumption) there is danger of explosion! Close regulator tap on the gas bottle imme- diately. Open doors and windows and ventilate well. If the gas system is defective: Do not smoke; do not ignite any open flames, and do not operate electric switches (light switches etc.). Have the defective gas system repaired by an authorised specialist workshop.

Fault Cause Remedy

No gas Gas bottle is empty Change gas bottle

Gas isolator tap closed Open the gas isolator tap

Regulator tap on the gas bottle is closed

Open regulator tap on the gas bottle

External temperature is too low (-42 C for pro- pane gas, 0 C for bu- tane gas)

Wait for higher external temperatures

Built-in appliance is de- fective

Contact customer service

247I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting 14

14.5 Heater/boiler In the event of a defect contact the nearest customer service workshop of the relevant appliance manufacturer. The list of addresses is enclosed with the accompanying appliance documentation. Only authorised qualified personnel may repair the appliance.

14.5.1 Truma heater/boiler

Fault Cause Remedy

Heater does not ignite Temperature sensor on operating unit or remote sensor defective

Pull out plug on operating unit. The heater then works without thermostat. Contact the customer service as soon as possi- ble

Red indicator lamp "Fault" illuminates

Air in the gas pipe sys- tem

Switch off and on again. After two futile ignition at- tempts, wait for 10 minutes before trying again

Lack of gas Open regulator tap and gas isolator tap

Connect a full gas bottle

Defect of a safety ele- ment

Contact customer service

Red indicator lamp "Fault" is flashing

Operating voltage too low Charge or replace the liv- ing area battery (or have it charged or replaced)

Green indicator lamp be- hind knob is not lit

Fuse on the transformer/ rectifier is defective

Replace fuse on the transformer/rectifier

Fuse in the electronic control unit has been trig- gered

Contact customer service

Living area battery defec- tive

Charge or replace the liv- ing area battery (or have it charged or replaced)

Yellow indicator lamp on the energy selector switch does not illumi- nate

No supply voltage Check 230 V connection and fuses

Overheating switch was triggered

Press overheating switch

Boiler empties, safety/ drainage valve has opened

Internal temperature be- low 8 C

Heat inside

Safety/drainage valve cannot be closed

Temperature at safety/ drainage valve below 8 C

Heat inside

Red and green indicator lamps are not lit

Fuse is defective Replace fuse on the transformer/rectifier

Fan wheel runs noisily or not steadily

Fan wheel is soiled Contact Truma service department

248 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting14

14.5.2 Alde heater/boiler

14.6 Air conditioning unit 14.6.1 Dometic

If a fault occurs in the system, the cause is shown on the display.

Fault Cause Remedy

Heater does not ignite with gas operation

Lack of gas Open regulator tap and gas isolator tap

Connect a full gas bottle

Heater does not ignite Battery voltage too low Charge battery. If the battery voltage rises above 11 V, the heater is switched on automatical- ly

Heater does not ignite at 230 V electrical operation

No 230 V power supply Switch on the 230 V au- tomatic circuit breaker

Connect 230 V power supply

Heater switches off Overheating Allow the heater to cool. To reset the display, in- terrupt the 12 V power supply to the heater and switch it back on again

Heater running, but no heat at the convectors

Circulating pump does not work

Switch on room thermo- stat

Contact customer service

Heater and circulating pump running, but no heat at the convectors

Air in the heating system Bleed hot-water heater

Fault Cause Remedy

Air conditioning unit does not start up

No 230 V power supply Connect the vehicle to the local power supply

230 V automatic circuit breaker has triggered

Switch on the 230 V au- tomatic circuit breaker

Remote control batteries empty

Change remote control batteries

Air conditioning unit does not cool

Temperature below 16 C

Temperature has been set incorrectly

Adjust the temperature

Thermostat defective Contact customer service

Air conditioning unit does not warm up

Temperature above 30 C

Temperature has been set incorrectly

Adjust the temperature

Thermostat defective Contact customer service

249I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting 14

14.6.2 Telair

14.7 Cooker 14.7.1 Gas cooker/gas oven

Water is entering the ve- hicle

Drainage holes for con- densation are clogged

Clean air conditioning unit

Seal is defective Contact customer service

No more air circulation Air filter clogged Clean air filter

Fan wheel defective Contact customer service

Fault Cause Remedy

Air conditioning unit does not start up

No 230 V power supply Connect 230 V power supply

230 V automatic circuit breaker has triggered

Switch on the 230 V au- tomatic circuit breaker

Remote control batteries empty

Change batteries (2 x AAA)

Air conditioning unit does not cool

Room temperature is lower than the preset temperature

Reset temperature

Air conditioning unit does not heat

Room temperature is higher than the preset temperature

Reset temperature

Insufficient ventilation rat- ing

Ventilation flaps closed Open at least one venti- lation flap

Filter dirty Clean the filter

Water is entering the ve- hicle

Drainage holes for con- densation are clogged

Clean air conditioning unit

Fault Cause Remedy

Ignition fuse does not op- erate (flame does not burn after the control knobs are released)

Heat-up time is too short Keep control knob pressed for approx. 15 to 20 seconds after ignition

Ignition fuse is defective Contact customer service

Flame extinguishes when being reduced to its mini- mum setting

Thermocouple sensor is incorrectly set

Correctly reset thermo- couple sensor (do not bend). The sensor tip should protrude by 5 mm beyond the burner. The sensor neck should not be more than 3 mm away from the burner ring; if necessary, contact cus- tomer service

Fault Cause Remedy

250 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting14

14.7.2 Microwave oven

14.8 Refrigerator In the event of a defect contact the nearest customer service workshop of the relevant appliance manufacturer. The list of addresses is enclosed with the accompanying appliance documentation. Only authorised qualified personnel may repair the appliance.

14.8.1 Dometic 7 series with AES

Only qualified personnel may repair the microwave oven. Improper repairs can cause major risks to the user.

Fault Cause Remedy

Microwave oven does not cut in

Fuse is defective Replace fuse

Door of the microwave oven is not properly closed

Remove foreign bodies stuck in the door of the microwave oven and close door properly

Fault Cause Remedy

Indicator lamps "230 V", "12 V" or "AUTO" are not lit green

Refrigerator is turned off Switch on the refrigera- tor with energy selector switch

No electrical operating voltage

Connect 230 V power supply

Let the vehicle engine run

Switch on or replace the fuse

Contact a specialist workshop

Refrigerator does not switch to 12 V mode dur- ing the journey

Operating voltage of al- ternator is not present/ too low

Contact a specialist workshop

Refrigerator does not switch on in gas opera- tion, "GAS" indicator lamp is not lit yellow

Lack of gas Open regulator tap and gas isolator tap

Connect a full gas bottle

Cobwebs or burnt resi- due in the burning cham- ber

Remove the ventilation grill on the outside of the vehicle and clean the burning chamber

251I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting 14

14.8.2 Dometic 8 series with AES

"GAS" indicator lamp flashes yellow, no gas

Air in the gas pipe Switch off the refrigera- tor with energy selector switch

Open regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap of the re- frigerator

Switch on the refrigera- tor with energy selector switch. After 10 seconds, the AES will attempt an- other ignition

If the "GAS" indicator lamp flashes yellow again after approx. 30 seconds, the failure has not been remedied yet

Repeat this process two to three times for ventila- tion. If the refrigerator cannot be operated, con- tact customer services

In the case of a fault the LED display fault will always light up " ".

Fault Cause Remedy

Text "230 V" flashes No 230 V power supply Connect 230 V power supply

230 V automatic circuit breaker has triggered

Switch on the 230 V au- tomatic circuit breaker

230 V operating voltage too low

Have the 230 V power supply checked by an au- thorised specialist work- shop

Text "12 V" flashes Fuse on the transformer/ rectifier is defective

Replace fuse on the transformer/rectifier

Disconnector relay in the transformer/rectifier is defective

Contact customer service

12 V operating voltage too low

Have the 12 V power supply checked by an au- thorised specialist work- shop

Fault Cause Remedy

252 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting14

14.9 Water supply

Text "GAS" flashes Lack of gas Open regulator tap and gas isolator tap

Connect a full gas bottle

Cobwebs or burnt resi- due in the burning cham- ber

Remove the ventilation grill on the outside of the vehicle and clean the burning chamber

LEDs for display of the temperature range flash

Temperature sensor de- fective

Contact customer service

Text "HE1" flashes 230 V heater element de- fective

Contact customer service

Text "HE2" flashes 12 V heater element de- fective

Contact customer service

Fault Cause Remedy

Leakage water inside the vehicle

A leak has occurred Identify leak, re-connect water pipes

No water Water tank is empty Replenish drinking water

Drain cock not closed Close drain cock

12 V power supply switched off

Switch 12 V power sup- ply on

Fuse of the water pump is defective

Replace fuse on the transformer/rectifier

Water pump defective Exchange water pump (have it exchanged)

Water pipe snapped off Straighten water pipe or replace

Transformer/rectifier de- fective

Contact customer service

Water pump switched off on panel

Switch water pump on

Toilet has no flush water Water tank is empty Replenish drinking water

Fuse for toilet is defective Replace fuse

Display for water and waste water indicates a wrong value

Measuring probe in the waste water or water tank is soiled

Clean water/waste water tank

Measuring probe is de- fective

Replace measuring probe

Waste water tank cannot be emptied

Drain cock is clogged Open the cleaning cap on the waste water tank and drain the waste wa- ter. Rinse the waste wa- ter tank well

Drain on the single lever mixer tap is clogged

Perlator calcified Unclip the perlator, de- calcify in vinegar water (only for products made from metal)

Fault Cause Remedy

253I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting 14

Water jets on the shower nozzle clogged

Water jets calcified De-calcify shower nozzle in vinegar water (only for products made from met- al) or rub off soft nozzle burling

Water drains from the shower tray slowly or does not drain at all

The vehicle is not in a horizontal position

Position the vehicle hori- zontally

Milkiness of the water Tank filled with dirty wa- ter

Clean water tank me- chanically and chemical- ly; then disinfect and rinse copiously with drinking water

Residues in the water tank or water system

Clean water system me- chanically and chemical- ly; then disinfect and rinse copiously with drinking water

Any change in the taste or odour of the water

Tank filled with dirty wa- ter

Clean water system me- chanically and chemical- ly; then disinfect and rinse copiously with drinking water

Fuel filled into the water tank by mistake

Clean water system me- chanically and chemical- ly; then disinfect and rinse copiously with drinking water. If not suc- cessful: Contact a spe- cialist workshop

Microbiological deposits in the water system

Clean water system me- chanically and chemical- ly; then disinfect and rinse copiously with drinking water

Deposits in the water tank and/or water-carry- ing components

Water excessively long in the water tank and in wa- ter-carrying components

Clean water system me- chanically and chemical- ly; then disinfect and rinse copiously with drinking water

Fault Cause Remedy

254 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Troubleshooting14

14.10 Body Fault Cause Remedy

Flap hinges/door hinges are difficult to operate

Flap/door hinges are not sufficiently lubricated

Lubricate flap hinges/ door hinges with acid- free and resin-free grease

Hinges/joints in the bath- room unit/toilet compart- ment are difficult to operate/make a grating noise

Hinges/joints are not suf- ficiently lubricated

Lubricate hinges/joints with solvent-free and acid-free grease

Spray cans often contain solvents

Storage compartment hinges are difficult to op- erate/make a grating noise

Storage compartment hinges are not sufficiently lubricated

Lubricate storage com- partment hinges with acid-free and resin-free grease

Wind-up skylight is diffi- cult to operate

Threaded spindle not lu- bricated

Lubricate threaded spin- dle

Threaded spindle defec- tive

Have threaded spindle replaced

The authorised dealers and service centres are available for any spare parts requirement.

255I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Special equipment 15

15Special equipment15.1 Weight details for special equipment

Weight details for factory-provided special equipment are listed in the table below. If these objects are either carried in or on the vehicle and are not part of the standard equipment, they must be taken into consideration when calcu- lating the payload. All weight details are approximate. Observe the max. permissible gross weight.

The use of accessories, parts and fittings not supplied by us may cause damage to the vehicle and jeopardize road safety. Even if an expert's report, a general type approval or a design certification exists, there is no guarantee for the proper quality of the product. Every alteration of the original condition of the vehicle can alter road behaviour and jeopardize road safety. No liability can be assumed for damage caused by products which have not been released by us. This also applies to impermissible alterations to the vehicle.

Item designation Surplus weight (kg)

Waste water pipes, insulated and heated 2

Waste water tank, heated with heating coils 1

Airbag (driver/front passenger) 3

Alloy wheel rims -15

Alloy wheel rims (tandem axle) -20

Caravan coupling, detachable 30

Caravan coupling 40

Dashboard upgrade 2

Conversion door, single-section (with window) 30

External shower 1

External mirrors, electrically adjustable and heated 2

External socket 1

Automatic transmission 17

Car radio and CD 1

Front passenger's seat, variable height 2

Fuel cell 8

Heki skylight midi 8

Skylight Heki 3 15

Roof rail 5

Extractor hood 1

Entrance step, electrical 5

Electrical stability program (ESP) 3

Spare wheel with 15" support (rear garage) 20

Spare wheel with with 15" support (underneath vehicle) 30

Spare wheel with 16" support (rear garage) 21

256 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Special equipment15

Spare wheel with with 16" support (underneath vehicle) 31

External gas connection 1

Driver's seat, variable height 2

Bike rack for 2 bicycles 10

Bike rack for 2 bicycles, lowerable 18

Bike rack for 3 bicycles 11

Bike rack for 3 bicycles, lowerable 20

Driver's door 38

Floor warming unit 4

Garage door, left 3

Gas oven 17

Gas bottle (11 kg) made of aluminium 12

Gas switching facility, automatic 2

Gas alarm system 5

Rear window 3

Rear ladder 10

Alde heater 30

Truma Combi 6 EH heater 3

Insect screen, door (full height) 4

Air conditioning unit (Dometic) 40

Driver's cabin air conditioning unit 18

Air conditioning unit (Telair) 34

Fuel tank 120 l 50

Refrigerator (160 l) 14

Refrigerator (Tec-Tower) 16-30

Level Controller 19

Alternator 180 Ah 2

Air suspension (2-axle vehicle) 79

Air suspension (3-axle vehicle) 113

Rear air suspension (2-axle vehicle) 45

Rear air suspension (3-axle vehicle) 79

Awning 350 cm 33

Awning 400 cm 38

Awning 450 cm 41

Awning 500 cm 46

Awning 550 cm 58

Awning 600 cm 61

Microwave oven 14

Minisafe 12

Item designation Surplus weight (kg)

257I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Special equipment 15

Motorcycle rack 38

Motorcycle rack in the rear garage 12

Navigation system 1

Fog light 4

Radio preparation 4

Reversing camera 4

Satellite unit (automatic) + LCD television 14-25

Satellite unit (semi-automatic) + LCD television 10

Solar installation 1 x 100 W 10

Solar installation 2 x 100 W 20

Independent vehicle heater 3

Steadies, electrically operated 20

Rear steadies 5

Bedspread 2

Telescopic ladder 10

Tempomat 3

Carpet in driver's cabin 2

Carpet in the living area 3

Adjustment mechanism bench (Reliner) 14

Winter insulation mat, outside 3

Auxiliary battery 27

Auxiliary heat exchanger 3

Two cross beams and slip protection for roof racks 3

Item designation Surplus weight (kg)

258 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Special equipment15

259I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Technical data 16

16Technical data16.1 View of ground plans Explanations (1) 230 V fuse

(2) Transformer/rectifier with 12 V fuses (3) Living area battery with main fuse (4) Water pump mounted in the tank area (5) Drain cock, waste water tank (6) Safety/drainage valve (7) Boiler/heater (8) Water drain cock - yellow (9) Water tank (10) Additional heater (partially special equipment) (11) Alde hot-water heater (12) Compensator reservoir for Alde hot-water heater (13) Alde auxiliary heat exchanger (14) Water drain cock - white * Access via service flap ** Beneath the vehicle *** Access via kitchen floor cupboard

Specifications without guarantee

Fig. 283 Ground plan I 640 G Viseo

Fig. 284 Ground plan I 640 G Viseo (alternative)

260 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Technical data16

Fig. 285 Ground plan I 684 P Aviano

Fig. 286 Ground plan I 707 Viseo

Fig. 287 Ground plan I 709 Aviano

Fig. 288 Ground plan I 726 Viseo

261I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Technical data 16

Fig. 289 Ground plan I 726 Viseo (alternative)

Fig. 290 Ground plan I 727 Aviano

Fig. 291 Ground plan I 728 G Aviano

Fig. 292 Ground plan I 730 Elegance

262 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Technical data16

Fig. 293 Ground plan I 737 G Viseo

Fig. 294 Ground plan I 739 G Aviano

Fig. 295 Ground plan I 800 G Elegance

Fig. 296 Ground plan I 810 G Elegance

263I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Technical data 16

Fig. 297 Ground plan I 821 G Elegance

Fig. 298 Ground plan I 870 G Aviano

Fig. 299 Ground plan I 875 G Aviano

Fig. 300 Ground plan I 890 G Elegance

264 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Technical data16

16.2 Table of linear measures

Fig. 301 Ground plan I 895 G Elegance

Fig. 302 Ground plan I 900 Elegance

Type Body width, exterior

Total length without ladder

Wheelbase Overall height without anten- na

I 640 G 2300 6850 3800 2850

I 684 2300 6960 3800 2750

I 707 2300 7070 4035 2850

I 709 2300 7100 4035 2750

I 726 2300 7490 4035 2850

I 727 2300 7560 4035 2750

I 728 G 2300 7560 4035 2750

I 730 2300 7590 4090 2850

I 737 G 2300 7450 4035 2850

I 739 G 2300 7460 4035 2750

I 800 G 2300 8120 4600 2850

I 810 G 2300 9200 4500 2850

I 821 G 2300 8870 4500 2850

I 870 G 2300 8800 4600 2850

I 875 G 2300 8800 4600 2850

265I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Technical data 16

16.3 Power supply

I 890 G 2300 9000 4600 2850

I 895 G 2300 9000 4600 2850

I 900 G 2300 9000 4600 2850

Mains connection Protection class I 230 V ( 10 %), 47 - 63 Hz

Mains power rating 400 VA

Appropriate batteries 6-cell lead acid and lead acid gel batteries from 55 Ah

Charging characteristics IUoU

Final charge voltage 14.3 V

Charging current 18 A throughout entire sup- ply voltage range, electroni- cally restricted

18 A

Trickle charge voltage Automatic switching 13.8 V

Repeated charging cycle (switchover to "Main charg- ing")

At < approx. 13.8 V battery voltage (with approx. 5 seconds delay)

Reflux (without mains and with connected battery)

After approx. 3 minutes "Mains Off"

< 0.3 mA

Guard circuits Short-circuit protection pro- vided by built-in car fuse (FKS)

Safety fuse, 3.15 AT at power input

Overtemperature protection

Charging current distribu- tion at mains connection

Starter battery float charge with max. 2 A or 6 A

Max. 2 A (EBL 99) or max. 6 A (EBL 220)

Living area battery charge with max. 18 A

Max. 18 A

Charging current distribu- tion during the journey

Simultaneous charging of starter and living area bat- teries by means of the alter- nator

50 A

Parallel battery switching via disconnector relay

Maximum permitted alter- nator charging current to the living area battery: 50 A (see block diagram)

Battery monitor Disconnection 10.5 V 0.1 V

Battery monitor Minimum voltage for con- nection

11.0 V 0.1 V

Type Body width, exterior

Total length without ladder

Wheelbase Overall height without anten- na

266 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Technical data16

267I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes 17

17Helpful notesChapter overview This chapter contains helpful tips for the journey. The instructions address the following topics:

road assistance in European countries traffic rules in European countries gas supply in European countries toll regulations in European countries safe ways to spend the night during travel camping in winter

At the end of the chapter there is a checklist containing the most important equipment for the journey.

17.1 Traffic rules in foreign countries

Information about traffic regulations is especially important as state law applies in case of damage. For your own safety, always observe the following rules when travelling abroad:

Take the green insurance card with you. Always register accidents with the police. Never sign documents that you have not read and understood completely.

17.2 Help on Europe's roads

The vehicle driver is required to inform himself as to the traffic rules of the countries in which he plans to travel before beginning the trip. Contact your automobile club or embassy for further information. In some European countries, warning vests must be worn when exiting the vehicle outside of towns in the case of vehicle failures or accidents.

Country Emergen- cy services

Police

Breakdown service

Belgium 112 112

TCB Brussels 0 70 34 47 77

Bulgaria 150 166

UAB (02) 9 11 46/146 1)

Denmark 112 free of charge

112 free of charge

FDM 45 27 07 07

Germany 112 110

ADAC 22 22 22 1)

Estonia 112

110/112 1) EESTI (0) 6 97 91 88/18 88 1)

Finland 112 112

Helsinki (09) 77 47 64 00

France 15/112 1)

17/112 1)

Lyon (08) 25 80 08 22

268 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes17

Greece 112

171/112 1)

ELPA 104 00

Great Britain 112 112

AA (08 00) 0 28 90 18

Ireland 999/112 1)

999/112 1)

AA Dublin 18 00 66 77 88

Iceland 112 112

F.I.B 5 11 21 12

Italy 118/112 1)

112

ACI 8 00 11 68 00

Croatia 112 112

HAK 9 87/ 0 19 87 1)

Latvia 03/112 1)

02/112 1)

LAMB 18 88

Lithuania 03/112 1)

02/112 1)

LAS 8 80 00 00 00/18 88 1)

Luxembourg 112

113/112 1)

ACL 2 60 00

Macedonia 194 192

AMSM +389 2 31 81 196

Montenegro 94 92

AMSCG 19807

Netherlands 112 112

ANWB (088) 2 69 28 88

Norway 113 112

NAF 0 85 05

Austria 144/112 1)

133/112 1)

AMTC 120

Poland 999/112 1)

997/112 1)

PZM 022 5 32 84 33

Portugal 112 112

ACP Lissab. (21) 9 42 91 03 ACP Porto (22) 8 34 00 01

Romania 961/112 1)

955/112 1)

ACR (021) 2 22 22 22

Russia 03 02

RAS 8- (4 95) 7 47 66 66

Sweden 112 112

(08) 6 90 38 00

Switzerland 144

117/112 1) TCS 1 40/03 18 50 53 11 1)

Country Emergen- cy services

Police

Breakdown service

269I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes 17

Date 07/2010 Specifications without guarantee

17.3 Speed limits and permissible dimensions

For information, the speed limits (in km/h) and permissible dimensions (in m) of the countries visited most:

Serbia 94 92

AMSS 987

Slovakia 112 112

SATC 1 81 24

Slovenia 112 113

AMZS (1) 9 87/ 00386 1 5 30 53 53 1)

Spain 061/112 1)

112

RACE 9 15 93 33 33

Czech Republic 112 112

UAMK CR 12 30

Turkey 112

155/112 1)

TTOK (02 12) 2 82 81 40

Ukraine 03 02

112 UA (8-032) 2 97 65 50

Hungary 104/112 1)

107/112 1)

MAK 1 88/(06) 13 45 17 44 1)

Cyprus 112 112

AA (022) 31 31 31

1) In the mobile communication network

Country Emergen- cy services

Police

Breakdown service

Please always observe the speed limits in the individual countries.

Country Max. dimen- sions in me- ters

Gross weight

In built- up are- as

Outside built-up areas

Motor- way

Width Lgth.

Belgium 2.55 12 Up to 7.5 t Over 7.5 t

50 50

90/120 1)

60/90 1)

120 90

Bulgaria 2.60 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

90 70

130 100

Denmark 2.55 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

80 70

130 80

270 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes17

Germany 2.55 12 Up to 3.5 t 3.5 t up to

7.5 t Over

7.5 t 2)

50 50

50

100 80

80

130 3)

100

80

Estonia 2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

90 70

110 70

Finland 2.60 12 50 80 4) 80 4)

France 2.55 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

90 5)/-

80 5)/ 100 1) 5)

130 5)

110 5)

Greece 2.50 12 50 90/110 11) 120

Great Brit- ain

2.55 12 48 96/112 1) 112

Ireland 2.55 12 50 60/100 1) 120

Iceland 2.55 12 50 90 6)

Italy 2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

90/ 110 1) 7)

80

130 7)

100

Croatia 2.55 12 50 90/110 1) 130

Latvia 2.50 12 Up to 7.5 t Over 7.5 t

50 50

90/100 11)

80

110 80

Lithuania 2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

90 70

110 70

Luxem- bourg

2.55 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

90 8) 7)

75 7)

130 8) 7)

90 7)

Macedo- nia

2.50 12 40/60 80 80

Montene- gro

2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

80/100 1)

80

100 80

Nether- lands

2.55 9) 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

80/100 1)

80

120 80

Norway 2.55 12.40 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

80/90 1)

80 90 80

Austria 2.55 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

100 70

130 10)

80

Poland 2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

90/100 1)

70/80 1)

130 80

Portugal 2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

90/100 11)

80/90 11) 120 12)

110 12)

Country Max. dimen- sions in me- ters

Gross weight

In built- up are- as

Outside built-up areas

Motor- way

Width Lgth.

271I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes 17

Romania 2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

80/90 1)

80/90 1)

120 110

Russia 2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

60 60

90 13)

70 110 13)

90 13)

Sweden 2.60 24 14) Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

70- 110 1) 11)

80/90 1)

110 90

Switzer- land

2.55 12 Up to 3.5 t Over

3.5 t 15)

50 50

80/100 1)

80/100 1)

120 100

Serbia and Mon- tenegro

2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

60 60

80/100 1)

80

100 80

Slovakia 2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

60 60

90 80

130 80

Slovenia 2.55 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

80/100 1)

80

100 80

Spain 2.55 12 50 70/80 1) 90

Czech Re- public

2.50 12 Up to 3.5 t Over 3.5 t

50 50

90 80

130 80

Turkey 2.50 10 50 80 90

Ukraine 2.50 12 60 90 13) 110 13)

Hungary 2.50 12 Up to 2.5 t Over 2.5 t

50 50

90/110 1)

70

130 80

Cyprus 2.55 12 50 80 100

1) On expressways, on roads with more than one lane in each direction 2) Vehicles over 7.5 tons max. permissible weight require a tachograph 3) Recommended speed: 130 km/h 4) Since 1995, for the first time, vehicles up to an unladen weight of 1875 kg and vehi-

cles up to 3.5 t perm gross weight with appropriate equipment (ABS, driver airbag, seat belts on all seats) can drive max. 100 km/h

5) On wet roads, reduce speed by 10 km/h, on motorways by 20 km/h 6) On unmade roads (gravel): 80 km/h 7) In wet conditions, reduce speed by 20 km/h 8) Drivers who don't have their driver's licence for the full year, must not drive faster

than max. 75 km/h when out of town or 90 km/h on motorways 9) On main roads 2.55 m, on roads marked "B" 2.20 m 10) Between 10 p.m. and 5 a.m. the speed limit on the following motorways is

100 km/h: A10 (Tauernautobahn), A12 (Inntalautobahn), A13 (Brennerautobahn), A14 (Rheintalautobahn)

11) According to traffic signs

Country Max. dimen- sions in me- ters

Gross weight

In built- up are- as

Outside built-up areas

Motor- way

Width Lgth.

272 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes17

Date 07/2010 Source: ADAC Specifications without guarantee

17.4 Driving with low beam in European countries

17.5 Sleeping in the vehicle away from camping areas

12) Drivers who have had their driver's licence for less than one year must not drive faster than 90 km/h. Corresponding stickers (available from ACP offices) must be affixed in a clearly visible position on the rear of the vehicle

13) Drivers who have had their driver's licence for less than two years must not drive faster than 70 km/h

14) Swedish campsites often require the motorhome to have a closed waste water system

15) A heavy goods vehicle supplement must be paid on all roads for all vehicles exceeding 3.5 tons max. permissible weight

In many European countries, it is compulsory to drive with the vehicle's lights on even during the day. Regulations vary between countries. Motoring organisations or consulates can provide you with the relevant information.

Country Sleeping on roads and fields

Sleeping on privately owned lands

Comments

Yes No Yes No

Belgium X X On highway rest areas max. 24 hours permitted

Bulgaria X X

Denmark X X On streets and squares only up to 11 hours with a parking disc

Germany X X Staying overnight for one night to restore driving ability is per- mitted. There may be regional and local limitations

Finland X X Possible with the permission of the land owner

France X X Permission from the local au- thorities or the owner of the land is required. Parking and staying overnight on free areas is pro- hibited

Greece X X Staying overnight for one night at designated areas on the na- tional route Patras-Athens- Thessaloniki is permitted

Great Britain X X

Ireland X X

273I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes 17

Italy X X Staying overnight for one night at car parks and service stations is allowed. Observe the local regulations. Parking and staying overnight on free areas is pro- hibited

Croatia X X

Luxembourg X X

Macedonia X X

Netherlands X X Overnight stays on streets and squares is allowed in some bor- oughs

Norway X X Officially prohibited on rest are- as and cultivated grounds. Trav- elling on dirt roads is prohibited

Austria X X Staying overnight for one night to restore driving ability is per- mitted, but not in nature re- serves. Observe regional and local restrictions. Generally for- bidden in Tyrol

Poland X X Requires property owner's per- mission

Portugal X X Staying overnight for one night on motorway service stations and car parks under 10 hours are tolerated

Romania X X

Russia X X

Sweden X X Not on agriculture areas or in the vicinity of houses. Driving on open fields is prohibited

Switzerland X X One overnight stay at highway rest areas and in some cantons is tolerated

Serbia and Montenegro

X X

Slovakia X X Overnight stays on private land are only allowed if a toilet is present

Slovenia X X

Spain X X Some regional prohibitions ap- ply, especially on beaches

Czech Repub- lic

X X Overnight stays on private land are only allowed if a toilet is present

Country Sleeping on roads and fields

Sleeping on privately owned lands

Comments

Yes No Yes No

274 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes17

Specifications without guarantee

17.6 Gas supply in European countries

General tips Always observe the following instructions:

Only go on vacation with completely filled gas bottles. Use all of the gas bottles' capacity. Take along adapter sets (available in camping supply stores) for filling gas bottles in foreign countries and for connecting the gas pressure regulator to foreign gas bottles. During the cold time of the year observe filling with propane gas component (butane does not gas below 0 C). Use blue bottles from the firm Campingaz (distributed world-wide). Only use gas bottles with safety valves. When bottles from other countries are used, check the gas bottle compart- ments to see if the gas bottles fit into them. Gas bottles from other countries do not always display the same size as your own gas bottles.

17.7 Toll regulations in European countries Many European countries have introduced a mandatory toll system. The toll regulations and how they are collected vary greatly from country to country. Nevertheless, ignorance is no excuse. Penalties can be quite severe. As is the case with traffic regulations, the vehicle driver is required to be familiar with the toll formalities before starting out on a trip. For example, in Austria the vignette does not meet the toll requirements for vehicles that weigh more than 3.5 t. There, a so-called "Go-Box" must be obtained and charged. Contact your automobile club or the Internet for further information.

17.8 Tips on staying overnight safely during travel Prudent behaviour is the most important protective measure for insuring a safe night in the motorhome.

Turkey X X

Ukraine X X

Hungary X X Staying overnight on privately owned land is permitted only with police certification

Country Sleeping on roads and fields

Sleeping on privately owned lands

Comments

Yes No Yes No

In Europe, there are several different connection systems for gas bottles. It is not always possible to fill or exchange your gas bottles in a foreign country. Get information about the connection system in the country you are travelling to before embarking on your journey, e.g. at a motoring club or in the trade press.

Windscreens with solar filters can affect the functioning of automatic toll collection systems (e.g. Go-Box). This must be taken into account when acquiring the appropriate device (e.g. Split-Go-Box).

275I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes 17

The risk of thievery is reduced to a minimum when the following basic rules are observed:

Before commencing the journey, close and lock all windows, doors and skylights. During high season do not spend the night at highway rest stops or parking areas located along typical vacation routes. Several vehicles on one site at the same time do not necessarily decrease the chances of thievery occurring. Consult your own feelings about the parking site. Even if it is just for one night, go to a camping site. When parking on open space keep emergency routes clear. The way to the driver's seat should be clear. The ignition key should always be within reach. Only take with you those valuables which are absolutely necessary for the journey. If possible, store valuables in a small safe and not in the immediate vicinity of windows or doors. Always lock up the vehicle.

17.9 Tips for winter campers The following tips will help make your winter camping experience as agreeable as possible.

Reserve your parking place in good time. Good winter camping sites are often booked up early. Do not start your trip without winter tyres. Bring snow chains. Choose your parking place with care. Observe the ground beneath you. Snow and ice may melt. When the vehicle has been positioned, release the handbrake to prevent freezing. No snow walls should be allowed to cover the built-in forced ventilation. Keep the built-in forced ventilation free from snow and ice. Make sure the air circulation is good. Good air circulation prevents mois- ture from collecting and makes it easier to heat the living area. Cover the single-paned driver's cabin window with insulation mats to avoid thermal bridges. Follow the instructions in the section "Gas supply in European countries". Use a two-bottle system with automatic controller for the gas system, so that the supply does not run out during the night. Only operate the gas system using propane gas. Do not use the space behind the heater as a storage compartment. Never operate catalytic ovens or infra-red gas radiators in the interior of the vehicle, since they consume oxygen for burning. Lay the 230 V power cable in such a way that the cable cannot be frozen or be damaged (e.g. during snow removal). When it is snowing heavily, clear the roof of the vehicle of snow regularly. A few centimetres of powdery snow serves as insulation, but wet snow quickly becomes a heavy burden. Before embarking on the return journey, remove all the snow from the roof to avoid impeding vehicles behind you with a "snow flag".

17.10 Travel checklists The following checklists will help that nothing important is left at home although not everything on the checklists might be necessary.

276 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes17

Do not leave checking of documents (e.g. vehicle papers and information) as well as checking the condition of the vehicle until just before com- mencing the trip. Planning and checking documents well in advance will save unnecessary trouble.

Object Object Object

Kitchen area Wiping cloth Cleansing agent (detergent)

Salad servers

Mug Dishcloths Chopping board

Turnspit Set of knifes and forks for grilling

Bowls

Can opener Coffeepot Brush to wash the dishes

Egg-cup Corkscrew Cloth to wash the dishes

Ice cube tray Kitchen paper Matches

Lighter Spoons Cups

Bottle opener Knifes Plates

Air-tight storage boxes

Garbage bags Thermos jug

Breakfast plate Frying pans Pots

Forks Stirring spoons Glasses

Bathroom/sanitary items

Towels Toilet brush Toothbrush glass

Sanitary items Toilet paper

Living area Dustbin Insect lamp Rain clothes

Road atlas Insect repellent First aid kit

Bath towels Deck of cards Travel guides/park- ing guide

Bath shoes Broom Rucksack

Batteries Candles Sleeping bags

Bed sheets Dust pan Pencils and paper

Bed linen Coat-hangers Shoes

Laundry bag Clothes brush Shoe polish

Books Pillow Vacuum cleaner

Camping guide Map Flash light

Spare bulbs Medicine Pocket knife

Water bottle Music cassettes Table cloth

Binoculars Neck-supporting pillow

Clothes pins

Fire extinguisher Sewing kit Clothesline

Gas bottle Radio

277I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes 17

Vehicle/tools Waste water con- tainer

Fabric tape Screwdriver

Adapter socket Watering can for drinking water

Current-measuring instrument

CEE adapter Cable reel Step

Wire V-belt Wheel chocks

Spare wheel Glue First-aid kit

Spare lamps Universal pliers Vehicle jack

Spare fuses Compressor Hazard warning tri- angle

Replacement wa- ter pump

Luster terminals Warning sign

Hammer Loops Warning vest

Flat wrench Tube adapter Flashing hazard warning light

Gas filling adapter Hose clips

Gas tube Snow chains (win- ter)

Outside Stay rope Camping table Lock

Bellows Luggage racks String

Camping chairs Grill Tent pegs/tighten- ing ropes

Documents List of addresses Registration book Identity card

Registration confir- mation(s)

Driving licence Passport

Allergy certificate Green insurance card

Writ of protection

Instruction manuals Vaccination certifi- cate

Vignette/toll card

Instruction leaflets for medicines

Credit card Visa

Object Object Object

278 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Helpful notes17

279I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Inspection plan 18

18Inspection plan

Pos. Component Activity Interval

1 Auxiliary support Lubrication Annually

2 Joints, hinges Lubrication Annually

3 Refrigerator, heater, boiler, cook- er, lighting, flap and door closures, toilet, seat belts

Function check Annually

4 Windows, skylights Function check, water ingress test

Annually

5 Upholstery, curtains, blinds Visual check Annually

6 Sealing strips, edges, rubber Check for damage Annually

7 Water supply Water ingress test Annually

8 Hot-air system Function check, clean fan wheel as neces- sary

Annually

9 Underbody protection, floor skirt at- tachment

Visual check Annually

10 Pull-down bed suspension Function check Annually

11 Electrical system Function check Annually

12 Gas system Official gas inspection Every two years

13 Connections between the chassis and body

Check Every two years

14 Underbody Visual check, repair underbody protection as necessary

Every two years

280 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Inspection plan18

Delivery Pos. 1-11

Stamp of the Brstner dealer

Date Signature

1st year Pos. 1-11 2nd year Pos. 1-14

Stamp of the Brstner dealer Stamp of the Brstner dealer

Date Signature Date Signature

3rd year Pos. 1-11 4th year Pos. 1-14

Stamp of the Brstner dealer Stamp of the Brstner dealer

Date Signature Date Signature

5th year Pos. 1-11 6th year Pos. 1-14

Stamp of the Brstner dealer Stamp of the Brstner dealer

Date Signature Date Signature

7th year Pos. 1-11 8th year Pos. 1-14

Stamp of the Brstner dealer Stamp of the Brstner dealer

Date Signature Date Signature

281I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Index

12 V fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 For Thetford toilet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 For toilet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 On the living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 On the relay box AD01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 On the starter battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 On the transformer/rectifier . . . . . . . . . . . . 137

12 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119, 124 12 V main switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117, 124, 125 12 V power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108

Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117, 124, 125 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244

230 V connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53, 134 External flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244

230 V fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259

230 V fuse box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 230 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . 119, 124, 125 230 V power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 3-way valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155

A Accessories, fitting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Additional equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Add-on parts see special equipment . . . . . . . . . 12 Add-on parts, securing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Adjustable head section, fixed bed . . . . . . . . . . 94 Adjustment mechanism, divan . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Air conditioning unit (Dometic)

Air current, adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Operating modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248

Air conditioning unit (Telair) Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Filter, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Operating modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Ventilation grill, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209

Air outlet nozzles, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150

Antenna alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Semi-automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54

Antenna, lowering for driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Appliances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149

Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Warranty cards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1

Armrest, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41, 42 Automatic power selection (AES) . . . . . . 174, 176 Auxiliary heat exchanger

Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158

Auxiliary water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Awning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56

B Basic equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Battery alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119, 122, 128 Battery cut-off switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Battery monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113, 116 Battery see starter battery or living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109, 110 Battery selector switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113, 115 Battery separation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Battery voltage, displaying . . . . . . . . 117, 120, 126 Bed extension, securing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Bed widening, single beds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Beds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Before the journey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Bike rack

Bicycles, loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Not lowerable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Travelling with a loaded bike rack . . . . . . . . 25

Blind, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Blind, window

Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78, 79 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79

Block diagram, panel (IT 96) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Block diagram, panel (IT 994) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Block diagram, panel (LT 510) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Boiler (Alde)

Emptying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 Water, filling with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166

Index

282 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Boiler (Truma) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Emptying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Operating modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Safety/drainage valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Summer operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Water, filling with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Winter operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164

Bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45

Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39, 243

Braking system, troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Breakdown services in Europe . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 Bulbs, changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221

Ceiling lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 Exterior lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Front lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222, 223 Garage light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Halogen spotlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Interior lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 Rear lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 Recessed halogen light . . . . . . . . . . . 228, 229 Side lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Types of external bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 Wardrobe light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230

Bunk bed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Butane gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15, 98

C Cable reel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Camping gas bottles, use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 98 Camping in winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Cap for the drinking water filler neck . . . . . . . . . 64 Capacity of the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Caravan coupling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203

Air conditioning unit (Telair) . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Blind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Curtains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Entrance step . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 External care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Extractor hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208

Fuel cell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Furniture surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 Gas cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 High-pressure cleaner, washing with . . . . .203 Hot-water heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217 In the winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209 Insect screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Interior care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 Leather covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Net curtains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 PVC-floor covering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Roman shade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Sink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Synthetic parts, interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 Temporary lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210 Underbody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204 Upholstery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 Washing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204 Waste water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 Water system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204 Winter lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211

Carpet, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Ceiling lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 Changing wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235

Tightening torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236 Charging condition, displaying

Living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117 Starter battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117

Charging current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123 Chassis number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33, 210

Before the journey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 For the journey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275 Initial start-up after temporary lay-up . . . . .212 Road safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Temporary lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210 Winter lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211

Child restraint systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 Children's beds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88, 90 Circuit diagram

Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148 Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142

Circulating pump, setting the rotational speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155 Circulation fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150

283I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Index

Cleaning Water pipes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206

Cleaning see care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Closed circuit current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Condensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73

On the double acrylic glass pane . . . . . . . . 74 On the screwed connections in the floor . . . 73

Condensation water see condensation . . . . . . . 74 Connecting cable see 230 V power supply . . . 134 Conventional load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Conversion door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57, 60

Roman shade, closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Roman shade, opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60

Conversion door, inside Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59, 60 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59, 60

Conversion door, outside Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58, 59 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58, 59

Cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249

Curtains, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206

D Danger of suffocation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 73 Daytime running light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Digital clock

Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122

Dimensions see table of linear measures . . . . 264 Dimensions, permissible . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Direction indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222, 225, 226 Discharging current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Displays

Battery voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117, 120, 126 Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Digital clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123, 129 Waste water tank level . . . . . . . 119, 122, 128 Water tank level . . . . . . . . . . . . 119, 122, 128

Disposal Household waste . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Sewage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Waste water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10

Divan adjustment mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57, 58, 59

Doors Conversion door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Driver's door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57, 58, 59 Maintenance work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254

Double floor, load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Drain cock, waste water tank . . . . . . . . . . 185, 186

Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Drain cocks, position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167, 259 Drinking water filler neck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183

Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183

Driver's door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Driver's door, inside

Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58

Driver's door, outside Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57

Driver's seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Adjusting an appropriate seating position . . 41 Armrest, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41, 42 Backrest, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Moving in lengthways direction . . . . . . . . . . 42 Seat inclination, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Seat, rotating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41

Driving speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Driving the motorhome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 DuoControl switching facility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 During the journey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35

E Electrical steady legs

Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Warning tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52

Electrical system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 230 V connection, troubleshooting . . . . . . . 244 Entrance step, troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . 243 Explanation of terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Lighting, troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243

Entrance step . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 49 Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Extending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 31 Retracting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243

Index

284 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Environmental tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Extendable storage compartment, loading . . . . . 25 Exterior lighting

Bulbs, changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243

External care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 External connection see 230 V connection . . . . 53 External flaps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61

Flap lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61, 62, 63 External gas connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 External mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44

Adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Heater, switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44

External socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Extractor hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172

Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Filter, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208

F Fault current protection switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134

Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Filling level of the waste water tank, displaying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Filling level of the water tank, displaying . . . . . 119 Filling the tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Fire

Behaviour in the event of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Extinguishing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11

Fire prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Fire risks, avoidance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 FI-switch see fault current protection switch . . . . . . . . . . 140 Fixed bed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92, 93, 94

Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Head section, lowering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Head section, raising . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93

Fixed bed, electrically adjustable . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Emergency operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Extending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Head section, adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Retracting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95

Fixed table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Extending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Moving in a crossways direction . . . . . . . . . 87 Moving in a lengthways direction . . . . . . . . . 87 Reducing size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86

Flap lock Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62, 63, 64 Elliptical-shaped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62, 63, 64 Service flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63 With recessed handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62

Flashing indicator see direction indicator . . . . .226 Flat screen with holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71

Positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72, 73 Storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72, 73

Floor warming unit, electrical Overload protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159

Fog light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223, 225 Forced ventilation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12, 73 Freezer compartment door locking mechanism

Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179 Locking in the ventilation position . . . . . . . .179 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178

Front passenger's seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 Adjusting an appropriate seating position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 Armrest, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41, 42 Backrest, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 Moving in lengthways direction . . . . . . . . . . .42 Seat inclination, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 Seat, rotating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41

Fuel cell Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216 Operating status, indication . . . . . . . . . . . .131 Operating unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 Process medium, refilling . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217 Tank cartridge, replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246

Fuel filler neck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47

Furniture flaps Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65, 66 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65, 66

Furniture flaps, troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . .254 Furniture surfaces, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 Fuse box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140

285I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Index

Fuses 12 V fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 230 V fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134, 140 For the Thetford toilet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 For toilet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 On the living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 On the relay box AD01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 On the solar charge regulator . . . . . . . . . . 139 On the starter battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 On the transformer/rectifier EBL 220 . . . . 137 On the transformer/rectifier EBL 99 . . . . . 137

Fuses see 12 V fuses and 230 V fuse . . . . . . . 135

G Garage light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Gas alarm system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Gas bottle compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15, 98 Gas bottles

Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15, 98

Gas connection, external . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Gas cooker

Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168, 169 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168, 169 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249

Gas isolator taps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100, 149

Gas odour . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 97, 246 Gas oven . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169

Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249

Gas supply in European countries . . . . . . . . . 274 Gas system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97

Defect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 97, 246 General instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 97 Switching automatics . . . . . . . . . . . . 101, 103 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246

Gas tube, check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15, 98 General instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Ground plans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259

H Halogen spotlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Handbrake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49

Applying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Handling of tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235

Headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Heat exchanger

Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158

Heat exchanger (Alde) Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156

Heat exchangers, heater, replacement . . . . . . 149 Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150

Air outlet nozzles, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . 150 Circulation fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Heat circulation, regulating . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Heat exchangers, replacement . . . . . . . . . 149 Hot air distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Initial start-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247

Heki skylight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Insect screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Roman shade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Ventilation position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83

Help on Europe's roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 High rate of gas consumption . . . . . . . 14, 97, 246 High-pressure cleaner, washing with . . . . . . . . 203 Hinged window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76

Blind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75, 76 Continuous ventilation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75, 76 Insect screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79, 80 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75, 76 Roman shade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80

Hot air distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Hot-air heater

Circulation fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Operating modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247

Hot-water heater 230 V electrical operation, selecting . . . . . 154 3-way valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Adjustment menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Auxiliary circulating pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Fluid level, checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218

Index

286 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Gas and 230 V electrical operation, selecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Gas operation, selecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Heat exchanger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Heater, switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Heater, switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Heating fluid, topping up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Heating system, bleeding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Maintenance work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Operating unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Rotational speed, circulating pump . . . . . . 155 Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Start screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Tool menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248

I Independent vehicle heater

Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159

Indicator lamp, 12 V power supply . . . . . . 119, 124 Indicator lamp, 230 V power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119, 124, 125 Indicator lamp, entrance step . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Indicator lamp, toilet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Information stickers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Inner door, troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 Insect screen door

Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61

Insect screen, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Insect screen, Heki skylight

Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83

Insect screen, sunroof Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81

Insect screen, windows Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79, 80 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79, 80

Insect screen, wind-up skylight Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84

Inspection plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 Inspection work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Inspections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Interior care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205

Interior lighting Bulbs, changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243

K Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17

L Ladder, rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227

Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 Lay-up

Temporary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210 Winter lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211

Leakage water inside the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . .252 Leather covers, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Light control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69 Light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69

Kitchen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68 Living area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68 Toilet compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67

Lighting Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222, 223 Lamps, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225 Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243

Living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110 Battery alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119, 122, 128 Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111 Charging current, displaying . . . . . . . . . . . .123 Discharging current, displaying . . . . . . . . . .123 Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110 Maintenance work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216 Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244, 245 Voltage, displaying . . . . . . . . . . 117, 120, 126

Load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21 Bike rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25 Double floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25 Extendable storage compartment . . . . . . . . .25 Rear garage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 Rear storage space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 Roof rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23

Load rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26, 27 Load rack for roof loads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 Load see also payload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21

287I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Index

Lock Conversion door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58, 59 Driver's door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 External flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62, 63 Furniture flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65

Low beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222, 223, 272

M Main beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222, 223 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Maintenance work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215

Air conditioning unit (Dometic) . . . . . . . . . 208 Air conditioning unit (Telair) . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Fuel cell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 Hot-water heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Independent vehicle heater . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216

Marker light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Mass in ready-to-drive condition . . . . . . . . . 19, 21 Maximum permissible gross weight . . . . . . 18, 21 Mechanical steady legs

Extending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 51 Length, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 51 Retracting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 51

Microwave oven Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250

Monitor, reversing camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38

N Net curtains, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 No gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Nose weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29

O Off-load voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Operating modes

Air conditioning unit (Dometic) . . . . . . . . . 160 Air conditioning unit (Telair) . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Boiler (Truma) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Hot-air heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Refrigerator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174, 176 Switching automatics, gas system . . . . . . 104

Oven see gas cooker or gas oven . . . . . . 167, 169 Overloading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21

P Panel (IT 96) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116

12 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 12 V main switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 230 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Battery voltage, displaying . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Filling level of the waste water tank, displaying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Filling level of the water tank, displaying . . 119 Switch for water pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119

Panel (IT 994) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 12 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 12 V main switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 230 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Battery voltage, displaying . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Filling level of the waste water tank, displaying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Filling level of the water tank, displaying . . 122 Switch for water pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124

Panel (light control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Panel (LT 510) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124

12 V main switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 230 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Battery displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Tank display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Tank heater switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 Temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 Water pump switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130

Panel see also displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116, 120 Parking distance control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36

Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Parking light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Payload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18

Calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Composition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Example calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19, 21

Payload see also load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Permissible gross weight see maximum permissible gross weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Permitted mass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Personal equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Pilot seat see driver's seat and front passenger's seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Propane gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15, 98

Index

288 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Pull-down bed Access ladder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89, 92 Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Roman shade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Safety net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89

Pull-down bed, electrically operated . . . . . . . . . 90 Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Emergency operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Making ready for operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Overload protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Safety net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92

PVC-floor covering, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206

R Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Ramps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Rear axle load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Rear garage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Rear ladder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Rear storage space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Recessed halogen light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228, 229 Refrigerator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54, 173

Change-over between energy sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175, 177 Door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 Frame heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 Operating modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174, 176 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175, 177 Refrigerating temperature control . . . 175, 177 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176, 178 Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175, 177 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 Ventilation grill, removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173

Refrigerator door locking mechanism Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 Locking in the ventilation position . . . . . . . 179 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178, 179

Refrigerator ventilation grill, removal . . . . . . . . 173 Registration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Remote control, electrical steady legs . . . . . . . . 52 Replacing the fuel cell tank cartridge . . . . . . . . 216 Reversing camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Risk of frost damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 181, 188 Road safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33

Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Notes for . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12

Roman shade, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206

Roman shade, driver's cabin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81

Roman shade, Heki skylight Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83

Roman shade, pull-down bed Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90

Roman shade, sunroof Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81

Roman shade, window of conversion door Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60

Roman shade, windows Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80

Roman shade, wind-up skylight Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84

Roof load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 Roof rack, load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 Roof rail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23

S Safety cut-out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140 Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11

Changing wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 Cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167 Electrical system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16 Fire prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11 Gas bottles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 Gas system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14, 97 Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 Road safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12 Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14 Water system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16

Safety net Pull-down bed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89 Pull-down bed, electrically operated . . . . . . .92

Safety switch (FI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140 Safety/drainage valve boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164

Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164, 259 Sanitary fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 SAT socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 Satellite unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54, 55

With automatic antenna alignment . . . . .54, 55 With semi-automatic antenna alignment . . . .54

289I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Index

Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Fastening correctly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40

Seating arrangement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Selector switch for radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Serial number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Sewage tank

Emptying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202

Shower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 Shower partition, securing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Side marker light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Single beds, bed widening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Sink, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Skylights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Sleeping conversion, widening single beds . . . . 96 Sliding window

Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77

Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Sockets

External socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 SAT socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 TV socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141

Solar charge regulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Solar installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Spare parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 Spare wheel support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 Special equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255

Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Marking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Weight details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255

Speed limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Spotlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71, 229

Removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Shifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Turning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71

Starter battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Battery alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Discharging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244 Voltage, displaying . . . . . . . . . . 117, 120, 126

Start-up After temporary lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 After winter lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212

Staying overnight Away from camping areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 During travel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274

Steady legs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 51 Extending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 51 Length, adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 51 Retracting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 51

Sunroof Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Insect screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Roman shade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80

Supports see steady legs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 51 Suspension table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84

Conversion to bed foundation . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Extending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Reducing size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85

Switching automatics, gas system . . . . . . 101, 103 Symbols

For instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Gas isolator taps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100, 149

Synthetic parts in the toilet and living areas, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205

T Table of linear measures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Tank alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Tank heater, switching on and off . . . . . . . . . . 129 Tank lid see fuel filler neck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Technical data

Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265

Television . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123, 129 Thetford cassette . . . . . . . . . . . 190, 194, 196, 199

Emptying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194, 199 Removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 Retaining clip . . . . . . . . . . . 190, 194, 196, 199

Thetford toilet Emptying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194, 199 Fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 Preparing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190, 196 Swiveling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 Using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192, 198 With fixed seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196

Index

290 I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Tightening torque, wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 Toilet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190

Fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252

Toilet (Dometic) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Flushing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Preparing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200

Toilet compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 Light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Ventilation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189

Toilet see Thetford toilet or toilet (Dometic) . . . 190 Toll regulations in European countries . . . . . . . 274 Total discharge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14

General instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14

Traffic rules in foreign countries . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 220) . . . . . . . . . . . . 114

Circuit diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115

Transformer/rectifier (EBL 99) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Circuit diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112

Transformer/rectifier, position . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Travel checklists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Travel cots suitable for children . . . . . . . . . . 88, 90 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243

12 V power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244 230 V connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244 Air conditioning unit (Dometic) . . . . . . . . . . 248 Air conditioning unit (Telair) . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244 Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 Boiler (Alde) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 Boiler (Truma) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Braking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Electrical system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Entrance step . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Extractor hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 Fuel cell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Furniture flaps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 Gas cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Gas oven . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Gas system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246

Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247 Hot-air heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247 Hot-water heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248 Inner door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254 Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243 Living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 Microwave oven . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250 Refrigerator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250 Starter battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 Toilet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252 Water supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252

TV socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 Tyre change see changing wheels . . . . . . . . . .235 Tyre specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233

Excessive wear . . . . . . . . . . . 13, 33, 233, 240 General instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233 Handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 Load-carrying capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236 Tyre pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240 Tyre selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234

U Underbody, maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204 Unladen weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 Upholstery, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205

V Vehicle identification plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 Vehicle lighting see exterior lighting . . . . . . . . .221 Vehicle, washing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204 Ventilation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73

Toilet compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189 Volume of waste water, displaying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119, 122, 128 Volume of water, displaying . . . . . . 119, 122, 128

W Wardrobe light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68, 230 Warning stickers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 Warning tone, electrical steady legs . . . . . . . . . .52 Warranty cards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1 Washer fluid, filling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 Washer nozzles, setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 Washing with a high-pressure cleaner . . . . . . .203 Waste gas vent on the right hand side of the vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150, 163

291I-Modell - 11/12 - Ausgabe 09/11 - 2096165 - BUE-0056-05EN

Index

Waste water hose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185, 186 Waste water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185

Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Cleaning opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 Emptying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185, 186 Filling level, displaying . . . . . . . 119, 122, 128 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252

Waste water tank heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 Water pipes, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Water pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181, 187

Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119, 124 Switching on and off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130

Water supply General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252

Water system Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Disinfect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 Drinking water filler neck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Emptying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 Filling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16

Water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Filling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Filling level, displaying . . . . . . . 119, 122, 128 Overflow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Volumes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Water, draining . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Water, filling with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184

Weight details for special equipment . . . . . . . . 255 Wheel chocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Wheel rim size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 Wheel rim type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Window winders, electrical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Window, conversion door

Roman shade, closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Roman shade, opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60

Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Blind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78, 79 Insect screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78, 79, 80 Roman shade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80, 81

Windows, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204

Wind-up skylight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Insect screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Roman shade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254

Winter care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 Winter operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the Viseo Burstner works, you can view and download the Burstner Viseo 2012 Instruction Manual on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the Instruction Manual for Burstner Viseo as well as other Burstner manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The Instruction Manual should include all the details that are needed to use a Burstner Viseo. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the Burstner Viseo 2012 Instruction Manual is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This Burstner Viseo 2012 Instruction Manual consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download Burstner Viseo 2012 Instruction Manual free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print Burstner Viseo 2012 Instruction Manual, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the Burstner Viseo 2012 Instruction Manual as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.